diff options
author | marha <marha@users.sourceforge.net> | 2011-05-16 08:06:12 +0000 |
---|---|---|
committer | marha <marha@users.sourceforge.net> | 2011-05-16 08:06:12 +0000 |
commit | 08cbf3b50bfe713044f36b363c73768cd042f13c (patch) | |
tree | 6be4c5dd7f5bc2f058228b2a2fa747a4d7666dc5 /xorg-server/hw/xfree86/doc | |
parent | d8c3e3d2ba88d6b87a718aef7f4fb4627113eb52 (diff) | |
download | vcxsrv-08cbf3b50bfe713044f36b363c73768cd042f13c.tar.gz vcxsrv-08cbf3b50bfe713044f36b363c73768cd042f13c.tar.bz2 vcxsrv-08cbf3b50bfe713044f36b363c73768cd042f13c.zip |
xserver xkeyboar-config mesa git update 16 May 2011
Diffstat (limited to 'xorg-server/hw/xfree86/doc')
-rw-r--r-- | xorg-server/hw/xfree86/doc/Makefile.am | 22 | ||||
-rw-r--r-- | xorg-server/hw/xfree86/doc/README.DRIcomp (renamed from xorg-server/hw/xfree86/doc/devel/README.DRIcomp) | 0 | ||||
-rw-r--r-- | xorg-server/hw/xfree86/doc/Registry (renamed from xorg-server/hw/xfree86/doc/devel/Registry) | 0 | ||||
-rw-r--r-- | xorg-server/hw/xfree86/doc/ddxDesign.xml (renamed from xorg-server/hw/xfree86/doc/sgml/DESIGN.xml) | 18788 | ||||
-rw-r--r-- | xorg-server/hw/xfree86/doc/devel/Makefile.am | 7 | ||||
-rw-r--r-- | xorg-server/hw/xfree86/doc/exa-driver.txt (renamed from xorg-server/hw/xfree86/doc/devel/exa-driver.txt) | 0 | ||||
-rw-r--r-- | xorg-server/hw/xfree86/doc/sgml/Makefile.am | 27 |
7 files changed, 9412 insertions, 9432 deletions
diff --git a/xorg-server/hw/xfree86/doc/Makefile.am b/xorg-server/hw/xfree86/doc/Makefile.am index acb8937f0..1c3620abb 100644 --- a/xorg-server/hw/xfree86/doc/Makefile.am +++ b/xorg-server/hw/xfree86/doc/Makefile.am @@ -1,4 +1,18 @@ -SUBDIRS = devel sgml
-
-EXTRA_DIST = \
- README.modes
+ +if ENABLE_DEVEL_DOCS +if HAVE_XMLTO + +# Main DocBook/XML files (DOCTYPE book) +docbook = ddxDesign.xml + +# Generate DocBook/XML output formats with or without stylesheets +include $(top_srcdir)/devbook.am + +endif HAVE_XMLTO +endif ENABLE_DEVEL_DOCS + +EXTRA_DIST = \ + Registry \ + exa-driver.txt \ + README.DRIcomp \ + README.modes diff --git a/xorg-server/hw/xfree86/doc/devel/README.DRIcomp b/xorg-server/hw/xfree86/doc/README.DRIcomp index 89f40a759..89f40a759 100644 --- a/xorg-server/hw/xfree86/doc/devel/README.DRIcomp +++ b/xorg-server/hw/xfree86/doc/README.DRIcomp diff --git a/xorg-server/hw/xfree86/doc/devel/Registry b/xorg-server/hw/xfree86/doc/Registry index 89a5f10fa..89a5f10fa 100644 --- a/xorg-server/hw/xfree86/doc/devel/Registry +++ b/xorg-server/hw/xfree86/doc/Registry diff --git a/xorg-server/hw/xfree86/doc/sgml/DESIGN.xml b/xorg-server/hw/xfree86/doc/ddxDesign.xml index 13e582877..02909602c 100644 --- a/xorg-server/hw/xfree86/doc/sgml/DESIGN.xml +++ b/xorg-server/hw/xfree86/doc/ddxDesign.xml @@ -1,9394 +1,9394 @@ -<?xml version="1.0" encoding="ISO-8859-1"?>
-<!DOCTYPE article PUBLIC "-//OASIS//DTD DocBook XML V4.3//EN"
- "http://www.oasis-open.org/docbook/xml/4.3/docbookx.dtd" [
- <!ENTITY % defs SYSTEM "/xserver/doc/xml/xserver.ent"> %defs;
- <!-- config file keyword markup -->
- <!-- specific config file keywords -->
- <!ENTITY k.device "<emphasis>Device</emphasis>">
- <!ENTITY k.monitor "<emphasis>Monitor</emphasis>">
- <!ENTITY k.display "<emphasis>Display</emphasis>">
- <!ENTITY k.inputdevice "<emphasis>InputDevice</emphasis>">
- <!ENTITY k.screen "<emphasis>Screen</emphasis>">
- <!ENTITY k.serverlayout "<emphasis>ServerLayout</emphasis>">
- <!ENTITY k.driver "<emphasis>Driver</emphasis>">
- <!ENTITY k.module "<emphasis>Module</emphasis>">
- <!ENTITY k.identifier "<emphasis>Identifier</emphasis>">
- <!ENTITY k.serverflags "<emphasis>ServerFlags</emphasis>">
-] >
-
-<article>
- <articleinfo>
-
- <title>XFree86 DDX Design (Xorg server version &xserver.version;)</title>
-
- <authorgroup>
- <corpauthor><ulink url="http://www.xfree86.org/">
- The XFree86 Project, Inc.</ulink></corpauthor>
- <corpauthor><ulink url="http://www.x.org/">
- The X.Org Foundation, Inc.</ulink></corpauthor>
-
- <othercredit>
- <firstname>Jim</firstname><surname>Gettys</surname>
- <contrib>Updates for X11R6.7</contrib>
- </othercredit>
- </authorgroup>
-
- <pubdate>&xserver.reldate;</pubdate>
- <releaseinfo>Xorg server version &xserver.version;</releaseinfo>
-
- </articleinfo>
-
- <note><para>
-This document describes software undergoing continual evolution, and
-the interfaces described here are subject to change without notice.
-This document is intended to cover the interfaces as found in the
-xorg-server-&xserver.version; release, but is probably not completely
-in sync with the code base.
- </para></note>
-
-
- <sect1>
- <title>Preface</title>
-
- <para>
-This document was originally the design spec for the DDX layer of the
-XFree86 4.0 X server. The X.Org Foundation adopted the XFree86 4.4rc2
-version of that server as the basis of the Xorg server project, and has
-evolved the XFree86 DDX layer greatly since forking. This document thus
-covers only the current implementation of the XFree86 DDX as found in the
-Xorg server &xserver.version; release, and no longer matches the XFree86
-server itself.
- </para>
-
- <para>
-The XFree86 Project's broad design principles for XFree86 4.0 were:
- <itemizedlist>
- <listitem><para>keep it reasonable
- <itemizedlist>
- <listitem><para>We cannot rewrite the complete server
- </para></listitem>
- <listitem><para>We don't want to re-invent the wheel
- </para></listitem>
- </itemizedlist></para></listitem>
- <listitem><para>keep it modular
- <itemizedlist>
- <listitem><para>As many things as possible should go into modules
- </para></listitem>
- <listitem><para>The basic loader binary should be minimal
- </para></listitem>
- <listitem><para>A clean design with well defined layering is
- important</para></listitem>
- <listitem><para>DDX specific global variables are a nono
- </para></listitem>
- <listitem><para>The structure should be flexible enough to allow
- future extensions</para></listitem>
- <listitem><para>The structure should minimize duplication of
- common code</para></listitem>
- </itemizedlist></para></listitem>
- <listitem><para>keep important features in mind
- <itemizedlist>
- <listitem><para>multiple screens, including multiple instances
- of drivers</para></listitem>
- <listitem><para>mixing different color depths and visuals on
- different and ideally even on the same screen
- </para></listitem>
- <listitem><para>better control of the PCI device used
- </para></listitem>
- <listitem><para>better config file parser</para></listitem>
- <listitem><para>get rid of all VGA compatibility assumptions
- </para></listitem>
- </itemizedlist></para></listitem>
- </itemizedlist>
- </para>
-
- <para>
-While the XFree86 project had a goal of avoiding changes to the DIX
-layer unless they found major deficiencies there, to avoid divergence from
-the X.Org sample implementation they were integrating changes from, the
-X.Org developers now maintain both sides, and make changes where they are
-most appropriate. This document concentrates on the XFree86 DDX layer used
-in the Xorg server itself (the code found in <filename>hw/xfree86</filename>
-in the source tree), and developers will also want to refer to the
-<filename>Xserver-spec</filename> documentation that covers the DIX layer
-routines common to all the X servers in the sample implementation.
- </para>
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1>
- <title>The xorg.conf File</title>
-
- <para>
-The xorg.conf file format is based on the XF86Config format from XFree86 4.4,
-which is in turn similar to the old XFree86 3.x XF86Config format, with the
-following changes:
- </para>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>&k.device; section</title>
-
- <para>
- The &k.device; sections are similar to what they used to be, and
- describe hardware-specific information for a single video card.
- &k.device;
- Some new keywords are added:
-
-
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry><term>Driver "drivername"</term>
- <listitem><para>
- Specifies the name of the driver to be used for the card. This
- is mandatory.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- <varlistentry><term>BusID "busslot"</term>
- <listitem><para>
- Specifies uniquely the location of the card on the bus. The
- purpose is to identify particular cards in a multi-headed
- configuration. The format of the argument is intentionally
- vague, and may be architecture dependent. For a PCI bus, it
- is something like "bus:slot:func".
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- A &k.device; section is considered <quote>active</quote> if there is a reference
- to it in an active &k.screen; section.
- </para>
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>&k.screen; section</title>
-
- <para>
- The &k.screen; sections are similar to what they used to be. They
- no longer have a &k.driver; keyword, but an &k.identifier; keyword
- is added. (The &k.driver; keyword may be accepted in place of the
- &k.identifier; keyword for compatibility purposes.) The identifier
- can be used to identify which screen is to be active when multiple
- &k.screen; sections are present. It is possible to specify the active
- screen from the command line. A default is chosen in the absence
- of one being specified. A &k.screen; section is considered <quote>active</quote>
- if there is a reference to it either from the command line, or from
- an active &k.serverlayout; section.
- </para>
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>&k.inputdevice; section</title>
-
- <para>
- The &k.inputdevice; section is a new section that describes
- configuration information for input devices. It replaces the old
- <emphasis>Keyboard</emphasis>, <emphasis>Pointer</emphasis> and <emphasis>XInput</emphasis>
- sections. Like the &k.device; section, it has two mandatory keywords:
- &k.identifier; and &k.driver;. For compatibility purposes the old
- <emphasis>Keyboard</emphasis> and <emphasis>Pointer</emphasis> sections are
- converted by the parser into &k.inputdevice; sections as follows:
-
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry><term><emphasis>Keyboard</emphasis></term>
- <listitem><literallayout>
- &k.identifier; "Implicit Core Keyboard"
- &k.driver; "keyboard"
- </literallayout></listitem></varlistentry>
- <varlistentry><term><emphasis>Pointer</emphasis></term>
- <listitem><literallayout>
- &k.identifier; "Implicit Core Pointer"
- &k.driver; "mouse"
- </literallayout></listitem></varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- An &k.inputdevice; section is considered active if there is a
- reference to it in an active &k.serverlayout; section. An
- &k.inputdevice; section may also be referenced implicitly if there
- is no &k.serverlayout; section, if the <option>-screen</option> command
- line options is used, or if the &k.serverlayout; section doesn't
- reference any &k.inputdevice; sections. In this case, the first
- sections with drivers "keyboard" and "mouse" are used as the core
- keyboard and pointer respectively.
- </para>
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>&k.serverlayout; section</title>
-
- <para>
- The &k.serverlayout; section is a new section that is used to identify
- which &k.screen; sections are to be used in a multi-headed configuration,
- and the relative layout of those screens. It also identifies which
- &k.inputdevice; sections are to be used. Each &k.serverlayout; section
- has an identifier, a list of &k.screen; section identifiers, and a list of
- &k.inputdevice; section identifiers. &k.serverflags; options may also be
- included in a &k.serverlayout; section, making it possible to override
- the global values in the &k.serverflags; section.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- A &k.serverlayout; section can be made active by being referenced on
- the command line. In the absence of this, a default will be chosen
- (the first one found). The screen names may optionally be followed
- by a number specifying the preferred screen number, and optionally
- by information specifying the physical positioning of the screen,
- either in absolute terms or relative to another screen (or screens).
- When no screen number is specified, they are numbered according to
- the order in which they are listed. The old (now obsolete) method
- of providing the positioning information is to give the names of
- the four adjacent screens. The order of these is top, bottom, left,
- right. Here is an example of a &k.serverlayout; section for two
- screens using the old method, with the second located to the right
- of the first:
-
- <programlisting>
- Section "ServerLayout"
- Identifier "Main Layout"
- Screen 0 "Screen 1" "" "" "" "Screen 2"
- Screen 1 "Screen 2"
- Screen "Screen 3"
- EndSection
- </programlisting>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The preferred way of specifying the layout is to explicitly specify
- the screen's location in absolute terms or relative to another
- screen.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- In the absolute case, the upper left corner's coordinates are given
- after the <emphasis>Absolute</emphasis> keyword. If the coordinates are
- omitted, a value of <code>(0,0)</code> is assumed. An example
- of absolute positioning follows:
-
- <programlisting>
- Section "ServerLayout"
- Identifier "Main Layout"
- Screen 0 "Screen 1" Absolute 0 0
- Screen 1 "Screen 2" Absolute 1024 0
- Screen "Screen 3" Absolute 2048 0
- EndSection
- </programlisting>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- In the relative case, the position is specified by either using one of
- the following keywords followed by the name of the reference screen:
-
- <simplelist type='vert' columns='1'>
- <member><emphasis>RightOf</emphasis></member>
- <member><emphasis>LeftOf</emphasis></member>
- <member><emphasis>Above</emphasis></member>
- <member><emphasis>Below</emphasis></member>
- <member><emphasis>Relative</emphasis></member>
- </simplelist>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- When the <emphasis>Relative</emphasis> keyword is used, the reference screen
- name is followed by the coordinates of the new screen's origin
- relative to reference screen. The following example shows how to use
- some of the relative positioning options.
-
- <programlisting>
- Section "ServerLayout"
- Identifier "Main Layout"
- Screen 0 "Screen 1"
- Screen 1 "Screen 2" RightOf "Screen 1"
- Screen "Screen 3" Relative "Screen 1" 2048 0
- EndSection
- </programlisting>
- </para>
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>Options</title>
-
- <para>
- Options are used more extensively. They may appear in most sections
- now. Options related to drivers can be present in the &k.screen;,
- &k.device; and &k.monitor; sections and the &k.display; subsections.
- The order of precedence is &k.display;, &k.screen;, &k.monitor;,
- &k.device;. Options have been extended to allow an optional value
- to be specified in addition to the option name. For more details
- about options, see the <link linkend="options">Options</link> section
- for details.
- </para>
- </sect2>
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1>
- <title>Driver Interface</title>
-
- <para>
-The driver interface consists of a minimal set of entry points that are
-required based on the external events that the driver must react to.
-No non-essential structure is imposed on the way they are used beyond
-that. This is a significant difference compared with the old design.
- </para>
-
- <para>
-The entry points for drawing operations are already taken care of by
-the framebuffer code (including, XAA). Extensions and enhancements to
-framebuffer code are outside the scope of this document.
- </para>
-
- <para>
-This approach to the driver interface provides good flexibility, but does
-increase the complexity of drivers. To help address this, the XFree86
-common layer provides a set of <quote>helper</quote> functions to take care of things
-that most drivers need. These helpers help minimise the amount of code
-duplication between drivers. The use of helper functions by drivers is
-however optional, though encouraged. The basic philosophy behind the
-helper functions is that they should be useful to many drivers, that
-they should balance this against the complexity of their interface. It
-is inevitable that some drivers may find some helpers unsuitable and
-need to provide their own code.
- </para>
-
- <para>
-Events that a driver needs to react to are:
-
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry><term>ScreenInit</term>
-
- <listitem><para>
- An initialisation function is called from the DIX layer for each
- screen at the start of each server generation.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry><term>Enter VT</term>
-
- <listitem><para>
- The server takes control of the console.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry><term>Leave VT</term>
-
- <listitem><para>
- The server releases control of the console.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry><term>Mode Switch</term>
-
- <listitem><para>
- Change video mode.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry><term>ViewPort change</term>
-
- <listitem><para>
- Change the origin of the physical view port.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry><term>ScreenSaver state change</term>
-
- <listitem><para>
- Screen saver activation/deactivation.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry><term>CloseScreen</term>
-
- <listitem><para>
- A close screen function is called from the DIX layer for each screen
- at the end of each server generation.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
- </para>
-
-
- <para>
-In addition to these events, the following functions are required by
-the XFree86 common layer:
-
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry><term>Identify</term>
-
- <listitem><para>
- Print a driver identifying message.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry><term>Probe</term>
-
- <listitem><para>
- This is how a driver identifies if there is any hardware present that
- it knows how to drive.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry><term>PreInit</term>
-
- <listitem><para>
- Process information from the xorg.conf file, determine the
- full characteristics of the hardware, and determine if a valid
- configuration is present.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
- </para>
-
- <para>
-The VidMode extension also requires:
-
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry><term>ValidMode</term>
-
- <listitem><para>
- Identify if a new mode is usable with the current configuration.
- The PreInit function (and/or helpers it calls) may also make use
- of the ValidMode function or something similar.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
- </para>
-
-
- <para>
-Other extensions may require other entry points. The drivers will
-inform the common layer of these in such cases.
- </para>
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1>
- <title>Resource Access Control Introduction</title>
-
- <para>
-Graphics devices are accessed through ranges in I/O or memory space.
-While most modern graphics devices allow relocation of such ranges many
-of them still require the use of well established interfaces such as
-VGA memory and IO ranges or 8514/A IO ranges. With modern buses (like
-PCI) it is possible for multiple video devices to share access to these
-resources. The RAC (Resource Access Control) subsystem provides a
-mechanism for this.
- </para>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>Terms and Definitions</title>
-
- <sect3>
- <title>Bus</title>
-
- <para>
- <quote>Bus</quote> is ambiguous as it is used for different things: it may refer
- to physical incompatible extension connectors in a computer system.
- The RAC system knows two such systems: The ISA bus and the PCI bus.
- (On the software level EISA, MCA and VL buses are currently treated
- like ISA buses). <quote>Bus</quote> may also refer to logically different
- entities on a single bus system which are connected via bridges. A
- PCI system may have several distinct PCI buses connecting each other
- by PCI-PCI bridges or to the host CPU by HOST-PCI bridges.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Systems that host more than one bus system link these together using
- bridges. Bridges are a concern to RAC as they might block or pass
- specific resources. PCI-PCI bridges may be set up to pass VGA
- resources to the secondary bus. PCI-ISA buses pass any resources not
- decoded on the primary PCI bus to the ISA bus. This way VGA resources
- (although exclusive on the ISA bus) can be shared by ISA and PCI
- cards. Currently HOST-PCI bridges are not yet handled by RAC as they
- require specific drivers.
- </para>
- </sect3>
-
- <sect3>
- <title>Entity</title>
-
- <para>
- The smallest independently addressable unit on a system bus is
- referred to as an entity. So far we know ISA and PCI entities. PCI
- entities can be located on the PCI bus by an unique ID consisting of
- the bus, card and function number.
- </para>
- </sect3>
-
- <sect3>
- <title>Resource</title>
-
- <para>
- <quote>Resource</quote> refers to a range of memory or I/O addresses an entity
- can decode.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- If a device is capable of disabling this decoding the resource is
- called sharable. For PCI devices a generic method is provided to
- control resource decoding. Other devices will have to provide a
- device specific function to control decoding.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- If the entity is capable of decoding this range at a different
- location this resource is considered relocatable.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Resources which start at a specific address and occupy a single
- continuous range are called block resources.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Alternatively resource addresses can be decoded in a way that they
- satisfy the conditions:
- <programlisting>
- address & mask == base
- </programlisting>
- and
- <programlisting>
- base & mask == base
- </programlisting>
- Resources addressed in such a way are called sparse resources.
- </para>
-
- </sect3>
-
- <sect3>
- <title>Server States</title>
-
- <para>
- The resource access control system knows two server states: the
- SETUP and the OPERATING state. The SETUP state is entered whenever
- a mode change takes place or the server exits or does VT switching.
- During this state all entity resources are under resource access
- control. During OPERATING state only those entities are controlled
- which actually have shared resources that conflict with others.
- </para>
- </sect3>
- </sect2>
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1>
- <title>Control Flow in the Server and Mandatory Driver Functions</title>
-
- <para>
-At the start of each server generation, <function>main()</function>
-(<filename>dix/main.c</filename>) calls the DDX function
-<function>InitOutput()</function>. This is the first place that the DDX gets
-control. <function>InitOutput()</function> is expected to fill in the global
-<structname>screenInfo</structname> struct, and one
-<structfield>screenInfo.screen[]</structfield> entry for each screen present.
-Here is what <function>InitOutput()</function> does:
- </para>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>Parse the xorg.conf file</title>
-
- <para>
- This is done at the start of the first server generation only.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The xorg.conf file is read in full, and the resulting information
- stored in data structures. None of the parsed information is
- processed at this point. The parser data structures are opaque to
- the video drivers and to most of the common layer code.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The entire file is parsed first to remove any section ordering
- requirements.
- </para>
- </sect2>
-
-
- <sect2>
- <title>Initial processing of parsed information and command line options
- </title>
-
- <para>
- This is done at the start of the first server generation only.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The initial processing is to determine paths like the
- <emphasis>ModulePath</emphasis>, etc, and to determine which &k.serverlayout;,
- &k.screen; and &k.device; sections are active.
- </para>
- </sect2>
-
-
- <sect2>
- <title>Enable port I/O access</title>
-
- <para>
- Port I/O access is controlled from the XFree86 common layer, and is
- <quote>all or nothing</quote>. It is enabled prior to calling driver probes, at
- the start of subsequent server generations, and when VT switching
- back to the Xserver. It is disabled at the end of server generations,
- and when VT switching away from the Xserver.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The implementation details of this may vary on different platforms.
- </para>
- </sect2>
-
-
- <sect2>
- <title>General bus probe</title>
-
- <para>
- This is done at the start of the first server generation only.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- In the case of ix86 machines, this will be a general PCI probe.
- The full information obtained here will be available to the drivers.
- This information persists for the life of the Xserver. In the PCI
- case, the PCI information for all video cards found is available by
- calling <function>xf86GetPciVideoInfo()</function>.
- </para>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- pciVideoPtr *xf86GetPciVideoInfo(void);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- returns a pointer to a list of pointers to
- <structname>pciVideoRec</structname> entries, of which there is one for
- each detected PCI video card. The list is terminated with a
- <constant>NULL</constant> pointer. If no PCI video cards were
- detected, the return value is <constant>NULL</constant>.
-
- </para></blockquote>
- </para></blockquote>
-
- <para>
- After the bus probe, the resource broker is initialised.
- </para>
- </sect2>
-
-
- <sect2>
- <title>Load initial set of modules</title>
-
- <para>
- This is done at the start of the first server generation only.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The core server contains a list of mandatory modules. These are loaded
- first. Currently the only module on this list is the bitmap font module.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The next set of modules loaded are those specified explicitly in the
- &k.module; section of the config file.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The final set of initial modules are the driver modules referenced
- by the active &k.device; and &k.inputdevice; sections in the config
- file. Each of these modules is loaded exactly once.
- </para>
- </sect2>
-
-
- <sect2>
- <title>Register Video and Input Drivers</title>
-
- <para>
- This is done at the start of the first server generation only.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- When a driver module is loaded, the loader calls its
- <function>Setup</function> function. For video drivers, this function
- calls <function>xf86AddDriver()</function> to register the driver's
- <structname>DriverRec</structname>, which contains a small set of essential
- details and driver entry points required during the early phase of
- <function>InitOutput()</function>. <function>xf86AddDriver()</function>
- adds it to the global <varname>xf86DriverList[]</varname> array.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The <structname>DriverRec</structname> contains the driver canonical name,
- the <function>Identify()</function>,
- <function>Probe()</function> and <function>AvailableOptions()</function>
- function entry points as well as a pointer
- to the driver's module (as returned from the loader when the driver
- was loaded) and a reference count which keeps track of how many
- screens are using the driver. The entry driver entry points are
- those required prior to the driver allocating and filling in its
- <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- For a static server, the <varname>xf86DriverList[]</varname> array is
- initialised at build time, and the loading of modules is not done.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- A similar procedure is used for input drivers. The input driver's
- <function>Setup</function> function calls
- <function>xf86AddInputDriver()</function> to register the driver's
- <structname>InputDriverRec</structname>, which contains a small set of
- essential details and driver entry points required during the early
- phase of <function>InitInput()</function>.
- <function>xf86AddInputDriver()</function> adds it to the global
- <varname>xf86InputDriverList[]</varname> array. For a static server,
- the <varname>xf86InputDriverList[]</varname> array is initialised at
- build time.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Both the <varname>xf86DriverList[]</varname> and
- <varname>xf86InputDriverList[]</varname> arrays have been initialised
- by the end of this stage.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Once all the drivers are registered, their
- <function>ChipIdentify()</function> functions are called.
- </para>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void ChipIdentify(int flags);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This is expected to print a message indicating the driver name,
- a short summary of what it supports, and a list of the chipset
- names that it supports. It may use the xf86PrintChipsets() helper
- to do this.
- </para></blockquote>
- </para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void xf86PrintChipsets(const char *drvname, const char *drvmsg,
- SymTabPtr chips);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function provides an easy way for a driver's ChipIdentify
- function to format the identification message.
- </para></blockquote>
- </para></blockquote>
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>Initialise Access Control</title>
-
- <para>
- This is done at the start of the first server generation only.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The Resource Access Control (RAC) subsystem is initialised before
- calling any driver functions that may access hardware. All generic
- bus information is probed and saved (for restoration later). All
- (shared resource) video devices are disabled at the generic bus
- level, and a probe is done to find the <quote>primary</quote> video device. These
- devices remain disabled for the next step.
- </para>
- </sect2>
-
-
- <sect2 id="probe">
- <title>Video Driver Probe</title>
-
- <para>
- This is done at the start of the first server generation only. The
- <function>ChipProbe()</function> function of each registered video driver
- is called.
- </para>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- Bool ChipProbe(DriverPtr drv, int flags);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- The purpose of this is to identify all instances of hardware
- supported by the driver. The flags value is currently either 0,
- <constant>PROBE_DEFAULT</constant> or <constant>PROBE_DETECT</constant>.
- <constant>PROBE_DETECT</constant> is used if "-configure" or "-probe"
- command line arguments are given and indicates to the
- <function>Probe()</function> function that it should not configure the
- bus entities and that no xorg.conf information is available.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The probe must find the active device sections that match the
- driver by calling <function>xf86MatchDevice()</function>. The number
- of matches found limits the maximum number of instances for this
- driver. If no matches are found, the function should return
- <constant>FALSE</constant> immediately.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Devices that cannot be identified by using device-independent
- methods should be probed at this stage (keeping in mind that access
- to all resources that can be disabled in a device-independent way
- are disabled during this phase). The probe must be a minimal
- probe. It should just determine if there is a card present that
- the driver can drive. It should use the least intrusive probe
- methods possible. It must not do anything that is not essential,
- like probing for other details such as the amount of memory
- installed, etc. It is recommended that the
- <function>xf86MatchPciInstances()</function> helper function be used
- for identifying matching PCI devices, and similarly the
- <function>xf86MatchIsaInstances()</function> for ISA (non-PCI) devices
- (see the <link linkend="rac">RAC</link> section). These helpers also
- checks and claims the appropriate entity. When not using the
- helper, that should be done with <function>xf86CheckPciSlot()</function>
- and <function>xf86ClaimPciSlot()</function> for PCI devices and
- <function>xf86ClaimIsaSlot()</function> for ISA devices (see the
- <link linkend="rac">RAC</link> section).
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The probe must register all non-relocatable resources at this
- stage. If a resource conflict is found between exclusive resources
- the driver will fail immediately. This is usually best done with
- the <function>xf86ConfigPciEntity()</function> helper function
- for PCI and <function>xf86ConfigIsaEntity()</function> for ISA
- (see the <link linkend="rac">RAC</link> section). It is possible to
- register some entity specific functions with those helpers. When
- not using the helpers, the <function>xf86AddEntityToScreen()</function>
- <function>xf86ClaimFixedResources()</function> and
- <function>xf86SetEntityFuncs()</function> should be used instead (see
- the <link linkend="rac">RAC</link> section).
- </para>
-
- <para>
- If a chipset is specified in an active device section which the
- driver considers relevant (ie it has no driver specified, or the
- driver specified matches the driver doing the probe), the Probe
- must return <constant>FALSE</constant> if the chipset doesn't match
- one supported by the driver.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- If there are no active device sections that the driver considers
- relevant, it must return <constant>FALSE</constant>.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Allocate a <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> for each active instance of the
- hardware found, and fill in the basic information, including the
- other driver entry points. This is best done with the
- <function>xf86ConfigIsaEntity()</function> helper function for ISA
- instances or <function>xf86ConfigPciEntity()</function> for PCI instances.
- These functions allocate a <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> for active
- entities. Optionally <function>xf86AllocateScreen()</function>
- function may also be used to allocate the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>.
- Any of these functions take care of initialising fields to defined
- <quote>unused</quote> values.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Claim the entities for each instance of the hardware found. This
- prevents other drivers from claiming the same hardware.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Must leave hardware in the same state it found it in, and must not
- do any hardware initialisation.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- All detection can be overridden via the config file, and that
- parsed information is available to the driver at this stage.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Returns <constant>TRUE</constant> if one or more instances are found,
- and <constant>FALSE</constant> otherwise.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- int xf86MatchDevice(const char *drivername,
- GDevPtr **driversectlist)
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function takes the name of the driver and returns via
- <parameter>driversectlist</parameter> a list of device sections that
- match the driver name. The function return value is the number
- of matches found. If a fatal error is encountered the return
- value is <literal>-1</literal>.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The caller should use <function>xfree()</function> to free
- <parameter>*driversectlist</parameter> when it is no longer needed.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- ScrnInfoPtr xf86AllocateScreen(DriverPtr drv, int flags)
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function allocates a new <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> in the
- <varname>xf86Screens[]</varname> array. This function is normally
- called by the video driver <function>ChipProbe()</function> functions.
- The return value is a pointer to the newly allocated
- <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>. The <structfield>scrnIndex</structfield>,
- <structfield>origIndex</structfield>, <structfield>module</structfield> and
- <structfield>drv</structfield> fields are initialised. The reference count
- in <parameter>drv</parameter> is incremented. The storage for any
- currently allocated <quote>privates</quote> pointers is also allocated and
- the <structfield>privates</structfield> field initialised (the privates data
- is of course not allocated or initialised). This function never
- returns on failure. If the allocation fails, the server exits
- with a fatal error. The flags value is not currently used, and
- should be set to zero.
- </para></blockquote>
- </para></blockquote>
-
- <para>
- At the completion of this, a list of <structname>ScrnInfoRecs</structname>
- have been allocated in the <varname>xf86Screens[]</varname> array, and
- the associated entities and fixed resources have been claimed. The
- following <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> fields must be initialised at
- this point:
-
- <literallayout>
- driverVersion
- driverName
- scrnIndex(*)
- origIndex(*)
- drv(*)
- module(*)
- name
- Probe
- PreInit
- ScreenInit
- EnterVT
- LeaveVT
- numEntities
- entityList
- access
- </literallayout>
-
- <literal>(*)</literal> These are initialised when the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>
- is allocated, and not explicitly by the driver.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The following <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> fields must be initialised
- if the driver is going to use them:
-
- <literallayout>
- SwitchMode
- AdjustFrame
- FreeScreen
- ValidMode
- </literallayout>
- </para>
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>Matching Screens</title>
-
- <para>
- This is done at the start of the first server generation only.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- After the Probe phase is finished, there will be some number of
- <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>s. These are then matched with the active
- &k.screen; sections in the xorg.conf, and those not having an active
- &k.screen; section are deleted. If the number of remaining screens
- is 0, <function>InitOutput()</function> sets
- <structfield>screenInfo.numScreens</structfield> to <constant>0</constant> and
- returns.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- At this point the following fields of the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>s
- must be initialised:
-
- <literallayout>
- confScreen
- </literallayout>
- </para>
-
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>Allocate non-conflicting resources</title>
-
- <para>
- This is done at the start of the first server generation only.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Before calling the drivers again, the resource information collected
- from the Probe phase is processed. This includes checking the extent
- of PCI resources for the probed devices, and resolving any conflicts
- in the relocatable PCI resources. It also reports conflicts, checks
- bus routing issues, and anything else that is needed to enable the
- entities for the next phase.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- If any drivers registered an <function>EntityInit()</function> function
- during the Probe phase, then they are called here.
- </para>
-
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>Sort the Screens and pre-check Monitor Information</title>
-
- <para>
- This is done at the start of the first server generation only.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The list of screens is sorted to match the ordering requested in the
- config file.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The list of modes for each active monitor is checked against the
- monitor's parameters. Invalid modes are pruned.
- </para>
-
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>PreInit</title>
-
- <para>
- This is done at the start of the first server generation only.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- For each <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>, enable access to the screens entities and call
- the <function>ChipPreInit()</function> function.
- </para>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- Bool ChipPreInit(ScrnInfoRec screen, int flags);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- The purpose of this function is to find out all the information
- required to determine if the configuration is usable, and to
- initialise those parts of the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> that
- can be set once at the beginning of the first server generation.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The number of entities registered for the screen should be checked
- against the expected number (most drivers expect only one). The
- entity information for each of them should be retrieved (with
- <function>xf86GetEntityInfo()</function>) and checked for the correct
- bus type and that none of the sharable resources registered during
- the Probe phase was rejected.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Access to resources for the entities that can be controlled in a
- device-independent way are enabled before this function is called.
- If the driver needs to access any resources that it has disabled
- in an <function>EntityInit()</function> function that it registered,
- then it may enable them here providing that it disables them before
- this function returns.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- This includes probing for video memory, clocks, ramdac, and all
- other HW info that is needed. It includes determining the
- depth/bpp/visual and related info. It includes validating and
- determining the set of video modes that will be used (and anything
- that is required to determine that).
- </para>
-
- <para>
- This information should be determined in the least intrusive way
- possible. The state of the HW must remain unchanged by this
- function. Although video memory (including MMIO) may be mapped
- within this function, it must be unmapped before returning. Driver
- specific information should be stored in a structure hooked into
- the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>'s <structfield>driverPrivate</structfield>
- field. Any other modules which require persistent data (ie data
- that persists across server generations) should be initialised in
- this function, and they should allocate a <quote>privates</quote> index to
- hook their data into by calling
- <function>xf86AllocateScrnInfoPrivateIndex()</function>. The <quote>privates</quote>
- data is persistent.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Helper functions for some of these things are provided at the
- XFree86 common level, and the driver can choose to make use of
- them.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- All additional resources that the screen needs must be registered
- here. This should be done with
- <function>xf86RegisterResources()</function>. If some of the fixed
- resources registered in the Probe phase are not needed or not
- decoded by the hardware when in the OPERATING server state, their
- status should be updated with
- <function>xf86SetOperatingState()</function>.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Modules may be loaded at any point in this function, and all
- modules that the driver will need must be loaded before the end
- of this function. Either the <function>xf86LoadSubModule()</function>
- or the <function>xf86LoadDrvSubModule()</function> function should be
- used to load modules depending on whether a
- <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> has been set up. A driver may unload
- a module within this function if it was only needed temporarily,
- and the <function>xf86UnloadSubModule()</function> function should be used
- to do that. Otherwise there is no need to explicitly unload modules
- because the loader takes care of module dependencies and will
- unload submodules automatically if/when the driver module is
- unloaded.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The bulk of the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> fields should be filled
- out in this function.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- <function>ChipPreInit()</function> returns <constant>FALSE</constant> when
- the configuration is unusable in some way (unsupported depth, no
- valid modes, not enough video memory, etc), and <constant>TRUE</constant>
- if it is usable.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- It is expected that if the <function>ChipPreInit()</function> function
- returns <constant>TRUE</constant>, then the only reasons that subsequent
- stages in the driver might fail are lack or resources (like xalloc
- failures). All other possible reasons for failure should be
- determined by the <function>ChipPreInit()</function> function.
- </para></blockquote>
- </para></blockquote>
-
- <para>
- The <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>s for screens where the <function>ChipPreInit()</function> fails are removed.
- If none remain, <function>InitOutput()</function> sets <structfield>screenInfo.numScreens</structfield> to <constant>0</constant> and returns.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- At this point, further fields of the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>s would normally be
- filled in. Most are not strictly mandatory, but many are required
- by other layers and/or helper functions that the driver may choose
- to use. The documentation for those layers and helper functions
- indicates which they require.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The following fields of the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>s should be filled in if the
- driver is going to use them:
-
- <literallayout>
- monitor
- display
- depth
- pixmapBPP
- bitsPerPixel
- weight (>8bpp only)
- mask (>8bpp only)
- offset (>8bpp only)
- rgbBits (8bpp only)
- gamma
- defaultVisual
- maxHValue
- maxVValue
- virtualX
- virtualY
- displayWidth
- frameX0
- frameY0
- frameX1
- frameY1
- zoomLocked
- modePool
- modes
- currentMode
- progClock (TRUE if clock is programmable)
- chipset
- ramdac
- clockchip
- numClocks (if not programmable)
- clock[] (if not programmable)
- videoRam
- biosBase
- memBase
- memClk
- driverPrivate
- chipID
- chipRev
- </literallayout>
- </para>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- pointer xf86LoadSubModule(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, const char *name);
- and
- pointer xf86LoadDrvSubModule(DriverPtr drv, const char *name);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Load a module that a driver depends on. This function loads the
- module <parameter>name</parameter> as a sub module of the driver. The
- return value is a handle identifying the new module. If the load
- fails, the return value will be <constant>NULL</constant>. If a driver
- needs to explicitly unload a module it has loaded in this way,
- the return value must be saved and passed to
- <function>xf86UnloadSubModule()</function> when unloading.
-
- </para></blockquote>
- </para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void xf86UnloadSubModule(pointer module);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Unloads the module referenced by <parameter>module</parameter>.
- <parameter>module</parameter> should be a pointer returned previously
- by <function>xf86LoadSubModule()</function> or
- <function>xf86LoadDrvSubModule()</function> .
-
- </para></blockquote>
- </para></blockquote>
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>Cleaning up Unused Drivers</title>
-
- <para>
- At this point it is known which screens will be in use, and which
- drivers are being used. Unreferenced drivers (and modules they
- may have loaded) are unloaded here.
- </para>
-
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>Consistency Checks</title>
-
- <para>
- The parameters that must be global to the server, like pixmap formats,
- bitmap bit order, bitmap scanline unit and image byte order are
- compared for each of the screens. If a mismatch is found, the server
- exits with an appropriate message.
- </para>
-
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>Check if Resource Control is Needed</title>
-
- <para>
- Determine if resource access control is needed. This is the case
- if more than one screen is used. If necessary the RAC wrapper module
- is loaded.
- </para>
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>AddScreen (ScreenInit)</title>
-
- <para>
- At this point, the valid screens are known.
- <function>AddScreen()</function> is called for each of them, passing
- <function>ChipScreenInit()</function> as the argument.
- <function>AddScreen()</function> is a DIX function that allocates a new
- <structfield>screenInfo.screen[]</structfield> entry (aka
- <varname>pScreen</varname>), and does some basic initialisation of it.
- It then calls the <function>ChipScreenInit()</function> function, with
- <parameter>pScreen</parameter> as one of its arguments. If
- <function>ChipScreenInit()</function> returns <constant>FALSE</constant>,
- <function>AddScreen()</function> returns <constant>-1</constant>. Otherwise
- it returns the index of the screen. <function>AddScreen()</function>
- should only fail because of programming errors or failure to allocate
- resources (like memory). All configuration problems should be
- detected BEFORE this point.
- </para>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- Bool ChipScreenInit(int index, ScreenPtr pScreen,
- int argc, char **argv);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This is called at the start of each server generation.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Fill in all of <parameter>pScreen</parameter>, possibly doing some of
- this by calling ScreenInit functions from other layers like mi,
- framebuffers (cfb, etc), and extensions.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Decide which operations need to be placed under resource access
- control. The classes of operations are the frame buffer operations
- (<constant>RAC_FB</constant>), the pointer operations
- (<constant>RAC_CURSOR</constant>), the viewport change operations
- (<constant>RAC_VIEWPORT</constant>) and the colormap operations
- (<constant>RAC_COLORMAP</constant>). Any operation that requires
- resources which might be disabled during OPERATING state should
- be set to use RAC. This can be specified separately for memory
- and IO resources (the <structfield>racMemFlags</structfield> and
- <structfield>racIoFlags</structfield> fields of the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>
- respectively).
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Map any video memory or other memory regions.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Save the video card state. Enough state must be saved so that
- the original state can later be restored.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Initialise the initial video mode. The <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>'s
- <structfield>vtSema</structfield> field should be set to <constant>TRUE</constant>
- just prior to changing the video hardware's state.
-
- </para></blockquote>
- </para></blockquote>
-
-
- <para>
- The <function>ChipScreenInit()</function> function (or functions from other
- layers that it calls) should allocate entries in the
- <structname>ScreenRec</structname>'s <structfield>devPrivates</structfield> area by
- calling <function>AllocateScreenPrivateIndex()</function> if it needs
- per-generation storage. Since the <structname>ScreenRec</structname>'s
- <structfield>devPrivates</structfield> information is cleared for each server
- generation, this is the correct place to initialise it.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- After <function>AddScreen()</function> has successfully returned, the
- following <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> fields are initialised:
-
- <literallayout>
- pScreen
- racMemFlags
- racIoFlags
- </literallayout>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The <function>ChipScreenInit()</function> function should initialise the
- <structfield>CloseScreen</structfield> and <structfield>SaveScreen</structfield> fields
- of <parameter>pScreen</parameter>. The old value of
- <structfield>pScreen->CloseScreen</structfield> should be saved as part of
- the driver's per-screen private data, allowing it to be called from
- <function>ChipCloseScreen()</function>. This means that the existing
- <function>CloseScreen()</function> function is wrapped.
- </para>
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>Finalising RAC Initialisation</title>
-
- <para>
- After all the <function>ChipScreenInit()</function> functions have been
- called, each screen has registered its RAC requirements. This
- information is used to determine which shared resources are requested
- by more than one driver and set the access functions accordingly.
- This is done following these rules:
-
- <orderedlist>
- <listitem><para>
- The sharable resources registered by each entity are compared.
- If a resource is registered by more than one entity the entity
- will be marked to indicate that it needs to share this resources
- type (IO or MEM).
- </para></listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>
- A resource marked <quote>disabled</quote> during OPERATING state will be
- ignored entirely.
- </para></listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>
- A resource marked <quote>unused</quote> will only conflict with an overlapping
- resource of an other entity if the second is actually in use
- during OPERATING state.
- </para></listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>
- If an <quote>unused</quote> resource was found to conflict but the entity
- does not use any other resource of this type the entire resource
- type will be disabled for that entity.
- </para></listitem>
- </orderedlist>
- </para>
-
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>Finishing InitOutput()</title>
-
- <para>
- At this point <function>InitOutput()</function> is finished, and all the
- screens have been setup in their initial video mode.
- </para>
-
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>Mode Switching</title>
-
- <para>
- When a SwitchMode event is received, <function>ChipSwitchMode()</function>
- is called (when it exists):
- </para>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- Bool ChipSwitchMode(int index, DisplayModePtr mode, int flags);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Initialises the new mode for the screen identified by
- <parameter>index;</parameter>. The viewport may need to be adjusted
- also.
-
- </para></blockquote>
- </para></blockquote>
-
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>Changing Viewport</title>
-
- <para>
- When a Change Viewport event is received,
- <function>ChipAdjustFrame()</function> is called (when it exists):
- </para>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void ChipAdjustFrame(int index, int x, int y, int flags);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Changes the viewport for the screen identified by
- <parameter>index;</parameter>.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- It should be noted that many chipsets impose restrictions on where the
- viewport may be placed in the virtual resolution, either for alignment
- reasons, or to prevent the start of the viewport from being positioned
- within a pixel (as can happen in a 24bpp mode). After calculating the
- value the chipset's panning registers need to be set to for non-DGA
- modes, this function should recalculate the ScrnInfoRec's
- <structfield>frameX0</structfield>, <structfield>frameY0</structfield>, <structfield>frameX1</structfield>
- and <structfield>frameY1</structfield> fields to correspond to that value. If
- this is not done, switching to another mode might cause the position
- of a hardware cursor to change.
-
- </para></blockquote>
- </para></blockquote>
-
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>VT Switching</title>
-
- <para>
- When a VT switch event is received, <function>xf86VTSwitch()</function>
- is called. <function>xf86VTSwitch()</function> does the following:
-
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry><term>On ENTER:</term>
- <listitem>
- <itemizedlist>
- <listitem><para>
- enable port I/O access
- </para></listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>
- save and initialise the bus/resource state
- </para></listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>
- enter the SETUP server state
- </para></listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>
- calls <function>ChipEnterVT()</function> for each screen
- </para></listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>
- enter the OPERATING server state
- </para></listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>
- validate GCs
- </para></listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>
- Restore fb from saved pixmap for each screen
- </para></listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>
- Enable all input devices
- </para></listitem>
- </itemizedlist>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term>On LEAVE:</term>
- <listitem>
- <itemizedlist>
- <listitem><para>
- Save fb to pixmap for each screen
- </para></listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>
- validate GCs
- </para></listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>
- enter the SETUP server state
- </para></listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>
- calls <function>ChipLeaveVT()</function> for each screen
- </para></listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>
- disable all input devices
- </para></listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>
- restore bus/resource state
- </para></listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>
- disables port I/O access
- </para></listitem>
- </itemizedlist>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
- </para>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- Bool ChipEnterVT(int index, int flags);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function should initialise the current video mode and
- initialise the viewport, turn on the HW cursor if appropriate,
- etc.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Should it re-save the video state before initialising the video
- mode?
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void ChipLeaveVT(int index, int flags);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function should restore the saved video state. If
- appropriate it should also turn off the HW cursor, and invalidate
- any pixmap/font caches.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <para>
- Optionally, <function>ChipLeaveVT()</function> may also unmap memory
- regions. If so, <function>ChipEnterVT()</function> will need to remap
- them. Additionally, if an aperture used to access video memory is
- unmapped and remapped in this fashion, <function>ChipEnterVT()</function>
- will also need to notify the framebuffer layers of the aperture's new
- location in virtual memory. This is done with a call to the screen's
- <function>ModifyPixmapHeader()</function> function, as follows
- </para>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- (*pScreen->ModifyPixmapHeader)(pScrn->ppix,
- -1, -1, -1, -1, -1, NewApertureAddress);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- where the <structfield>ppix</structfield> field in a ScrnInfoRec
- points to the pixmap used by the screen's
- <function>SaveRestoreImage()</function> function to hold the screen's
- contents while switched out.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <para>
- Other layers may wrap the <function>ChipEnterVT()</function> and
- <function>ChipLeaveVT()</function> functions if they need to take some
- action when these events are received.
- </para>
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>End of server generation</title>
-
- <para>
- At the end of each server generation, the DIX layer calls
- <function>ChipCloseScreen()</function> for each screen:
- </para>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- Bool ChipCloseScreen(int index, ScreenPtr pScreen);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function should restore the saved video state and unmap the
- memory regions.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- It should also free per-screen data structures allocated by the
- driver. Note that the persistent data held in the
- <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>'s <structfield>driverPrivate</structfield> field
- should not be freed here because it is needed by subsequent server
- generations.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>'s <structfield>vtSema</structfield> field
- should be set to <constant>FALSE</constant> once the video HW state
- has been restored.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Before freeing the per-screen driver data the saved
- <structfield>CloseScreen</structfield> value should be restored to
- <structfield>pScreen->CloseScreen</structfield>, and that function should
- be called after freeing the data.
-
- </para></blockquote>
- </para></blockquote>
- </sect2>
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1>
- <title>Optional Driver Functions</title>
-
- <para>
-The functions outlined here can be called from the XFree86 common layer,
-but their presence is optional.
- </para>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>Mode Validation</title>
-
- <para>
- When a mode validation helper supplied by the XFree86-common layer is
- being used, it can be useful to provide a function to check for hw
- specific mode constraints:
- </para>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- ModeStatus ChipValidMode(int index, DisplayModePtr mode,
- Bool verbose, int flags);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Check the passed mode for hw-specific constraints, and return the
- appropriate status value.
-
- </para></blockquote>
- </para></blockquote>
-
- <para>
-This function may also modify the effective timings and clock of the passed
-mode. These have been stored in the mode's <structfield>Crtc*</structfield> and
-<structfield>SynthClock</structfield> elements, and have already been adjusted for
-interlacing, doublescanning, multiscanning and clock multipliers and dividers.
-The function should not modify any other mode field, unless it wants to modify
-the mode timings reported to the user by <function>xf86PrintModes()</function>.
- </para>
-
- <para>
-The function is called once for every mode in the xorg.conf Monitor section
-assigned to the screen, with <parameter>flags</parameter> set to
-<constant>MODECHECK_INITIAL</constant>. It is subsequently called for every mode
-in the xorg.conf Display subsection assigned to the screen, with
-<parameter>flags</parameter> set to <constant>MODECHECK_FINAL</constant>. In the second
-case, the mode will have successfully passed all other tests. In addition,
-the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>'s <structfield>virtualX</structfield>,
-<structfield>virtualY</structfield> and <structfield>displayWidth</structfield> fields will have been
-set as if the mode to be validated were to be the last mode accepted.
- </para>
-
- <para>
-In effect, calls with MODECHECK_INITIAL are intended for checks that do not
-depend on any mode other than the one being validated, while calls with
-MODECHECK_FINAL are intended for checks that may involve more than one mode.
- </para>
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>Free screen data</title>
-
- <para>
- When a screen is deleted prior to the completion of the ScreenInit
- phase the <function>ChipFreeScreen()</function> function is called when defined.
- </para>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void ChipFreeScreen(int scrnindex, int flags);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Free any driver-allocated data that may have been allocated up to
- and including an unsuccessful <function>ChipScreenInit()</function>
- call. This would predominantly be data allocated by
- <function>ChipPreInit()</function> that persists across server
- generations. It would include the <structfield>driverPrivate</structfield>,
- and any <quote>privates</quote> entries that modules may have allocated.
-
- </para></blockquote>
- </para></blockquote>
-
- </sect2>
-</sect1>
-
- <sect1>
- <title>Recommended driver functions</title>
-
- <para>
-The functions outlined here are for internal use by the driver only.
-They are entirely optional, and are never accessed directly from higher
-layers. The sample function declarations shown here are just examples.
-The interface (if any) used is up to the driver.
- </para>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>Save</title>
-
- <para>
- Save the video state. This could be called from <function>ChipScreenInit()</function> and
- (possibly) <function>ChipEnterVT()</function>.
- </para>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void ChipSave(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Saves the current state. This will only be saving pre-server
- states or states before returning to the server. There is only
- one current saved state per screen and it is stored in private
- storage in the screen.
-
- </para></blockquote>
- </para></blockquote>
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>Restore</title>
-
- <para>
- Restore the original video state. This could be called from the
- <function>ChipLeaveVT()</function> and <function>ChipCloseScreen()</function>
- functions.
- </para>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void ChipRestore(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Restores the saved state from the private storage. Usually only
- used for restoring text modes.
-
- </para></blockquote>
- </para></blockquote>
-
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>Initialise Mode</title>
-
- <para>
- Initialise a video mode. This could be called from the
- <function>ChipScreenInit()</function>, <function>ChipSwitchMode()</function>
- and <function>ChipEnterVT()</function> functions.
- </para>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- Bool ChipModeInit(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, DisplayModePtr mode);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Programs the hardware for the given video mode.
-
- </para></blockquote>
- </para></blockquote>
-
- </sect2>
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1>
- <title>Data and Data Structures</title>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>Command line data</title>
-
- <para>
-Command line options are typically global, and are stored in global
-variables. These variables are read-only and are available to drivers
-via a function call interface. Most of these command line values are
-processed via helper functions to ensure that they are treated consistently
-by all drivers. The other means of access is provided for cases where
-the supplied helper functions might not be appropriate.
- </para>
-
- <para>
-Some of them are:
-
- <literallayout>
- xf86Verbose verbosity level
- xf86Bpp -bpp from the command line
- xf86Depth -depth from the command line
- xf86Weight -weight from the command line
- xf86Gamma -{r,g,b,}gamma from the command line
- xf86FlipPixels -flippixels from the command line
- xf86ProbeOnly -probeonly from the command line
- defaultColorVisualClass -cc from the command line
- </literallayout>
- </para>
-
- <para>
-If we ever do allow for screen-specific command line options, we may
-need to rethink this.
- </para>
-
- <para>
-These can be accessed in a read-only manner by drivers with the following
-functions:
- </para>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- int xf86GetVerbosity();
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Returns the value of <varname>xf86Verbose</varname>.
- </para></blockquote>
-
- </para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- int xf86GetDepth();
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Returns the <option>-depth</option> command line setting. If not
- set on the command line, <constant>-1</constant> is returned.
- </para></blockquote>
-
- </para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- rgb xf86GetWeight();
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Returns the <option>-weight</option> command line setting. If not
- set on the command line, <literal remap="tt">{0, 0, 0}</literal> is returned.
- </para></blockquote>
-
- </para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- Gamma xf86GetGamma();
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Returns the <option>-gamma</option> or <option>-rgamma</option>,
- <option>-ggamma</option>, <option>-bgamma</option> command line settings.
- If not set on the command line, <literal remap="tt">{0.0, 0.0, 0.0}</literal>
- is returned.
- </para></blockquote>
-
- </para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- Bool xf86GetFlipPixels();
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Returns <constant>TRUE</constant> if <option>-flippixels</option> is
- present on the command line, and <constant>FALSE</constant> otherwise.
- </para></blockquote>
-
- </para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- const char *xf86GetServerName();
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Returns the name of the X server from the command line.
- </para></blockquote>
-
- </para></blockquote>
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>Data handling</title>
-
- <para>
-Config file data contains parts that are global, and parts that are
-Screen specific. All of it is parsed into data structures that neither
-the drivers or most other parts of the server need to know about.
- </para>
-
- <para>
-The global data is typically not required by drivers, and as such, most
-of it is stored in the private <structname>xf86InfoRec</structname>.
- </para>
-
- <para>
-The screen-specific data collected from the config file is stored in
-screen, device, display, monitor-specific data structures that are separate
-from the <varname>ScrnInfoRecs</varname>, with the appropriate elements/fields
-hooked into the <varname>ScrnInfoRecs</varname> as required. The screen
-config data is held in <structname>confScreenRec</structname>, device data in
-the <structname>GDevRec</structname>, monitor data in the <structname>MonRec</structname>,
-and display data in the <structname>DispRec</structname>.
- </para>
-
- <para>
-The XFree86 common layer's screen specific data (the actual data in use
-for each screen) is held in the <varname>ScrnInfoRecs</varname>. As has
-been outlined above, the <varname>ScrnInfoRecs</varname> are allocated at probe
-time, and it is the responsibility of the Drivers' <function>Probe()</function>
-and <function>PreInit()</function> functions to finish filling them in based
-on both data provided on the command line and data provided from the
-Config file. The precedence for this is:
-
- <blockquote><para>
- command line -> config file -> probed/default data
- </para></blockquote>
- </para>
-
- <para>
-For most things in this category there are helper functions that the
-drivers can use to ensure that the above precedence is consistently
-used.
- </para>
-
- <para>
-As well as containing screen-specific data that the XFree86 common layer
-(including essential parts of the server infrastructure as well as helper
-functions) needs to access, it also contains some data that drivers use
-internally. When considering whether to add a new field to the
-<structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>, consider the balance between the convenience
-of things that lots of drivers need and the size/obscurity of the
-<structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>.
- </para>
-
- <para>
-Per-screen driver specific data that cannot be accommodated with the
-static <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> fields is held in a driver-defined
-data structure, a pointer to which is assigned to the
-<structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>'s <structfield>driverPrivate</structfield> field. This
-is per-screen data that persists across server generations (as does the
-bulk of the static <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> data). It would typically
-also include the video card's saved state.
- </para>
-
- <para>
-Per-screen data for other modules that the driver uses (for example,
-the XAA module) that is reset for each server generation is hooked into
-the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> through it's <structfield>privates</structfield>
-field.
- </para>
-
- <para>
-Once it has stabilised, the data structures and variables accessible to
-video drivers will be documented here. In the meantime, those things
-defined in the <filename>xf86.h</filename> and <filename>xf86str.h</filename>
-files are visible to video drivers. Things defined in
-<filename>xf86Priv.h</filename> and <filename>xf86Privstr.h</filename> are NOT
-intended to be visible to video drivers, and it is an error for a driver
-to include those files.
- </para>
-
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>Accessing global data</title>
-
- <para>
-Some other global state information that the drivers may access via
-functions is as follows:
- </para>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- Bool xf86ServerIsExiting();
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Returns <constant>TRUE</constant> if the server is at the end of a
- generation and is in the process of exiting, and
- <constant>FALSE</constant> otherwise.
- </para></blockquote>
-
- </para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- Bool xf86ServerIsResetting();
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Returns <constant>TRUE</constant> if the server is at the end of a
- generation and is in the process of resetting, and
- <constant>FALSE</constant> otherwise.
- </para></blockquote>
-
- </para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- Bool xf86ServerIsInitialising();
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Returns <constant>TRUE</constant> if the server is at the beginning of
- a generation and is in the process of initialising, and
- <constant>FALSE</constant> otherwise.
- </para></blockquote>
-
- </para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- Bool xf86ServerIsOnlyProbing();
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Returns <constant>TRUE</constant> if the -probeonly command line flag
- was specified, and <constant>FALSE</constant> otherwise.
- </para></blockquote>
-
- </para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- Bool xf86CaughtSignal();
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Returns <constant>TRUE</constant> if the server has caught a signal,
- and <constant>FALSE</constant> otherwise.
- </para></blockquote>
-
- </para></blockquote>
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>Allocating private data</title>
-
- <para>
-A driver and any module it uses may allocate per-screen private storage
-in either the <structname>ScreenRec</structname> (DIX level) or
-<structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> (XFree86 common layer level).
-<structname>ScreenRec</structname> storage persists only for a single server
-generation, and <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> storage persists across
-generations for the lifetime of the server.
- </para>
-
- <para>
-The <structname>ScreenRec</structname> <structfield>devPrivates</structfield> data must be
-reallocated/initialised at the start of each new generation. This is
-normally done from the <function>ChipScreenInit()</function> function, and
-Init functions for other modules that it calls. Data allocated in this
-way should be freed by the driver's <function>ChipCloseScreen()</function>
-functions, and Close functions for other modules that it calls. A new
-<structfield>devPrivates</structfield> entry is allocated by calling the
-<function>AllocateScreenPrivateIndex()</function> function.
- </para>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- int AllocateScreenPrivateIndex();
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function allocates a new element in the
- <structfield>devPrivates</structfield> field of all currently existing
- <literal remap="tt">ScreenRecs</literal>. The return value is the index of this
- new element in the <structfield>devPrivates</structfield> array. The
- <structfield>devPrivates</structfield> field is of type
- <structname>DevUnion</structname>:
-
- <programlisting>
- typedef union _DevUnion {
- pointer ptr;
- long val;
- unsigned long uval;
- pointer (*fptr)(void);
- } DevUnion;
- </programlisting>
-
- which allows the element to be used for any of the above types.
- It is commonly used as a pointer to data that the caller allocates
- after the new index has been allocated.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- This function will return <constant>-1</constant> when there is an
- error allocating the new index.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote>
- </para></blockquote>
-
- <para>
-The <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> <structfield>privates</structfield> data persists
-for the life of the server, so only needs to be allocated once. This
-should be done from the <function>ChipPreInit()</function> function, and Init
-functions for other modules that it calls. Data allocated in this way
-should be freed by the driver's <function>ChipFreeScreen()</function> functions,
-and Free functions for other modules that it calls. A new
-<structfield>privates</structfield> entry is allocated by calling the
-<function>xf86AllocateScrnInfoPrivateIndex()</function> function.
- </para>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- int xf86AllocateScrnInfoPrivateIndex();
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function allocates a new element in the <structfield>privates</structfield>
- field of all currently existing <varname>ScrnInfoRecs</varname>.
- The return value is the index of this new element in the
- <structfield>privates</structfield> array. The <structfield>privates</structfield>
- field is of type <structfield>DevUnion</structfield>:
-
- <programlisting>
- typedef union _DevUnion {
- pointer ptr;
- long val;
- unsigned long uval;
- pointer (*fptr)(void);
- } DevUnion;
- </programlisting>
-
- which allows the element to be used for any of the above types.
- It is commonly used as a pointer to data that the caller allocates
- after the new index has been allocated.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- This function will not return when there is an error allocating
- the new index. When there is an error it will cause the server
- to exit with a fatal error. The similar function for allocation
- privates in the <structname>ScreenRec</structname>
- (<function>AllocateScreenPrivateIndex()</function>) differs in this
- respect by returning <constant>-1</constant> when the allocation fails.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote>
- </para></blockquote>
- </sect2>
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1 id="rac">
- <title>Keeping Track of Bus Resources</title>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>Theory of Operation</title>
-
- <para>
-The XFree86 common layer has knowledge of generic access control mechanisms
-for devices on certain bus systems (currently the PCI bus) as well as
-of methods to enable or disable access to the buses itself. Furthermore
-it can access information on resources decoded by these devices and if
-necessary modify it.
- </para>
-
- <para>
-When first starting the Xserver collects all this information, saves it
-for restoration, checks it for consistency, and if necessary, corrects
-it. Finally it disables all resources on a generic level prior to
-calling any driver function.
- </para>
-
- <para>
-When the <function>Probe()</function> function of each driver is called the
-device sections are matched against the devices found in the system.
-The driver may probe devices at this stage that cannot be identified by
-using device independent methods. Access to all resources that can be
-controlled in a device independent way is disabled. The
-<function>Probe()</function> function should register all non-relocatable
-resources at this stage. If a resource conflict is found between
-exclusive resources the driver will fail immediately. Optionally the
-driver might specify an <function>EntityInit()</function>,
-<function>EntityLeave()</function> and <function>EntityEnter()</function> function.
- </para>
-
- <para>
-<function>EntityInit()</function> can be used to disable any shared resources
-that are not controlled by the generic access control functions. It is
-called prior to the PreInit phase regardless if an entity is active or
-not. When calling the <function>EntityInit()</function>,
-<function>EntityEnter()</function> and <function>EntityLeave()</function> functions
-the common level will disable access to all other entities on a generic
-level. Since the common level has no knowledge of device specific
-methods to disable access to resources it cannot be guaranteed that
-certain resources are not decoded by any other entity until the
-<function>EntityInit()</function> or <function>EntityEnter()</function> phase is
-finished. Device drivers should therefore register all those resources
-which they are going to disable. If these resources are never to be
-used by any driver function they may be flagged <constant>ResInit</constant>
-so that they can be removed from the resource list after processing all
-<function>EntityInit()</function> functions. <function>EntityEnter()</function>
-should disable decoding of all resources which are not registered as
-exclusive and which are not handled by the generic access control in
-the common level. The difference to <function>EntityInit()</function> is
-that the latter one is only called once during lifetime of the server.
-It can therefore be used to set up variables prior to disabling resources.
-<function>EntityLeave()</function> should restore the original state when
-exiting the server or switching to a different VT. It also needs to
-disable device specific access functions if they need to be disabled on
-server exit or VT switch. The default state is to enable them before
-giving up the VT.
- </para>
-
- <para>
-In <function>PreInit()</function> phase each driver should check if any
-sharable resources it has registered during <function>Probe()</function> has
-been denied and take appropriate action which could simply be to fail.
-If it needs to access resources it has disabled during
-<function>EntitySetup()</function> it can do so provided it has registered
-these and will disable them before returning from
-<function>PreInit()</function>. This also applies to all other driver
-functions. Several functions are provided to request resource ranges,
-register these, correct PCI config space and add replacements for the
-generic access functions. Resources may be marked <quote>disabled</quote> or
-<quote>unused</quote> during OPERATING stage. Although these steps could also be
-performed in <function>ScreenInit()</function>, this is not desirable.
- </para>
-
- <para>
-Following <function>PreInit()</function> phase the common level determines
-if resource access control is needed. This is the case if more than
-one screen is used. If necessary the RAC wrapper module is loaded. In
-<function>ScreenInit()</function> the drivers can decide which operations
-need to be placed under RAC. Available are the frame buffer operations,
-the pointer operations and the colormap operations. Any operation that
-requires resources which might be disabled during OPERATING state should
-be set to use RAC. This can be specified separately for memory and IO
-resources.
- </para>
-
- <para>
-When <function>ScreenInit()</function> phase is done the common level will
-determine which shared resources are requested by more than one driver
-and set the access functions accordingly. This is done following these
-rules:
-
- <orderedlist>
- <listitem><para>
- The sharable resources registered by each entity are compared. If
- a resource is registered by more than one entity the entity will be
- marked to need to share this resources type (<constant>IO</constant> or
- <constant>MEM</constant>).
- </para></listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>
- A resource marked <quote>disabled</quote> during OPERATING state will be ignored
- entirely.
- </para></listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>
- A resource marked <quote>unused</quote> will only conflicts with an overlapping
- resource of an other entity if the second is actually in use during
- OPERATING state.
- </para></listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>
- If an <quote>unused</quote> resource was found to conflict however the entity
- does not use any other resource of this type the entire resource type
- will be disabled for that entity.
- </para></listitem>
- </orderedlist>
- </para>
-
- <para>
-The driver has the choice among different ways to control access to
-certain resources:
-
- <orderedlist>
- <listitem><para>
- It can rely on the generic access functions. This is probably the
- most common case. Here the driver only needs to register any resource
- it is going to use.
- </para></listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>
- It can replace the generic access functions by driver specific
- ones. This will mostly be used in cases where no generic access
- functions are available. In this case the driver has to make sure
- these resources are disabled when entering the <function>PreInit()</function>
- stage. Since the replacement functions are registered in
- <function>PreInit()</function> the driver will have to enable these
- resources itself if it needs to access them during this state. The
- driver can specify if the replacement functions can control memory
- and/or I/O resources separately.
- </para></listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>
- The driver can enable resources itself when it needs them. Each
- driver function enabling them needs to disable them before it will
- return. This should be used if a resource which can be controlled
- in a device dependent way is only required during SETUP state. This
- way it can be marked <quote>unused</quote> during OPERATING state.
- </para></listitem>
- </orderedlist>
- </para>
-
- <para>
-A resource which is decoded during OPERATING state however never accessed
-by the driver should be marked unused.
- </para>
-
- <para>
-Since access switching latencies are an issue during Xserver operation,
-the common level attempts to minimize the number of entities that need
-to be placed under RAC control. When a wrapped operation is called,
-the <function>EnableAccess()</function> function is called before control is
-passed on. <function>EnableAccess()</function> checks if a screen is under
-access control. If not it just establishes bus routing and returns.
-If the screen needs to be under access control,
-<function>EnableAccess()</function> determines which resource types
-(<literal remap="tt">MEM</literal>, <literal remap="tt">IO</literal>) are required. Then it tests
-if this access is already established. If so it simply returns. If
-not it disables the currently established access, fixes bus routing and
-enables access to all entities registered for this screen.
- </para>
-
- <para>
-Whenever a mode switch or a VT-switch is performed the common level will
-return to SETUP state.
- </para>
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>Resource Types</title>
-
- <para>
-Resource have certain properties. When registering resources each range
-is accompanied by a flag consisting of the ORed flags of the different
-properties the resource has. Each resource range may be classified
-according to
-
- <itemizedlist>
- <listitem><para>
- its physical properties i.e., if it addresses
- memory (<constant>ResMem</constant>) or
- I/O space (<constant>ResIo</constant>),
- </para></listitem>
- <listitem><para>
- if it addresses a
- block (<constant>ResBlock</constant>) or
- sparse (<constant>ResSparse</constant>)
- range,
- </para></listitem>
- <listitem><para>
- its access properties.
- </para></listitem>
- </itemizedlist>
- </para>
-
- <para>
-There are two known access properties:
-
- <itemizedlist>
- <listitem><para>
- <constant>ResExclusive</constant>
- for resources which may not be shared with any other device and
- </para></listitem>
- <listitem><para>
- <constant>ResShared</constant>
- for resources which can be disabled and therefore can be shared.
- </para></listitem>
- </itemizedlist>
- </para>
-
- <para>
-If it is necessary to test a resource against any type a generic access
-type <constant>ResAny</constant> is provided. If this is set the resource
-will conflict with any resource of a different entity intersecting its
-range. Further it can be specified that a resource is decoded however
-never used during any stage (<constant>ResUnused</constant>) or during
-OPERATING state (<constant>ResUnusedOpr</constant>). A resource only visible
-during the init functions (ie. <function>EntityInit()</function>,
-<function>EntityEnter()</function> and <function>EntityLeave()</function> should
-be registered with the flag <constant>ResInit</constant>. A resource that
-might conflict with background resource ranges may be flagged with
-<constant>ResBios</constant>. This might be useful when registering resources
-ranges that were assigned by the system Bios.
- </para>
-
- <para>
-Several predefined resource lists are available for VGA and 8514/A
-resources in <filename>common/xf86Resources.h</filename>.
- </para>
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2 id="avail">
- <title>Available Functions</title>
-
- <para>
-The functions provided for resource management are listed in their order
-of use in the driver.
- </para>
-
- <sect3>
- <title>Probe Phase</title>
-
- <para>
-In this phase each driver detects those resources it is able to drive,
-creates an entity record for each of them, registers non-relocatable
-resources and allocates screens and adds the resources to screens.
- </para>
-
- <para>
-Two helper functions are provided for matching device sections in the
-xorg.conf file to the devices:
- </para>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- int xf86MatchPciInstances(const char *driverName, int vendorID,
- SymTabPtr chipsets, PciChipsets *PCIchipsets,
- GDevPtr *devList, int numDevs, DriverPtr drvp,
- int **foundEntities);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function finds matches between PCI cards that a driver supports
- and config file device sections. It is intended for use in the
- <function>ChipProbe()</function> function of drivers for PCI cards.
- Only probed PCI devices with a vendor ID matching
- <parameter>vendorID</parameter> are considered. <parameter>devList</parameter>
- and <parameter>numDevs</parameter> are typically those found from
- calling <function>xf86MatchDevice()</function>, and represent the active
- config file device sections relevant to the driver.
- <parameter>PCIchipsets</parameter> is a table that provides a mapping
- between the PCI device IDs, the driver's internal chipset tokens
- and a list of fixed resources.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- When a device section doesn't have a <emphasis>BusID</emphasis> entry it
- can only match the primary video device. Secondary devices are
- only matched with device sections that have a matching
- <emphasis>BusID</emphasis> entry.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Once the preliminary matches have been found, a final match is
- confirmed by checking if the chipset override, ChipID override or
- probed PCI chipset type match one of those given in the
- <parameter>chipsets</parameter> and <parameter>PCIchipsets</parameter> lists.
- The <parameter>PCIchipsets</parameter> list includes a list of the PCI
- device IDs supported by the driver. The list should be terminated
- with an entry with PCI ID <constant>-1</constant>". The
- <parameter>chipsets</parameter> list is a table mapping the driver's
- internal chipset tokens to names, and should be terminated with
- a <constant>NULL</constant> entry. Only those entries with a
- corresponding entry in the <parameter>PCIchipsets</parameter> list are
- considered. The order of precedence is: config file chipset,
- config file ChipID, probed PCI device ID.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- In cases where a driver handles PCI chipsets with more than one
- vendor ID, it may set <parameter>vendorID</parameter> to
- <constant>0</constant>, and OR each devID in the list with (the
- vendor ID << 16).
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Entity index numbers for confirmed matches are returned as an
- array via <parameter>foundEntities</parameter>. The PCI information,
- chipset token and device section for each match are found in the
- <structname>EntityInfoRec</structname> referenced by the indices.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The function return value is the number of confirmed matches. A
- return value of <constant>-1</constant> indicates an internal error.
- The returned <parameter>foundEntities</parameter> array should be freed
- by the driver with <function>xfree()</function> when it is no longer
- needed in cases where the return value is greater than zero.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- int xf86MatchIsaInstances(const char *driverName,
- SymTabPtr chipsets, IsaChipsets *ISAchipsets,
- DriverPtr drvp, FindIsaDevProc FindIsaDevice,
- GDevPtr *devList, int numDevs,
- int **foundEntities);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function finds matches between ISA cards that a driver supports
- and config file device sections. It is intended for use in the
- <function>ChipProbe()</function> function of drivers for ISA cards.
- <parameter>devList</parameter> and <parameter>numDevs</parameter> are
- typically those found from calling <function>xf86MatchDevice()</function>,
- and represent the active config file device sections relevant to
- the driver. <parameter>ISAchipsets</parameter> is a table that provides
- a mapping between the driver's internal chipset tokens and the
- resource classes. <parameter>FindIsaDevice</parameter> is a
- driver-provided function that probes the hardware and returns the
- chipset token corresponding to what was detected, and
- <constant>-1</constant> if nothing was detected.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- If the config file device section contains a chipset entry, then
- it is checked against the <parameter>chipsets</parameter> list. When
- no chipset entry is present, the <parameter>FindIsaDevice</parameter>
- function is called instead.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Entity index numbers for confirmed matches are returned as an
- array via <parameter>foundEntities</parameter>. The chipset token and
- device section for each match are found in the
- <structname>EntityInfoRec</structname> referenced by the indices.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The function return value is the number of confirmed matches. A
- return value of <constant>-1</constant> indicates an internal error.
- The returned <parameter>foundEntities</parameter> array should be freed
- by the driver with <function>xfree()</function> when it is no longer
- needed in cases where the return value is greater than zero.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <para>
-These two helper functions make use of several core functions that are
-available at the driver level:
- </para>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- Bool xf86ParsePciBusString(const char *busID, int *bus,
- int *device, int *func);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Takes a <parameter>BusID</parameter> string, and if it is in the correct
- format, returns the PCI <parameter>bus</parameter>, <parameter>device</parameter>,
- <parameter>func</parameter> values that it indicates. The format of the
- string is expected to be "PCI:bus:device:func" where each of <quote>bus</quote>,
- <quote>device</quote> and <quote>func</quote> are decimal integers. The ":func" part may
- be omitted, and the func value assumed to be zero, but this isn't
- encouraged. The "PCI" prefix may also be omitted. The prefix
- "AGP" is currently equivalent to the "PCI" prefix. If the string
- isn't a valid PCI BusID, the return value is <constant>FALSE</constant>.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- Bool xf86ComparePciBusString(const char *busID, int bus,
- int device, int func);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Compares a <parameter>BusID</parameter> string with PCI <parameter>bus</parameter>,
- <parameter>device</parameter>, <parameter>func</parameter> values. If they
- match <constant>TRUE</constant> is returned, and <constant>FALSE</constant>
- if they don't.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- Bool xf86ParseIsaBusString(const char *busID);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Compares a <parameter>BusID</parameter> string with the ISA bus ID string
- ("ISA" or "ISA:"). If they match <constant>TRUE</constant> is returned,
- and <constant>FALSE</constant> if they don't.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- Bool xf86CheckPciSlot(int bus, int device, int func);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Checks if the PCI slot <literal remap="tt">bus:device:func</literal> has been
- claimed. If so, it returns <constant>FALSE</constant>, and otherwise
- <constant>TRUE</constant>.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- int xf86ClaimPciSlot(int bus, int device, int func, DriverPtr drvp,
- int chipset, GDevPtr dev, Bool active);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function is used to claim a PCI slot, allocate the associated
- entity record and initialise their data structures. The return
- value is the index of the newly allocated entity record, or
- <constant>-1</constant> if the claim fails. This function should always
- succeed if <function>xf86CheckPciSlot()</function> returned
- <constant>TRUE</constant> for the same PCI slot.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- Bool xf86IsPrimaryPci(void);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function returns <constant>TRUE</constant> if the primary card is
- a PCI device, and <constant>FALSE</constant> otherwise.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- int xf86ClaimIsaSlot(DriverPtr drvp, int chipset,
- GDevPtr dev, Bool active);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This allocates an entity record entity and initialise the data
- structures. The return value is the index of the newly allocated
- entity record.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- Bool xf86IsPrimaryIsa(void);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function returns <constant>TRUE</constant> if the primary card is
- an ISA (non-PCI) device, and <constant>FALSE</constant> otherwise.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <para>
-Two helper functions are provided to aid configuring entities:
- </para>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- ScrnInfoPtr xf86ConfigPciEntity(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn,
- int scrnFlag, int entityIndex,
- PciChipsets *p_chip,
- resList res, EntityProc init,
- EntityProc enter, EntityProc leave,
- pointer private);
-
- ScrnInfoPtr xf86ConfigIsaEntity(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn,
- int scrnFlag, int entityIndex,
- IsaChipsets *i_chip,
- resList res, EntityProc init,
- EntityProc enter, EntityProc leave,
- pointer private);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- These functions are used to register the non-relocatable resources
- for an entity, and the optional entity-specific <parameter>Init</parameter>, <parameter>Enter</parameter> and
- <parameter>Leave</parameter> functions. Usually the list of fixed resources is obtained
- from the Isa/PciChipsets lists. However an additional list of
- resources may be passed. Generally this is not required.
- For active entities a <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> is allocated
- if the <parameter>pScrn</parameter> argument is <constant>NULL</constant>.
-The
- return value is <constant>TRUE</constant> when successful. The init, enter, leave
- functions are defined as follows:
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- typedef void (*EntityProc)(int entityIndex,
- pointer private);
- </programlisting>
- </para></blockquote>
-
- They are passed the entity index and a pointer to a private scratch
- area. This can be set up during <function>Probe()</function> and
- its address can be passed to
- <function>xf86ConfigIsaEntity()</function> and
- <function>xf86ConfigPciEntity()</function> as the last argument.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <para>
-These two helper functions make use of several core functions that are
-available at the driver level:
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void xf86ClaimFixedResources(resList list, int entityIndex);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function registers the non-relocatable resources which cannot
- be disabled and which therefore would cause the server to fail
- immediately if they were found to conflict. It also records
- non-relocatable but sharable resources for processing after the
- <function>Probe()</function> phase.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- Bool xf86SetEntityFuncs(int entityIndex, EntityProc init,
- EntityProc enter, EntityProc leave, pointer);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function registers with an entity the <parameter>init</parameter>,
- <parameter>enter</parameter>, <parameter>leave</parameter> functions along
- with the pointer to their private area.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void xf86AddEntityToScreen(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, int entityIndex);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function associates the entity referenced by
- <parameter>entityIndex</parameter> with the screen.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
- </para>
- </sect3>
-
- <sect3>
- <title>PreInit Phase</title>
-
- <para>
-During this phase the remaining resources should be registered.
-<function>PreInit()</function> should call <function>xf86GetEntityInfo()</function>
-to obtain a pointer to an <structname>EntityInfoRec</structname> for each entity
-it is able to drive and check if any resource are listed in its
-<structfield>resources</structfield> field. If resources registered in the Probe
-phase have been rejected in the post-Probe phase
-(<structfield>resources</structfield> is non-<constant>NULL</constant>), then the driver should
-decide if it can continue without using these or if it should fail.
- </para>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- EntityInfoPtr xf86GetEntityInfo(int entityIndex);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function returns a pointer to the <structname>EntityInfoRec</structname>
- referenced by <parameter>entityIndex</parameter>. The returned
- <structname>EntityInfoRec</structname> should be freed with
- <function>xfree()</function> when no longer needed.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <para>
-Several functions are provided to simplify resource registration:
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- Bool xf86IsEntityPrimary(int entityIndex);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function returns <constant>TRUE</constant> if the entity referenced
- by <parameter>entityIndex</parameter> is the primary display device (i.e.,
- the one initialised at boot time and used in text mode).
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- Bool xf86IsScreenPrimary(int scrnIndex);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function returns <constant>TRUE</constant> if the primary entity
- is registered with the screen referenced by
- <parameter>scrnIndex</parameter>.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- pciVideoPtr xf86GetPciInfoForEntity(int entityIndex);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function returns a pointer to the <structname>pciVideoRec</structname>
- for the specified entity. If the entity is not a PCI device,
- <constant>NULL</constant> is returned.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
- </para>
-
- <para>
-The primary function for registration of resources is:
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- resPtr xf86RegisterResources(int entityIndex, resList list,
- int access);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function tries to register the resources in
- <parameter>list</parameter>. If list is <constant>NULL</constant> it tries
- to determine the resources automatically. This only works for
- entities that provide a generic way to read out the resource ranges
- they decode. So far this is only the case for PCI devices. By
- default the PCI resources are registered as shared
- (<constant>ResShared</constant>) if the driver wants to set a different
- access type it can do so by specifying the access flags in the
- third argument. A value of <constant>0</constant> means to use the
- default settings. If for any reason the resource broker is not
- able to register some of the requested resources the function will
- return a pointer to a list of the failed ones. In this case the
- driver may be able to move the resource to different locations.
- In case of PCI bus entities this is done by passing the list of
- failed resources to <function>xf86ReallocatePciResources()</function>.
- When the registration succeeds, the return value is
- <constant>NULL</constant>.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
- </para>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- resPtr xf86ReallocatePciResources(int entityIndex, resPtr pRes);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function takes a list of PCI resources that need to be
- reallocated and returns <constant>NULL</constant> when all relocations are
- successful.
- <function>xf86RegisterResources()</function> should be called again to
- register the relocated resources with the broker.
- If the reallocation fails, a list of the resources that could not be
- relocated is returned.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
-<para>
-Two functions are provided to obtain a resource range of a given type:
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- resRange xf86GetBlock(long type, memType size,
- memType window_start, memType window_end,
- memType align_mask, resPtr avoid);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function tries to find a block range of size
- <parameter>size</parameter> and type <parameter>type</parameter> in a window
- bound by <parameter>window_start</parameter> and <parameter>window_end</parameter>
- with the alignment specified in <parameter>align_mask</parameter>.
- Optionally a list of resource ranges which should be avoided within
- the window can be supplied. On failure a zero-length range of
- type <constant>ResEnd</constant> will be returned.
- </para>
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- resRange xf86GetSparse(long type, memType fixed_bits,
- memType decode_mask, memType address_mask,
- resPtr avoid);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function is like the previous one, but attempts to find a
- sparse range instead of a block range. Here three values have to
- be specified: the <parameter>address_mask</parameter> which marks all
- bits of the mask part of the address, the <parameter>decode_mask</parameter>
- which masks out the bits which are hardcoded and are therefore
- not available for relocation and the values of the fixed bits.
- The function tries to find a base that satisfies the given condition.
- If the function fails it will return a zero range of type
- <constant>ResEnd</constant>. Optionally it might be passed a list of
- resource ranges to avoid.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
- </para>
-
- <para>
-Some PCI devices are broken in the sense that they return invalid size
-information for a certain resource. In this case the driver can supply
-the correct size and make sure that the resource range allocated for
-the card is large enough to hold the address range decoded by the card.
-The function <function>xf86FixPciResource()</function> can be used to do this:
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- Bool xf86FixPciResource(int entityIndex, unsigned int prt,
- CARD32 alignment, long type);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function fixes a PCI resource allocation. The
- <parameter>prt</parameter> parameter contains the number of the PCI base
- register that needs to be fixed (<constant>0-5</constant>, and
- <constant>6</constant> for the BIOS base register). The size is
- specified by the alignment. Since PCI resources need to span an
- integral range of size <literal remap="tt">2ˆn</literal>, the alignm ent also
- specifies the number of addresses that will be decoded. If the
- driver specifies a type mask it can override the default type for
- PCI resources which is <constant>ResShared</constant>. The resource
- broker needs to know that to find a matching resource range. This
- function should be called before calling
- <function>xf86RegisterResources()</function>. The return value is
- <constant>TRUE</constant> when the function succeeds.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- Bool xf86CheckPciMemBase(pciVideoPtr pPci, memType base);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function checks that the memory base address specified matches
- one of the PCI base address register values for the given PCI
- device. This is mostly used to check that an externally provided
- base address (e.g., from a config file) matches an actual value
- allocated to a device.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
- </para>
-
- <para>
-The driver may replace the generic access control functions for an entity.
-This is done with the <function>xf86SetAccessFuncs()</function>:
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void xf86SetAccessFuncs(EntityInfoPtr pEnt,
- xf86SetAccessFuncPtr funcs,
- xf86SetAccessFuncPtr oldFuncs);
- </programlisting>
- with:
- <programlisting>
- typedef struct {
- xf86AccessPtr mem;
- xf86AccessPtr io;
- xf86AccessPtr io_mem;
- } xf86SetAccessFuncRec, *xf86SetAccessFuncPtr;
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- The driver can pass three functions: one for I/O access, one for
- memory access and one for combined memory and I/O access. If the
- memory access and combined access functions are identical the
- common level assumes that the memory access cannot be controlled
- independently of I/O access, if the I/O access function and the
- combined access functions are the same it is assumed that I/O can
- not be controlled independently. If memory and I/O have to be
- controlled together all three values should be the same. If a
- non <constant>NULL</constant> value is passed as third argument it is
- interpreted as an address where to store the old access record.
- If the third argument is <constant>NULL</constant> it will be assumed
- that the generic access should be enabled before replacing the
- access functions. Otherwise it will be disabled. The driver may
- enable them itself using the returned values. It should do this
- from its replacement access functions as the generic access may
- be disabled by the common level on certain occasions. If replacement
- functions are specified they must control all resources of the
- specific type registered for the entity.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
- </para>
-
- <para>
-To find out if a specific resource range conflicts with another
-resource the <function>xf86ChkConflict()</function> function may be used:
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- memType xf86ChkConflict(resRange *rgp, int entityIndex);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function checks if the resource range <parameter>rgp</parameter> of
- for the specified entity conflicts with with another resource.
- If a conflict is found, the address of the start of the conflict
- is returned. The return value is zero when there is no conflict.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
- </para>
-
- <para>
-The OPERATING state properties of previously registered fixed resources
-can be set with the <function>xf86SetOperatingState()</function> function:
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- resPtr xf86SetOperatingState(resList list, int entityIndex,
- int mask);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function is used to set the status of a resource during
- OPERATING state. <parameter>list</parameter> holds a list to which
- <parameter>mask</parameter> is to be applied. The parameter
- <parameter>mask</parameter> may have the value <constant>ResUnusedOpr</constant>
- and <constant>ResDisableOpr</constant>. The first one should be used
- if a resource isn't used by the driver during OPERATING state
- although it is decoded by the device, while the latter one indicates
- that the resource is not decoded during OPERATING state. Note
- that the resource ranges have to match those specified during
- registration. If a range has been specified starting at
- <literal remap="tt">A</literal> and ending at <literal remap="tt">B</literal> and suppose
- <literal remap="tt">C</literal> us a value satisfying
- <literal remap="tt">A < C < B</literal> one may not
- specify the resource range <literal remap="tt">(A,B)</literal> by splitting it
- into two ranges <literal remap="tt">(A,C)</literal> and <literal remap="tt">(C,B)</literal>.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
- </para>
-
- <para>
-The following two functions are provided for special cases:
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void xf86RemoveEntityFromScreen(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, int entityIndex);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function may be used to remove an entity from a screen. This
- only makes sense if a screen has more than one entity assigned or
- the screen is to be deleted. No test is made if the screen has
- any entities left.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void xf86DeallocateResourcesForEntity(int entityIndex, long type);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function deallocates all resources of a given type registered
- for a certain entity from the resource broker list.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
- </para>
-
- </sect3>
-
- <sect3>
- <title>ScreenInit Phase</title>
-
- <para>
-All that is required in this phase is to setup the RAC flags. Note that
-it is also permissible to set these flags up in the PreInit phase. The
-RAC flags are held in the <structfield>racIoFlags</structfield> and <structfield>racMemFlags</structfield> fields of the
-<structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> for each screen. They specify which graphics operations
-might require the use of shared resources. This can be specified
-separately for memory and I/O resources. The available flags are defined
-in <filename>rac/xf86RAC.h</filename>. They are:
-
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry><term><constant>RAC_FB</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>
- for framebuffer operations (including hw acceleration)
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- <varlistentry><term><constant>RAC_CURSOR</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>
- for Cursor operations
- (??? I'm not sure if we need this for SW cursor it depends
- on which level the sw cursor is drawn)
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- <varlistentry><term><constant>RAC_COLORMAP</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>
- for colormap operations
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- <varlistentry><term><constant>RAC_VIEWPORT</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>
- for the call to <function>ChipAdjustFrame()</function>
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
-
-
-The flags are ORed together.
- </para>
- </sect3>
- </sect2>
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1 id="options">
- <title>Config file <quote>Option</quote> entries</title>
-
- <para>
-Option entries are permitted in most sections and subsections of the
-config file. There are two forms of option entries:
-
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry><term>Option "option-name"</term>
- <listitem><para>
- A boolean option.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- <varlistentry><term>Option "option-name" "option-value"</term>
- <listitem><para>
- An option with an arbitrary value.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
- </para>
-
- <para>
-The option entries are handled by the parser, and a list of the parsed
-options is included with each of the appropriate data structures that
-the drivers have access to. The data structures used to hold the option
-information are opaque to the driver, and a driver must not access the
-option data directly. Instead, the common layer provides a set of
-functions that may be used to access, check and manipulate the option
-data.
- </para>
-
- <para>
-First, the low level option handling functions. In most cases drivers
-would not need to use these directly.
- </para>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- pointer xf86FindOption(pointer options, const char *name);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Takes a list of options and an option name, and returns a handle
- for the first option entry in the list matching the name. Returns
- <constant>NULL</constant> if no match is found.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- char *xf86FindOptionValue(pointer options, const char *name);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Takes a list of options and an option name, and returns the value
- associated with the first option entry in the list matching the
- name. If the matching option has no value, an empty string
- (<constant>""</constant>) is returned. Returns <constant>NULL</constant>
- if no match is found.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void xf86MarkOptionUsed(pointer option);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Takes a handle for an option, and marks that option as used.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void xf86MarkOptionUsedByName(pointer options, const char *name);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Takes a list of options and an option name and marks the first
- option entry in the list matching the name as used.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <para>
-Next, the higher level functions that most drivers would use.
- </para>
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void xf86CollectOptions(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, pointer extraOpts);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Collect the options from each of the config file sections used by
- the screen (<parameter>pScrn</parameter>) and return the merged list as
- <structfield>pScrn->options</structfield>. This function requires that
- <structfield>pScrn->confScreen</structfield>, <structfield>pScrn->display</structfield>,
- <structfield>pScrn->monitor</structfield>,
- <structfield>pScrn->numEntities</structfield>, and
- <structfield>pScrn->entityList</structfield> are initialised.
- <parameter>extraOpts</parameter> may optionally be set to an additional
- list of options to be combined with the others. The order of
- precedence for options is <parameter>extraOpts</parameter>, display,
- confScreen, monitor, device.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void xf86ProcessOptions(int scrnIndex, pointer options,
- OptionInfoPtr optinfo);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Processes a list of options according to the information in the
- array of <structname>OptionInfoRecs</structname> (<parameter>optinfo</parameter>).
- The resulting information is stored in the <structfield>value</structfield>
- fields of the appropriate <parameter>optinfo</parameter> entries. The
- <structfield>found</structfield> fields are set to <constant>TRUE</constant>
- when an option with a value of the correct type if found, and
- <constant>FALSE</constant> otherwise. The <structfield>type</structfield> field
- is used to determine the expected value type for each option.
- Each option in the list of options for which there is a name match
- (but not necessarily a value type match) is marked as used.
- Warning messages are printed when option values don't match the
- types specified in the optinfo data.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- NOTE: If this function is called before a driver's screen number
- is known (e.g., from the <function>ChipProbe()</function> function) a
- <parameter>scrnIndex</parameter> value of <constant>-1</constant> should be
- used.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- NOTE 2: Given that this function stores into the
- <literal remap="tt">OptionInfoRecs</literal> pointed to by <parameter>optinfo</parameter>,
- the caller should ensure the <literal remap="tt">OptionInfoRecs</literal> are
- (re-)initialised before the call, especially if the caller expects
- to use the predefined option values as defaults.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The <structname>OptionInfoRec</structname> is defined as follows:
-
- <programlisting>
- typedef struct {
- double freq;
- int units;
- } OptFrequency;
-
- typedef union {
- unsigned long num;
- char * str;
- double realnum;
- Bool bool;
- OptFrequency freq;
- } ValueUnion;
-
- typedef enum {
- OPTV_NONE = 0,
- OPTV_INTEGER,
- OPTV_STRING, /* a non-empty string */
- OPTV_ANYSTR, /* Any string, including an empty one */
- OPTV_REAL,
- OPTV_BOOLEAN,
- OPTV_PERCENT,
- OPTV_FREQ
- } OptionValueType;
-
- typedef enum {
- OPTUNITS_HZ = 1,
- OPTUNITS_KHZ,
- OPTUNITS_MHZ
- } OptFreqUnits;
-
- typedef struct {
- int token;
- const char* name;
- OptionValueType type;
- ValueUnion value;
- Bool found;
- } OptionInfoRec, *OptionInfoPtr;
- </programlisting>
- </para>
- <para>
- <constant>OPTV_FREQ</constant> can be used for options values that are
- frequencies. These values are a floating point number with an
- optional unit name appended. The unit name can be one of "Hz",
- "kHz", "k", "MHz", "M". The multiplier associated with the unit
- is stored in <structfield>freq.units</structfield>, and the scaled frequency
- is stored in <structfield>freq.freq</structfield>. When no unit is specified,
- <structfield>freq.units</structfield> is set to <constant>0</constant>, and
- <structfield>freq.freq</structfield> is unscaled.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- <constant>OPTV_PERCENT</constant> can be used for option values that are
- specified in percent (e.g. "20%"). These values are a floating point
- number with a percent sign appended. If the percent sign is missing,
- the parser will fail to match the value.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Typical usage is to setup an array of
- <structname>OptionInfoRec</structname>s with all fields initialised.
- The <structfield>value</structfield> and <structfield>found</structfield> fields get
- set by <function>xf86ProcessOptions()</function>. For cases where the
- value parsing is more complex, the driver should specify
- <constant>OPTV_STRING</constant>, and parse the string itself. An
- example of using this option handling is included in the
- <link linkend="sample">Sample Driver</link> section.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void xf86ShowUnusedOptions(int scrnIndex, pointer options);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Prints out warning messages for each option in the list of options
- that isn't marked as used. This is intended to show options that
- the driver hasn't recognised. It would normally be called near
- the end of the <function>ChipScreenInit()</function> function, but only
- when <code>serverGeneration == 1</code>
- </para>
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- OptionInfoPtr xf86TokenToOptinfo(const OptionInfoRec *table,
- int token);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Returns a pointer to the <structname>OptionInfoRec</structname> in
- <parameter>table</parameter> with a token field matching
- <parameter>token</parameter>. Returns <constant>NULL</constant> if no match
- is found.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- Bool xf86IsOptionSet(const OptionInfoRec *table, int token);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Returns the <literal remap="tt">found</literal> field of the
- <structname>OptionInfoRec</structname> in <parameter>table</parameter> with a
- <structfield>token</structfield> field matching <parameter>token</parameter>. This
- can be used for options of all types. Note that for options of
- type <constant>OPTV_BOOLEAN</constant>, it isn't sufficient to check
- this to determine the value of the option. Returns
- <constant>FALSE</constant> if no match is found.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- char *xf86GetOptValString(const OptionInfoRec *table, int token);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Returns the <structfield>value.str</structfield> field of the
- <structname>OptionInfoRec</structname> in <parameter>table</parameter> with a
- token field matching <parameter>token</parameter>. Returns
- <constant>NULL</constant> if no match is found.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- Bool xf86GetOptValInteger(const OptionInfoRec *table, int token,
-
- int *value);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Returns via <parameter>*value</parameter> the <structfield>value.num</structfield>
- field of the <structname>OptionInfoRec</structname> in <parameter>table</parameter>
- with a <structfield>token</structfield> field matching <parameter>token</parameter>.
- <parameter>*value</parameter> is only changed when a match is found so
- it can be safely initialised with a default prior to calling this
- function. The function return value is as for
- <function>xf86IsOptionSet()</function>.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- Bool xf86GetOptValULong(const OptionInfoRec *table, int token,
- unsigned long *value);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Like <function>xf86GetOptValInteger()</function>, except the value is
- treated as an <type>unsigned long</type>.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- Bool xf86GetOptValReal(const OptionInfoRec *table, int token,
- double *value);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Like <function>xf86GetOptValInteger()</function>, except that
- <structfield>value.realnum</structfield> is used.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- Bool xf86GetOptValFreq(const OptionInfoRec *table, int token,
- OptFreqUnits expectedUnits, double *value);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Like <function>xf86GetOptValInteger()</function>, except that the
- <structfield>value.freq</structfield> data is returned. The frequency value
- is scaled to the units indicated by <parameter>expectedUnits</parameter>.
- The scaling is exact when the units were specified explicitly in
- the option's value. Otherwise, the <parameter>expectedUnits</parameter>
- field is used as a hint when doing the scaling. In this case,
- values larger than <constant>1000</constant> are assumed to have be
- specified in the next smallest units. For example, if the Option
- value is "10000" and expectedUnits is <constant>OPTUNITS_MHZ</constant>,
- the value returned is <constant>10</constant>.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- Bool xf86GetOptValBool(const OptionInfoRec *table, int token, Bool *value);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function is used to check boolean options
- (<constant>OPTV_BOOLEAN</constant>). If the function return value is
- <constant>FALSE</constant>, it means the option wasn't set. Otherwise
- <parameter>*value</parameter> is set to the boolean value indicated by
- the option's value. No option <parameter>value</parameter> is interpreted
- as <constant>TRUE</constant>. Option values meaning <constant>TRUE</constant>
- are "1", "yes", "on", "true", and option values meaning
- <constant>FALSE</constant> are "0", "no", "off", "false". Option names
- both with the "no" prefix in their names, and with that prefix
- removed are also checked and handled in the obvious way.
- <parameter>*value</parameter> is not changed when the option isn't present.
- It should normally be set to a default value before calling this
- function.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- Bool xf86ReturnOptValBool(const OptionInfoRec *table, int token, Bool def);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function is used to check boolean options
- (<constant>OPTV_BOOLEAN</constant>). If the option is set, its value
- is returned. If the options is not set, the default value specified
- by <parameter>def</parameter> is returned. The option interpretation is
- the same as for <function>xf86GetOptValBool()</function>.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- int xf86NameCmp(const char *s1, const char *s2);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function should be used when comparing strings from the config
- file with expected values. It works like <function>strcmp()</function>,
- but is not case sensitive and space, tab, and <quote><literal>_</literal></quote> characters
- are ignored in the comparison. The use of this function isn't
- restricted to parsing option values. It may be used anywhere
- where this functionality required.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1>
- <title>Modules, Drivers, Include Files and Interface Issues</title>
-
- <para>
-NOTE: this section is incomplete.
- </para>
-
-
- <sect2>
- <title>Include files</title>
-
- <para>
-The following include files are typically required by video drivers:
-
- <blockquote><para>
- All drivers should include these:
- <literallayout><filename>
- "xf86.h"
- "xf86_OSproc.h"
- "xf86_ansic.h"
- "xf86Resources.h"
- </filename></literallayout>
- Wherever inb/outb (and related things) are used the following should be
- included:
- <literallayout><filename>
- "compiler.h"
- </filename></literallayout>
- Note: in drivers, this must be included after <filename>"xf86_ansic.h"</filename>.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Drivers that need to access PCI vendor/device definitions need this:
- <literallayout><filename>
- "xf86PciInfo.h"
- </filename></literallayout>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Drivers that need to access the PCI config space need this:
- <literallayout><filename>
- "xf86Pci.h"
- </filename></literallayout>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Drivers that initialise a SW cursor need this:
- <literallayout><filename>
- "mipointer.h"
- </filename></literallayout>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- All drivers implementing backing store need this:
- <literallayout><filename>
- "mibstore.h"
- </filename></literallayout>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- All drivers using the mi colourmap code need this:
- <literallayout><filename>
- "micmap.h"
- </filename></literallayout>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- If a driver uses the vgahw module, it needs this:
- <literallayout><filename>
- "vgaHW.h"
- </filename></literallayout>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Drivers supporting VGA or Hercules monochrome screens need:
- <literallayout><filename>
- "xf1bpp.h"
- </filename></literallayout>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Drivers supporting VGA or EGC 16-colour screens need:
- <literallayout><filename>
- "xf4bpp.h"
- </filename></literallayout>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Drivers using cfb need:
- <programlisting>
- #define PSZ 8
- #include "cfb.h"
- #undef PSZ
- </programlisting>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Drivers supporting bpp 16, 24 or 32 with cfb need one or more of:
- <literallayout><filename>
- "cfb16.h"
- "cfb24.h"
- "cfb32.h"
- </filename></literallayout>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- If a driver uses XAA, it needs these:
- <literallayout><filename>
- "xaa.h"
- "xaalocal.h"
- </filename></literallayout>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- If a driver uses the fb manager, it needs this:
- <literallayout><filename>
- "xf86fbman.h"
- </filename></literallayout>
- </para>
- </blockquote>
- </para>
-
- <para>
-Non-driver modules should include <filename>"xf86_ansic.h"</filename> to get the correct
-wrapping of ANSI C/libc functions.
- </para>
-
- <para>
-All modules must NOT include any system include files, or the following:
-
- <literallayout><filename>
- "xf86Priv.h"
- "xf86Privstr.h"
- "xf86_OSlib.h"
- "Xos.h"
- </filename></literallayout>
- </para>
-
- <para>
-In addition, "xf86_libc.h" must not be included explicitly. It is
-included implicitly by "xf86_ansic.h".
- </para>
-
- </sect2>
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1>
- <title>Offscreen Memory Manager</title>
-
- <para>
-Management of offscreen video memory may be handled by the XFree86
-framebuffer manager. Once the offscreen memory manager is running,
-drivers or extensions may allocate, free or resize areas of offscreen
-video memory using the following functions (definitions taken from
-<filename>xf86fbman.h</filename>):
-
- <programlisting>
- typedef struct _FBArea {
- ScreenPtr pScreen;
- BoxRec box;
- int granularity;
- void (*MoveAreaCallback)(struct _FBArea*, struct _FBArea*)
- void (*RemoveAreaCallback)(struct _FBArea*)
- DevUnion devPrivate;
- } FBArea, *FBAreaPtr;
-
- typedef void (*MoveAreaCallbackProcPtr)(FBAreaPtr from, FBAreaPtr to)
- typedef void (*RemoveAreaCallbackProcPtr)(FBAreaPtr)
-
- FBAreaPtr xf86AllocateOffscreenArea (
- ScreenPtr pScreen,
- int width, int height,
- int granularity,
- MoveAreaCallbackProcPtr MoveAreaCallback,
- RemoveAreaCallbackProcPtr RemoveAreaCallback,
- pointer privData
- )
-
- void xf86FreeOffscreenArea (FBAreaPtr area)
-
- Bool xf86ResizeOffscreenArea (
- FBAreaPtr area
- int w, int h
- )
- </programlisting>
- </para>
-
- <para>
-The function:
- <programlisting>
- Bool xf86FBManagerRunning(ScreenPtr pScreen);
- </programlisting>
-
-can be used by an extension to check if the driver has initialized
-the memory manager. The manager is not available if this returns
-<constant>FALSE</constant> and the functions above will all fail.
- </para>
-
-
- <para>
-<function>xf86AllocateOffscreenArea()</function> can be used to request a
-rectangle of dimensions <parameter>width</parameter> × <parameter>height</parameter>
-(in pixels) from unused offscreen memory. <parameter>granularity</parameter>
-specifies that the leftmost edge of the rectangle must lie on some
-multiple of <parameter>granularity</parameter> pixels. A granularity of zero
-means the same thing as a granularity of one - no alignment preference.
-A <parameter>MoveAreaCallback</parameter> can be provided to notify the requester
-when the offscreen area is moved. If no <parameter>MoveAreaCallback</parameter>
-is supplied then the area is considered to be immovable. The
-<parameter>privData</parameter> field will be stored in the manager's internal
-structure for that allocated area and will be returned to the requester
-in the <parameter>FBArea</parameter> passed via the
-<parameter>MoveAreaCallback</parameter>. An optional
-<parameter>RemoveAreaCallback</parameter> is provided. If the driver provides
-this it indicates that the area should be allocated with a lower priority.
-Such an area may be removed when a higher priority request (one that
-doesn't have a <parameter>RemoveAreaCallback</parameter>) is made. When this
-function is called, the driver will have an opportunity to do whatever
-cleanup it needs to do to deal with the loss of the area, but it must
-finish its cleanup before the function exits since the offscreen memory
-manager will free the area immediately after.
- </para>
-
- <para>
-<function>xf86AllocateOffscreenArea()</function> returns <constant>NULL</constant>
-if it was unable to allocate the requested area. When no longer needed,
-areas should be freed with <function>xf86FreeOffscreenArea()</function>.
- </para>
-
- <para>
-<function>xf86ResizeOffscreenArea()</function> resizes an existing
-<literal remap="tt">FBArea</literal>. <function>xf86ResizeOffscreenArea()</function>
-returns <constant>TRUE</constant> if the resize was successful. If
-<function>xf86ResizeOffscreenArea()</function> returns <constant>FALSE</constant>,
-the original <literal remap="tt">FBArea</literal> is left unmodified. Resizing an
-area maintains the area's original <literal remap="tt">granularity</literal>,
-<literal remap="tt">devPrivate</literal>, and <literal remap="tt">MoveAreaCallback</literal>.
-<function>xf86ResizeOffscreenArea()</function> has considerably less overhead
-than freeing the old area then reallocating the new size, so it should
-be used whenever possible.
- </para>
-
- <para>
-The function:
- <programlisting>
- Bool xf86QueryLargestOffscreenArea(
- ScreenPtr pScreen,
- int *width, int *height,
- int granularity,
- int preferences,
- int priority
- );
- </programlisting>
-
-is provided to query the width and height of the largest single
-<structname>FBArea</structname> allocatable given a particular priority.
-<parameter>preferences</parameter> can be one of the following to indicate
-whether width, height or area should be considered when determining
-which is the largest single <structname>FBArea</structname> available.
-
- <programlisting>
- FAVOR_AREA_THEN_WIDTH
- FAVOR_AREA_THEN_HEIGHT
- FAVOR_WIDTH_THEN_AREA
- FAVOR_HEIGHT_THEN_AREA
- </programlisting>
- </para>
-
- <para>
-<parameter>priority</parameter> is one of the following:
-
- <blockquote>
- <para>
- <constant>PRIORITY_LOW</constant>
- <blockquote><para>
- Return the largest block available without stealing anyone else's
- space. This corresponds to the priority of allocating a
- <structname>FBArea</structname> when a <function>RemoveAreaCallback</function>
- is provided.
- </para></blockquote>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- <constant>PRIORITY_NORMAL</constant>
- <blockquote><para>
- Return the largest block available if it is acceptable to steal a
- lower priority area from someone. This corresponds to the priority
- of allocating a <structname>FBArea</structname> without providing a
- <function>RemoveAreaCallback</function>.
- </para></blockquote>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- <constant>PRIORITY_EXTREME</constant>
- <blockquote><para>
- Return the largest block available if all <structname>FBArea</structname>s
- that aren't locked down were expunged from memory first. This
- corresponds to any allocation made directly after a call to
- <function>xf86PurgeUnlockedOffscreenAreas()</function>.
- </para></blockquote>
- </para>
-
- </blockquote>
- </para>
-
-
- <para>
-The function:
-
- <programlisting>
- Bool xf86PurgeUnlockedOffscreenAreas(ScreenPtr pScreen);
- </programlisting>
-
-is provided as an extreme method to free up offscreen memory. This
-will remove all removable <structname>FBArea</structname> allocations.
- </para>
-
-
- <para>
-Initialization of the XFree86 framebuffer manager is done via
-
- <programlisting>
- Bool xf86InitFBManager(ScreenPtr pScreen, BoxPtr FullBox);
- </programlisting>
-
-<parameter>FullBox</parameter> represents the area of the framebuffer that the
-manager is allowed to manage. This is typically a box with a width of
-<structfield>pScrn->displayWidth</structfield> and a height of as many lines as
-can be fit within the total video memory, however, the driver can reserve
-areas at the extremities by passing a smaller area to the manager.
- </para>
-
- <para>
-<function>xf86InitFBManager()</function> must be called before XAA is
-initialized since XAA uses the manager for it's pixmap cache.
- </para>
-
- <para>
-An alternative function is provided to allow the driver to initialize
-the framebuffer manager with a Region rather than a box.
-
- <programlisting>
- Bool xf86InitFBManagerRegion(ScreenPtr pScreen,
- RegionPtr FullRegion);
- </programlisting>
-
-<function>xf86InitFBManagerRegion()</function>, unlike
-<function>xf86InitFBManager()</function>, does not remove the area used for
-the visible screen so that area should not be included in the region
-passed to the function. <function>xf86InitFBManagerRegion()</function> is
-useful when non-contiguous areas are available to be managed, and is
-required when multiple framebuffers are stored in video memory (as in
-the case where an overlay of a different depth is stored as a second
-framebuffer in offscreen memory).
- </para>
-
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1 id="cmap">
- <title>Colormap Handling</title>
-
- <para>
-A generic colormap handling layer is provided within the XFree86 common
-layer. This layer takes care of most of the details, and only requires
-a function from the driver that loads the hardware palette when required.
-To use the colormap layer, a driver calls the
-<function>xf86HandleColormaps()</function> function.
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- Bool xf86HandleColormaps(ScreenPtr pScreen, int maxColors,
- int sigRGBbits, LoadPaletteFuncPtr loadPalette,
- SetOverscanFuncPtr setOverscan,
- unsigned int flags);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function must be called after the default colormap has been
- initialised. The <structfield>pScrn->gamma</structfield> field must also
- be initialised, preferably by calling <function>xf86SetGamma()</function>.
- <parameter>maxColors</parameter> is the number of entries in the palette.
- <parameter>sigRGBbits</parameter> is the size in bits of each color
- component in the DAC's palette. <parameter>loadPalette</parameter>
- is a driver-provided function for loading a colormap into the
- hardware, and is described below. <parameter>setOverscan</parameter> is
- an optional function that may be provided when the overscan color
- is an index from the standard LUT and when it needs to be adjusted
- to keep it as close to black as possible. The
- <parameter>setOverscan</parameter> function programs the overscan index.
- It shouldn't normally be used for depths other than 8.
- <parameter>setOverscan</parameter> should be set to <constant>NULL</constant>
- when it isn't needed. <parameter>flags</parameter> may be set to the
- following (which may be ORed together):
-
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>CMAP_PALETTED_TRUECOLOR</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>
- the TrueColor visual is paletted and is
- just a special case of DirectColor.
- This flag is only valid for
- <code>bpp > 8</code>.
-
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>CMAP_RELOAD_ON_MODE_SWITCH</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>
- reload the colormap automatically
- after mode switches. This is useful
- for when the driver is resetting the
- hardware during mode switches and
- corrupting or erasing the hardware
- palette.
-
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>CMAP_LOAD_EVEN_IF_OFFSCREEN</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>
- reload the colormap even if the screen
- is switched out of the server's VC.
- The palette is <emphasis>not</emphasis> reloaded when
- the screen is switched back in, nor after
- mode switches. This is useful when the
- driver needs to keep track of palette
- changes.
-
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The colormap layer normally reloads the palette after VT enters so it
- is not necessary for the driver to save and restore the palette
- when switching VTs. The driver must, however, still save the
- initial palette during server start up and restore it during
- server exit.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void LoadPalette(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, int numColors, int *indices,
- LOCO *colors, VisualPtr pVisual);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- <function>LoadPalette()</function> is a driver-provided function for
- loading a colormap into hardware. <parameter>colors</parameter> is the
- array of RGB values that represent the full colormap.
- <parameter>indices</parameter> is a list of index values into the colors
- array. These indices indicate the entries that need to be updated.
- <parameter>numColors</parameter> is the number of the indices to be
- updated.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void SetOverscan(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, int overscan);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- <function>SetOverscan()</function> is a driver-provided function for
- programming the <parameter>overscan</parameter> index. As described
- above, it is normally only appropriate for LUT modes where all
- colormap entries are available for the display, but where one of
- them is also used for the overscan (typically 8bpp for VGA compatible
- LUTs). It isn't required in cases where the overscan area is
- never visible.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para>
- </blockquote></para>
-
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1>
- <title>DPMS Extension</title>
-
- <para>
-Support code for the DPMS extension is included in the XFree86 common layer.
-This code provides an interface between the main extension code, and a means
-for drivers to initialise DPMS when they support it. One function is
-available to drivers to do this initialisation, and it is always available,
-even when the DPMS extension is not supported by the core server (in
-which case it returns a failure result).
- </para>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- Bool xf86DPMSInit(ScreenPtr pScreen, DPMSSetProcPtr set, int flags);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function registers a driver's DPMS level programming function
- <parameter>set</parameter>. It also checks
- <structfield>pScrn->options</structfield> for the "dpms" option, and when
- present marks DPMS as being enabled for that screen. The
- <parameter>set</parameter> function is called whenever the DPMS level
- changes, and is used to program the requested level.
- <parameter>flags</parameter> is currently not used, and should be
- <constant>0</constant>. If the initialisation fails for any reason,
- including when there is no DPMS support in the core server, the
- function returns <constant>FALSE</constant>.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
-
- <para>
-Drivers that implement DPMS support must provide the following function,
-that gets called when the DPMS level is changed:
-
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void ChipDPMSSet(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, int level, int flags);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Program the DPMS level specified by <parameter>level</parameter>. Valid
- values of <parameter>level</parameter> are <constant>DPMSModeOn</constant>,
- <constant>DPMSModeStandby</constant>, <constant>DPMSModeSuspend</constant>,
- <constant>DPMSModeOff</constant>. These values are defined in
- <filename>"extensions/dpms.h"</filename>.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
- </para>
-
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1>
- <title>DGA Extension</title>
-
- <para>
-Drivers can support the XFree86 Direct Graphics Architecture (DGA) by
-filling out a structure of function pointers and a list of modes and
-passing them to DGAInit.
- </para>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- Bool DGAInit(ScreenPtr pScreen, DGAFunctionPtr funcs,
- DGAModePtr modes, int num);
-
-/** The DGAModeRec **/
-
-typedef struct {
- int num;
- DisplayModePtr mode;
- int flags;
- int imageWidth;
- int imageHeight;
- int pixmapWidth;
- int pixmapHeight;
- int bytesPerScanline;
- int byteOrder;
- int depth;
- int bitsPerPixel;
- unsigned long red_mask;
- unsigned long green_mask;
- unsigned long blue_mask;
- int viewportWidth;
- int viewportHeight;
- int xViewportStep;
- int yViewportStep;
- int maxViewportX;
- int maxViewportY;
- int viewportFlags;
- int offset;
- unsigned char *address;
- int reserved1;
- int reserved2;
-} DGAModeRec, *DGAModePtr;
- </programlisting>
-
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>num</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Can be ignored. The DGA DDX will assign these numbers.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>mode</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- A pointer to the <structname>DisplayModeRec</structname> for this mode.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>flags</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The following flags are defined and may be OR'd together:
-
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>DGA_CONCURRENT_ACCESS</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Indicates that the driver supports concurrent graphics
- accelerator and linear framebuffer access.
-
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>DGA_FILL_RECT
- DGA_BLIT_RECT
- DGA_BLIT_RECT_TRANS</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Indicates that the driver supports the FillRect, BlitRect
- or BlitTransRect functions in this mode.
-
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>DGA_PIXMAP_AVAILABLE</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Indicates that Xlib may be used on the framebuffer.
- This flag will usually be set unless the driver wishes
- to prohibit this for some reason.
-
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>DGA_INTERLACED
- DGA_DOUBLESCAN</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Indicates that these are interlaced or double scan modes.
-
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>imageWidth
- imageHeight</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- These are the dimensions of the linear framebuffer
- accessible by the client.
-
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>pixmapWidth
- pixmapHeight</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- These are the dimensions of the area of the
- framebuffer accessible by the graphics accelerator.
-
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>bytesPerScanline</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Pitch of the framebuffer in bytes.
-
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>byteOrder</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Usually the same as
- <structfield>pScrn->imageByteOrder</structfield>.
-
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>depth</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The depth of the framebuffer in this mode.
-
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>bitsPerPixel</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The number of bits per pixel in this mode.
-
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>red_mask</structfield></term>
- <term><structfield>green_mask</structfield></term>
- <term><structfield>blue_mask</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The RGB masks for this mode, if applicable.
-
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>viewportWidth</structfield></term>
- <term><structfield>viewportHeight</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Dimensions of the visible part of the framebuffer.
- Usually <structfield>mode->HDisplay</structfield> and
- <structfield>mode->VDisplay</structfield>.
-
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>xViewportStep
- yViewportStep</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The granularity of x and y viewport positions that
- the driver supports in this mode.
-
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>maxViewportX
- maxViewportY</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The maximum viewport position supported by the
- driver in this mode.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>viewportFlags</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The following may be OR'd together:
-
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>DGA_FLIP_IMMEDIATE</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The driver supports immediate viewport changes.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>DGA_FLIP_RETRACE</constant></term>
-
- <listitem><para>
- The driver supports viewport changes at retrace.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>offset</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The offset into the linear framebuffer that corresponds to
- pixel (0,0) for this mode.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>address</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The virtual address of the framebuffer as mapped by the driver.
- This is needed when DGA_PIXMAP_AVAILABLE is set.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- </variablelist>
-
- <programlisting>
-/** The DGAFunctionRec **/
-
-typedef struct {
- Bool (*OpenFramebuffer)(
- ScrnInfoPtr pScrn,
- char **name,
- unsigned char **mem,
- int *size,
- int *offset,
- int *extra
- );
- void (*CloseFramebuffer)(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn);
- Bool (*SetMode)(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, DGAModePtr pMode);
- void (*SetViewport)(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, int x, int y, int flags);
- int (*GetViewport)(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn);
- void (*Sync)(ScrnInfoPtr);
- void (*FillRect)(
- ScrnInfoPtr pScrn,
- int x, int y, int w, int h,
- unsigned long color
- );
- void (*BlitRect)(
- ScrnInfoPtr pScrn,
- int srcx, int srcy,
- int w, int h,
- int dstx, int dsty
- );
- void (*BlitTransRect)(
- ScrnInfoPtr pScrn,
- int srcx, int srcy,
- int w, int h,
- int dstx, int dsty,
- unsigned long color
- );
-} DGAFunctionRec, *DGAFunctionPtr;
- </programlisting>
-
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- Bool OpenFramebuffer (pScrn, name, mem, size, offset, extra);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- <function>OpenFramebuffer()</function> should pass the client everything
- it needs to know to be able to open the framebuffer. These
- parameters are OS specific and their meanings are to be interpreted
- by an OS specific client library.
-
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><parameter>name</parameter></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The name of the device to open or <constant>NULL</constant> if
- there is no special device to open. A <constant>NULL</constant>
- name tells the client that it should open whatever device
- one would usually open to access physical memory.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><parameter>mem</parameter></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The physical address of the start of the framebuffer.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><parameter>size</parameter></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The size of the framebuffer in bytes.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><parameter>offset</parameter></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Any offset into the device, if applicable.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><parameter>flags</parameter></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Any additional information that the client may need.
- Currently, only the <constant>DGA_NEED_ROOT</constant> flag is
- defined.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- </variablelist>
- </para></blockquote>
- </para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void CloseFramebuffer (pScrn);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- <function>CloseFramebuffer()</function> merely informs the driver (if it
- even cares) that client no longer needs to access the framebuffer
- directly. This function is optional.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- Bool SetMode (pScrn, pMode);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- <function>SetMode()</function> tells the driver to initialize the mode
- passed to it. If <parameter>pMode</parameter> is <constant>NULL</constant>,
- then the driver should restore the original pre-DGA mode.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void SetViewport (pScrn, x, y, flags);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- <function>SetViewport()</function> tells the driver to make the upper
- left-hand corner of the visible screen correspond to coordinate
- <literal remap="tt">(x,y)</literal> on the framebuffer. <parameter>flags</parameter>
- currently defined are:
-
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>DGA_FLIP_IMMEDIATE</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The viewport change should occur immediately.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>DGA_FLIP_RETRACE</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The viewport change should occur at the
- vertical retrace, but this function should
- return sooner if possible.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The <literal remap="tt">(x,y)</literal> locations will be passed as the client
- specified them, however, the driver is expected to round these
- locations down to the next supported location as specified by the
- <structfield>xViewportStep</structfield> and <structfield>yViewportStep</structfield>
- for the current mode.
- </para>
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- int GetViewport (pScrn);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- <function>GetViewport()</function> gets the current page flip status.
- Set bits in the returned int correspond to viewport change requests
- still pending. For instance, set bit zero if the last SetViewport
- request is still pending, bit one if the one before that is still
- pending, etc.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void Sync (pScrn);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function should ensure that any graphics accelerator operations
- have finished. This function should not return until the graphics
- accelerator is idle.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void FillRect (pScrn, x, y, w, h, color);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This optional function should fill a rectangle
- <parameter>w × h</parameter> located at
- <parameter>(x,y)</parameter> in the given color.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void BlitRect (pScrn, srcx, srcy, w, h, dstx, dsty);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This optional function should copy an area
- <parameter>w × h</parameter> located at
- <parameter>(srcx,srcy)</parameter> to location <parameter>(dstx,dsty)</parameter>.
- This function will need to handle copy directions as appropriate.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void BlitTransRect (pScrn, srcx, srcy, w, h, dstx, dsty, color);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This optional function is the same as BlitRect except that pixels
- in the source corresponding to the color key <parameter>color</parameter>
- should be skipped.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
- </para></blockquote>
-
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1>
- <title>The XFree86 X Video Extension (Xv) Device Dependent Layer</title>
-
- <para>
-XFree86 offers the X Video Extension which allows clients to treat video
-as any another primitive and <quote>Put</quote> video into drawables. By default,
-the extension reports no video adaptors as being available since the
-DDX layer has not been initialized. The driver can initialize the DDX
-layer by filling out one or more <literal remap="tt">XF86VideoAdaptorRecs</literal>
-as described later in this document and passing a list of
-<literal remap="tt">XF86VideoAdaptorPtr</literal> pointers to the following function:
-
- <programlisting>
- Bool xf86XVScreenInit(ScreenPtr pScreen,
- XF86VideoAdaptorPtr *adaptPtrs,
- int num);
- </programlisting>
- </para>
-
- <para>
-After doing this, the extension will report video adaptors as being
-available, providing the data in their respective
-<literal remap="tt">XF86VideoAdaptorRecs</literal> was valid.
-<function>xf86XVScreenInit()</function> <emphasis>copies</emphasis> data from the structure
-passed to it so the driver may free it after the initialization. At
-the moment, the DDX only supports rendering into Window drawables.
-Pixmap rendering will be supported after a sufficient survey of suitable
-hardware is completed.
- </para>
-
- <para>
-The <structname>XF86VideoAdaptorRec</structname>:
-
- <programlisting>
-typedef struct {
- unsigned int type;
- int flags;
- char *name;
- int nEncodings;
- XF86VideoEncodingPtr pEncodings;
- int nFormats;
- XF86VideoFormatPtr pFormats;
- int nPorts;
- DevUnion *pPortPrivates;
- int nAttributes;
- XF86AttributePtr pAttributes;
- int nImages;
- XF86ImagePtr pImages;
- PutVideoFuncPtr PutVideo;
- PutStillFuncPtr PutStill;
- GetVideoFuncPtr GetVideo;
- GetStillFuncPtr GetStill;
- StopVideoFuncPtr StopVideo;
- SetPortAttributeFuncPtr SetPortAttribute;
- GetPortAttributeFuncPtr GetPortAttribute;
- QueryBestSizeFuncPtr QueryBestSize;
- PutImageFuncPtr PutImage;
- QueryImageAttributesFuncPtr QueryImageAttributes;
-} XF86VideoAdaptorRec, *XF86VideoAdaptorPtr;
- </programlisting></para>
-
- <para>
-Each adaptor will have its own XF86VideoAdaptorRec. The fields are
-as follows:
-
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>type</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- This can be any of the following flags OR'd together.
-
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>XvInputMask</constant>
- <constant>XvOutputMask</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>
- These refer to the target drawable and are similar to a Window's
- class. <literal remap="tt">XvInputMask</literal> indicates that the adaptor
- can put video into a drawable. <literal remap="tt">XvOutputMask</literal>
- indicates that the adaptor can get video from a drawable.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>XvVideoMask</constant>
- <constant>XvStillMask</constant>
- <constant>XvImageMask</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>
- These indicate that the adaptor supports video, still or
- image primitives respectively.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>XvWindowMask</constant>
- <constant>XvPixmapMask</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>
- These indicate the types of drawables the adaptor is capable
- of rendering into. At the moment, Pixmap rendering is not
- supported and the <constant>XvPixmapMask</constant> flag is ignored.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
-
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>flags</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Currently, the following flags are defined:
-
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>VIDEO_NO_CLIPPING</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>
- This indicates that the video adaptor does not support
- clipping. The driver will never receive <quote>Put</quote> requests
- where less than the entire area determined by
- <parameter>drw_x</parameter>, <parameter>drw_y</parameter>,
- <parameter>drw_w</parameter> and <parameter>drw_h</parameter> is visible.
- This flag does not apply to <quote>Get</quote> requests. Hardware
- that is incapable of clipping <quote>Gets</quote> may punt or get
- the extents of the clipping region passed to it.
- </para></listitem>
-
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>VIDEO_INVERT_CLIPLIST</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>
- This indicates that the video driver requires the clip
- list to contain the regions which are obscured rather
- than the regions which are are visible.
- </para></listitem>
-
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>VIDEO_OVERLAID_STILLS</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Implementing PutStill for hardware that does video as an
- overlay can be awkward since it's unclear how long to leave
- the video up for. When this flag is set, StopVideo will be
- called whenever the destination gets clipped or moved so that
- the still can be left up until then.
- </para></listitem>
-
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>VIDEO_OVERLAID_IMAGES</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Same as <constant>VIDEO_OVERLAID_STILLS</constant> but for images.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>VIDEO_CLIP_TO_VIEWPORT</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Indicates that the clip region passed to the driver functions
- should be clipped to the visible portion of the screen in the
- case where the viewport is smaller than the virtual desktop.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- </variablelist>
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>name</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The name of the adaptor.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>nEncodings</structfield>
- <structfield>pEncodings</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The number of encodings the adaptor is capable of and pointer
- to the <structname>XF86VideoEncodingRec</structname> array. The
- <structname>XF86VideoEncodingRec</structname> is described later on.
- For drivers that only support XvImages there should be an encoding
- named "XV_IMAGE" and the width and height should specify
- the maximum size source image supported.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>nFormats</structfield>
- <structfield>pFormats</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The number of formats the adaptor is capable of and pointer to
- the <structname>XF86VideoFormatRec</structname> array. The
- <structname>XF86VideoFormatRec</structname> is described later on.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>nPorts</structfield>
- <structfield>pPortPrivates</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The number of ports is the number of separate data streams which
- the adaptor can handle simultaneously. If you have more than
- one port, the adaptor is expected to be able to render into more
- than one window at a time. <structfield>pPortPrivates</structfield> is
- an array of pointers or ints - one for each port. A port's
- private data will be passed to the driver any time the port is
- requested to do something like put the video or stop the video.
- In the case where there may be many ports, this enables the
- driver to know which port the request is intended for. Most
- commonly, this will contain a pointer to the data structure
- containing information about the port. In Xv, all ports on
- a particular adaptor are expected to be identical in their
- functionality.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>nAttributes</structfield>
- <structfield>pAttributes</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The number of attributes recognized by the adaptor and a pointer to
- the array of <structname>XF86AttributeRecs</structname>. The
- <structname>XF86AttributeRec</structname> is described later on.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>nImages</structfield>
- <structfield>pImages</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The number of <structname>XF86ImageRecs</structname> supported by the adaptor
- and a pointer to the array of <structname>XF86ImageRecs</structname>. The
- <structname>XF86ImageRec</structname> is described later on.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>
- PutVideo PutStill GetVideo GetStill StopVideo
- SetPortAttribute GetPortAttribute QueryBestSize PutImage
- QueryImageAttributes
- </structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- These functions define the DDX->driver interface. In each
- case, the pointer <parameter>data</parameter> is passed to the driver.
- This is the port private for that port as described above. All
- fields are required except under the following conditions:
-
- <orderedlist>
- <listitem><para>
- <structfield>PutVideo</structfield>, <structfield>PutStill</structfield> and
- the image routines <structfield>PutImage</structfield> and
- <structfield>QueryImageAttributes</structfield> are not required when the
- adaptor type does not contain <constant>XvInputMask</constant>.
- </para></listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>
- <structfield>GetVideo</structfield> and <structfield>GetStill</structfield>
- are not required when the adaptor type does not contain
- <constant>XvOutputMask</constant>.
- </para></listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>
- <structfield>GetVideo</structfield> and <structfield>PutVideo</structfield>
- are not required when the adaptor type does not contain
- <constant>XvVideoMask</constant>.
- </para></listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>
- <structfield>GetStill</structfield> and <structfield>PutStill</structfield>
- are not required when the adaptor type does not contain
- <constant>XvStillMask</constant>.
- </para></listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>
- <structfield>PutImage</structfield> and <structfield>QueryImageAttributes</structfield>
- are not required when the adaptor type does not contain
- <constant>XvImageMask</constant>.
- </para></listitem>
-
- </orderedlist>
-
- </para>
-
- <para>
- With the exception of <structfield>QueryImageAttributes</structfield>, these
- functions should return <constant>Success</constant> if the operation was
- completed successfully. They can return <constant>XvBadAlloc</constant>
- otherwise. <structfield>QueryImageAttributes</structfield> returns the size
- of the XvImage queried.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- If the <constant>VIDEO_NO_CLIPPING</constant>
- flag is set, the <literal remap="tt">clipBoxes</literal> may be ignored by
- the driver. <literal remap="tt">ClipBoxes</literal> is an <literal remap="tt">X-Y</literal>
- banded region identical to those used throughout the server.
- The clipBoxes represent the visible portions of the area determined
- by <literal remap="tt">drw_x</literal>, <literal remap="tt">drw_y</literal>,
- <literal remap="tt">drw_w</literal> and <literal remap="tt">drw_h</literal> in the Get/Put
- function. The boxes are in screen coordinates, are guaranteed
- not to overlap and an empty region will never be passed.
- If the driver has specified <constant>VIDEO_INVERT_CLIPLIST</constant>,
- <literal remap="tt">clipBoxes</literal> will indicate the areas of the primitive
- which are obscured rather than the areas visible.
-
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- typedef int (* PutVideoFuncPtr)( ScrnInfoPtr pScrn,
- short vid_x, short vid_y, short drw_x, short drw_y,
- short vid_w, short vid_h, short drw_w, short drw_h,
- RegionPtr clipBoxes, pointer data );
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This indicates that the driver should take a subsection
- <parameter>vid_w</parameter> by <parameter>vid_h</parameter> at location
- <parameter>(vid_x,vid_y)</parameter> from the video stream and direct
- it into the rectangle <parameter>drw_w</parameter> by <parameter>drw_h</parameter>
- at location <parameter>(drw_x,drw_y)</parameter> on the screen, scaling as
- necessary. Due to the large variations in capabilities of
- the various hardware expected to be used with this extension,
- it is not expected that all hardware will be able to do this
- exactly as described. In that case the driver should just do
- <quote>the best it can,</quote> scaling as closely to the target rectangle
- as it can without rendering outside of it. In the worst case,
- the driver can opt to just not turn on the video.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- typedef int (* PutStillFuncPtr)( ScrnInfoPtr pScrn,
- short vid_x, short vid_y, short drw_x, short drw_y,
- short vid_w, short vid_h, short drw_w, short drw_h,
- RegionPtr clipBoxes, pointer data );
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This is same as <structfield>PutVideo</structfield> except that the driver
- should place only one frame from the stream on the screen.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- typedef int (* GetVideoFuncPtr)( ScrnInfoPtr pScrn,
- short vid_x, short vid_y, short drw_x, short drw_y,
- short vid_w, short vid_h, short drw_w, short drw_h,
- RegionPtr clipBoxes, pointer data );
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This is same as <structfield>PutVideo</structfield> except that the driver
- gets video from the screen and outputs it. The driver should
- do the best it can to get the requested dimensions correct
- without reading from an area larger than requested.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- typedef int (* GetStillFuncPtr)( ScrnInfoPtr pScrn,
- short vid_x, short vid_y, short drw_x, short drw_y,
- short vid_w, short vid_h, short drw_w, short drw_h,
- RegionPtr clipBoxes, pointer data );
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This is the same as <literal remap="tt">GetVideo</literal> except that the
- driver should place only one frame from the screen into the
- output stream.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- typedef void (* StopVideoFuncPtr)(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn,
- pointer data, Bool cleanup);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This indicates the driver should stop displaying the video.
- This is used to stop both input and output video. The
- <parameter>cleanup</parameter> field indicates that the video is
- being stopped because the client requested it to stop or
- because the server is exiting the current VT. In that case
- the driver should deallocate any offscreen memory areas (if
- there are any) being used to put the video to the screen. If
- <parameter>cleanup</parameter> is not set, the video is being stopped
- temporarily due to clipping or moving of the window, etc...
- and video will likely be restarted soon so the driver should
- not deallocate any offscreen areas associated with that port.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- typedef int (* SetPortAttributeFuncPtr)(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn,
- Atom attribute,INT32 value, pointer data);
- </programlisting>
-
- <programlisting>
- typedef int (* GetPortAttributeFuncPtr)(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn,
- Atom attribute,INT32 *value, pointer data);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- A port may have particular attributes such as hue,
- saturation, brightness or contrast. Xv clients set and
- get these attribute values by sending attribute strings
- (Atoms) to the server. Such requests end up at these
- driver functions. It is recommended that the driver provide
- at least the following attributes mentioned in the Xv client
- library docs:
- <literallayout><constant>
- XV_ENCODING
- XV_HUE
- XV_SATURATION
- XV_BRIGHTNESS
- XV_CONTRAST
- </constant></literallayout>
- but the driver may recognize as many atoms as it wishes. If
- a requested attribute is unknown by the driver it should return
- <constant>BadMatch</constant>. <constant>XV_ENCODING</constant> is the
- attribute intended to let the client specify which video
- encoding the particular port should be using (see the description
- of <structname>XF86VideoEncodingRec</structname> below). If the
- requested encoding is unsupported, the driver should return
- <constant>XvBadEncoding</constant>. If the value lies outside the
- advertised range <constant>BadValue</constant> may be returned.
- <constant>Success</constant> should be returned otherwise.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- typedef void (* QueryBestSizeFuncPtr)(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn,
- Bool motion, short vid_w, short vid_h,
- short drw_w, short drw_h,
- unsigned int *p_w, unsigned int *p_h, pointer data);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- <function>QueryBestSize</function> provides the client with a way
- to query what the destination dimensions would end up being
- if they were to request that an area
- <parameter>vid_w</parameter> by <parameter>vid_h</parameter> from the video
- stream be scaled to rectangle of
- <parameter>drw_w</parameter> by <parameter>drw_h</parameter> on the screen.
- Since it is not expected that all hardware will be able to
- get the target dimensions exactly, it is important that the
- driver provide this function.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- typedef int (* PutImageFuncPtr)( ScrnInfoPtr pScrn,
- short src_x, short src_y, short drw_x, short drw_y,
- short src_w, short src_h, short drw_w, short drw_h,
- int image, char *buf, short width, short height,
- Bool sync, RegionPtr clipBoxes, pointer data );
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This is similar to <structfield>PutStill</structfield> except that the
- source of the video is not a port but the data stored in a system
- memory buffer at <parameter>buf</parameter>. The data is in the format
- indicated by the <parameter>image</parameter> descriptor and represents a
- source of size <parameter>width</parameter> by <parameter>height</parameter>.
- If <parameter>sync</parameter> is TRUE the driver should not return
- from this function until it is through reading the data
- from <parameter>buf</parameter>. Returning when <parameter>sync</parameter>
- is TRUE indicates that it is safe for the data at <parameter>buf</parameter>
- to be replaced, freed, or modified.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- typedef int (* QueryImageAttributesFuncPtr)( ScrnInfoPtr pScrn,
- int image, short *width, short *height,
- int *pitches, int *offsets);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function is called to let the driver specify how data for
- a particular <parameter>image</parameter> of size <parameter>width</parameter>
- by <parameter>height</parameter> should be stored. Sometimes only
- the size and corrected width and height are needed. In that
- case <parameter>pitches</parameter> and <parameter>offsets</parameter> are
- NULL. The size of the memory required for the image is returned
- by this function. The <parameter>width</parameter> and
- <parameter>height</parameter> of the requested image can be altered by
- the driver to reflect format limitations (such as component
- sampling periods that are larger than one). If
- <parameter>pitches</parameter> and <parameter>offsets</parameter> are not NULL,
- these will be arrays with as many elements in them as there
- are planes in the <parameter>image</parameter> format. The driver
- should specify the pitch (in bytes) of each scanline in the
- particular plane as well as the offset to that plane (in bytes)
- from the beginning of the image.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
- </para>
-
- <para>
-The XF86VideoEncodingRec:
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
-typedef struct {
- int id;
- char *name;
- unsigned short width, height;
- XvRationalRec rate;
-} XF86VideoEncodingRec, *XF86VideoEncodingPtr;
-
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- The <structname>XF86VideoEncodingRec</structname> specifies what encodings
- the adaptor can support. Most of this data is just informational
- and for the client's benefit, and is what will be reported by
- <function>XvQueryEncodings</function>. The <parameter>id</parameter> field is
- expected to be a unique identifier to allow the client to request a
- certain encoding via the <constant>XV_ENCODING</constant> attribute string.
-
- </para>
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
- </para>
-
- <para>
-The XF86VideoFormatRec:
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
-typedef struct {
- char depth;
- short class;
-} XF86VideoFormatRec, *XF86VideoFormatPtr;
-
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This specifies what visuals the video is viewable in.
- <parameter>depth</parameter> is the depth of the visual (not bpp).
- <parameter>class</parameter> is the visual class such as
- <constant>TrueColor</constant>, <constant>DirectColor</constant> or
- <constant>PseudoColor</constant>. Initialization of an adaptor will fail
- if none of the visuals on that screen are supported.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
- </para>
-
- <para>
-The XF86AttributeRec:
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
-typedef struct {
- int flags;
- int min_value;
- int max_value;
- char *name;
-} XF86AttributeListRec, *XF86AttributeListPtr;
-
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Each adaptor may have an array of these advertising the attributes
- for its ports. Currently defined flags are <literal remap="tt">XvGettable</literal>
- and <literal remap="tt">XvSettable</literal> which may be OR'd together indicating that
- attribute is <quote>gettable</quote> or <quote>settable</quote> by the client. The
- <literal remap="tt">min</literal> and <literal remap="tt">max</literal> field specify the valid range
- for the value. <literal remap="tt">Name</literal> is a text string describing the
- attribute by name.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- </para>
-
- <para>
-The XF86ImageRec:
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
-typedef struct {
- int id;
- int type;
- int byte_order;
- char guid[16];
- int bits_per_pixel;
- int format;
- int num_planes;
-
- /* for RGB formats */
- int depth;
- unsigned int red_mask;
- unsigned int green_mask;
- unsigned int blue_mask;
-
- /* for YUV formats */
- unsigned int y_sample_bits;
- unsigned int u_sample_bits;
- unsigned int v_sample_bits;
- unsigned int horz_y_period;
- unsigned int horz_u_period;
- unsigned int horz_v_period;
- unsigned int vert_y_period;
- unsigned int vert_u_period;
- unsigned int vert_v_period;
- char component_order[32];
- int scanline_order;
-} XF86ImageRec, *XF86ImagePtr;
-
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- XF86ImageRec describes how video source data is laid out in memory.
- The fields are as follows:
-
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>id</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- This is a unique descriptor for the format. It is often good to
- set this value to the FOURCC for the format when applicable.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>type</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- This is <constant>XvRGB</constant> or <constant>XvYUV</constant>.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>byte_order</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- This is <constant>LSBFirst</constant> or <constant>MSBFirst</constant>.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>guid</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- This is the Globally Unique IDentifier for the format. When
- not applicable, all characters should be NULL.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>bits_per_pixel</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The number of bits taken up (but not necessarily used) by each
- pixel. Note that for some planar formats which have fractional
- bits per pixel (such as IF09) this number may be rounded _down_.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>format</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- This is <constant>XvPlanar</constant> or <constant>XvPacked</constant>.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>num_planes</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The number of planes in planar formats. This should be set to
- one for packed formats.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>depth</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The significant bits per pixel in RGB formats (analgous to the
- depth of a pixmap format).
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>red_mask</structfield></term>
- <term><structfield>green_mask</structfield></term>
- <term><structfield>blue_mask</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The red, green and blue bitmasks for packed RGB formats.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>y_sample_bits</structfield></term>
- <term><structfield>u_sample_bits</structfield></term>
- <term><structfield>v_sample_bits</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The y, u and v sample sizes (in bits).
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>horz_y_period</structfield></term>
- <term><structfield>horz_u_period</structfield></term>
- <term><structfield>horz_v_period</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The y, u and v sampling periods in the horizontal direction.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>vert_y_period</structfield></term>
- <term><structfield>vert_u_period</structfield></term>
- <term><structfield>vert_v_period</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The y, u and v sampling periods in the vertical direction.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>component_order</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Uppercase ascii characters representing the order that
- samples are stored within packed formats. For planar formats
- this represents the ordering of the planes. Unused characters
- in the 32 byte string should be set to NULL.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>scanline_order</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- This is <constant>XvTopToBottom</constant> or <constant>XvBottomToTop</constant>.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- </variablelist>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Since some formats (particular some planar YUV formats) may not
-be completely defined by the parameters above, the guid, when
-available, should provide the most accurate description of the
-format.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
- </para>
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1>
- <title>The Loader</title>
-
- <para>
-This section describes the interfaces to the module loader. The loader
-interfaces can be divided into two groups: those that are only available to
-the XFree86 common layer, and those that are also available to modules.
- </para>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>Loader Overview</title>
-
- <para>
-The loader is capable of loading modules in a range of object formats,
-and knowledge of these formats is built in to the loader. Knowledge of
-new object formats can be added to the loader in a straightforward
-manner. This makes it possible to provide OS-independent modules (for
-a given CPU architecture type). In addition to this, the loader can
-load modules via the OS-provided <function>dlopen(3)</function> service where
-available. Such modules are not platform independent, and the semantics
-of <function>dlopen()</function> on most systems results in significant
-limitations in the use of modules of this type. Support for
-<function>dlopen()</function> modules in the loader is primarily for
-experimental and development purposes.
- </para>
-
- <para>
-Symbols exported by the loader (on behalf of the core X server) to
-modules are determined at compile time. Only those symbols explicitly
-exported are available to modules. All external symbols of loaded
-modules are exported to other modules, and to the core X server. The
-loader can be requested to check for unresolved symbols at any time,
-and the action to be taken for unresolved symbols can be controlled by
-the caller of the loader. Typically the caller identifies which symbols
-can safely remain unresolved and which cannot.
- </para>
-
- <para>
-NOTE: Now that ISO-C allows pointers to functions and pointers to data to
-have different internal representations, some of the following interfaces
-will need to be revisited.
- </para>
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>Semi-private Loader Interface</title>
-
- <para>
-The following is the semi-private loader interface that is available to the
-XFree86 common layer.
- </para>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void LoaderInit(void);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- The <function>LoaderInit()</function> function initialises the loader,
- and it must be called once before calling any other loader functions.
- This function initialises the tables of exported symbols, and anything
- else that might need to be initialised.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void LoaderSetPath(const char *path);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- The <function>LoaderSetPath()</function> function initialises a default
- module search path. This must be called if calls to other functions
- are to be made without explicitly specifying a module search path.
- The search path <parameter>path</parameter> must be a string of one or more
- comma separated absolute paths. Modules are expected to be located
- below these paths, possibly in subdirectories of these paths.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- pointer LoadModule(const char *module, const char *path,
- const char **subdirlist, const char **patternlist,
- pointer options, const XF86ModReqInfo * modreq,
- int *errmaj, int *errmin);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- The <function>LoadModule()</function> function loads the module called
- <parameter>module</parameter>. The return value is a module handle, and
- may be used in future calls to the loader that require a reference
- to a loaded module. The module name <parameter>module</parameter> is
- normally the module's canonical name, which doesn't contain any
- directory path information, or any object/library file prefixes of
- suffixes. Currently a full pathname and/or filename is also accepted.
- This might change. The other parameters are:
-
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><parameter>path</parameter></term>
- <listitem><para>
- An optional comma-separated list of module search paths.
- When <constant>NULL</constant>, the default search path is used.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><parameter>subdirlist</parameter></term>
- <listitem><para>
- An optional <constant>NULL</constant> terminated list of
- subdirectories to search. When <constant>NULL</constant>,
- the default built-in list is used (refer to
- <varname>stdSubdirs</varname> in <filename>loadmod.c</filename>).
- The default list is also substituted for entries in
- <parameter>subdirlist</parameter> with the value
- <constant>DEFAULT_LIST</constant>. This makes is possible
- to augment the default list instead of replacing it.
- Subdir elements must be relative, and must not contain
- <literal remap="tt">".."</literal>. If any violate this requirement,
- the load fails.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><parameter>patternlist</parameter></term>
- <listitem><para>
- An optional <constant>NULL</constant> terminated list of
- POSIX regular expressions used to connect module
- filenames with canonical module names. Each regex
- should contain exactly one subexpression that corresponds
- to the canonical module name. When <constant>NULL</constant>,
- the default built-in list is used (refer to
- <varname>stdPatterns</varname> in
- <filename>loadmod.c</filename>). The default list is also
- substituted for entries in <parameter>patternlist</parameter>
- with the value <constant>DEFAULT_LIST</constant>. This
- makes it possible to augment the default list instead
- of replacing it.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><parameter>options</parameter></term>
- <listitem><para>
- An optional parameter that is passed to the newly
- loaded module's <literal remap="tt">SetupProc</literal> function
- (if it has one). This argument is normally a
- <constant>NULL</constant> terminated list of
- <structname>Options</structname>, and must be interpreted that
- way by modules loaded directly by the XFree86 common
- layer. However, it may be used for application-specific
- parameter passing in other situations.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- When loading <quote>external</quote> modules (modules that don't
- have the standard entry point, for example a
- special shared library) the options parameter can be
- set to <constant>EXTERN_MODULE</constant> to tell the
- loader not to reject the module when it doesn't find
- the standard entry point.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><parameter>modreq</parameter></term>
- <listitem><para>
- An optional <structname>XF86ModReqInfo*</structname> containing
- version/ABI/vendor information to requirements to
- check the newly loaded module against. The main
- purpose of this is to allow the loader to verify that
- a module of the correct type/version before running
- its <function>SetupProc</function> function.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The <literal remap="tt">XF86ModReqInfo</literal> struct is defined
- as follows:
- <programlisting>
-typedef struct {
- CARD8 majorversion; /* MAJOR_UNSPEC */
- CARD8 minorversion; /* MINOR_UNSPEC */
- CARD16 patchlevel; /* PATCH_UNSPEC */
- const char * abiclass; /* ABI_CLASS_NONE */
- CARD32 abiversion; /* ABI_VERS_UNSPEC */
- const char * moduleclass; /* MOD_CLASS_NONE */
-} XF86ModReqInfo;
- </programlisting>
-
- The information here is compared against the equivalent
- information in the module's
- <structname>XF86ModuleVersionInfo</structname> record (which
- is described below). The values in comments above
- indicate <quote>don't care</quote> settings for each of the fields.
- The comparisons made are as follows:
-
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>majorversion</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Must match the module's majorversion
- exactly.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>minorversion</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The module's minor version must be
- no less than this value. This
- comparison is only made if
- <structfield>majorversion</structfield> is
- specified and matches.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>patchlevel</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The module's patchlevel must be no
- less than this value. This comparison
- is only made if
- <structfield>minorversion</structfield> is
- specified and matches.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>abiclass</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- String must match the module's abiclass
- string.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>abiversion</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Must be consistent with the module's
- abiversion (major equal, minor no
- older).
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>moduleclass</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- String must match the module's
- moduleclass string.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- </variablelist>
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><parameter>errmaj</parameter></term>
- <listitem><para>
- An optional pointer to a variable holding the major
- part or the error code. When provided,
- <parameter>*errmaj</parameter> is filled in when
- <function>LoadModule()</function> fails.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><parameter>errmin</parameter></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Like <parameter>errmaj</parameter>, but for the minor part
- of the error code.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- </variablelist>
-
- </para></blockquote>
- </para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void UnloadModule(pointer mod);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function unloads the module referred to by the handle mod.
- All child modules are also unloaded recursively. This function must
- not be used to directly unload modules that are child modules (i.e.,
- those that have been loaded with the <function>LoadSubModule()</function>
- described below).
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>Module Requirements</title>
-
- <para>
-Modules must provide information about themselves to the loader, and
-may optionally provide entry points for "setup" and "teardown" functions
-(those two functions are referred to here as <function>SetupProc</function>
-and <function>TearDownProc</function>).
- </para>
-
- <para>
-The module information is contained in the
-<structname>XF86ModuleVersionInfo</structname> struct, which is defined as follows:
-
- <programlisting>
-typedef struct {
- const char * modname; /* name of module, e.g. "foo" */
- const char * vendor; /* vendor specific string */
- CARD32 _modinfo1_; /* constant MODINFOSTRING1/2 to find */
- CARD32 _modinfo2_; /* infoarea with a binary editor/sign tool */
- CARD32 xf86version; /* contains XF86_VERSION_CURRENT */
- CARD8 majorversion; /* module-specific major version */
- CARD8 minorversion; /* module-specific minor version */
- CARD16 patchlevel; /* module-specific patch level */
- const char * abiclass; /* ABI class that the module uses */
- CARD32 abiversion; /* ABI version */
- const char * moduleclass; /* module class */
- CARD32 checksum[4]; /* contains a digital signature of the */
- /* version info structure */
-} XF86ModuleVersionInfo;
- </programlisting>
-
-The fields are used as follows:
-
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>modname</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The module's name. This field is currently only for
- informational purposes, but the loader may be modified
- in future to require it to match the module's canonical
- name.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>vendor</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The module vendor. This field is for informational purposes
- only.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>_modinfo1_</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- This field holds the first part of a signature that can
- be used to locate this structure in the binary. It should
- always be initialised to <constant>MODINFOSTRING1</constant>.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>_modinfo2_</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- This field holds the second part of a signature that can
- be used to locate this structure in the binary. It should
- always be initialised to <constant>MODINFOSTRING2</constant>.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>xf86version</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The XFree86 version against which the module was compiled.
- This is mostly for informational/diagnostic purposes. It
- should be initialised to <constant>XF86_VERSION_CURRENT</constant>, which is
- defined in <filename>xf86Version.h</filename>.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>majorversion</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The module-specific major version. For modules where this
- version is used for more than simply informational
- purposes, the major version should only change (be
- incremented) when ABI incompatibilities are introduced,
- or ABI components are removed.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>minorversion</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The module-specific minor version. For modules where this
- version is used for more than simply informational
- purposes, the minor version should only change (be
- incremented) when ABI additions are made in a backward
- compatible way. It should be reset to zero when the major
- version is increased.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>patchlevel</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The module-specific patch level. The patch level should
- increase with new revisions of the module where there
- are no ABI changes, and it should be reset to zero when
- the minor version is increased.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>abiclass</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The ABI class that the module requires. The class is
- specified as a string for easy extensibility. It should
- indicate which (if any) of the X server's built-in ABI
- classes that the module relies on, or a third-party ABI
- if appropriate. Built-in ABI classes currently defined are:
-
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>ABI_CLASS_NONE</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>no class
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>ABI_CLASS_ANSIC</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>only requires the ANSI C interfaces
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>ABI_CLASS_VIDEODRV</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>requires the video driver ABI
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>ABI_CLASS_XINPUT</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>requires the XInput driver ABI
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>ABI_CLASS_EXTENSION</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>requires the extension module ABI
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>ABI_CLASS_FONT</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>requires the font module ABI
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
-
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>abiversion</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The version of abiclass that the module requires. The
- version consists of major and minor components. The
- major version must match and the minor version must be
- no newer than that provided by the server or parent
- module. Version identifiers for the built-in classes
- currently defined are:
-
- <literallayout><constant>
- ABI_ANSIC_VERSION
- ABI_VIDEODRV_VERSION
- ABI_XINPUT_VERSION
- ABI_EXTENSION_VERSION
- ABI_FONT_VERSION
- </constant></literallayout>
-
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>moduleclass</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- This is similar to the abiclass field, except that it
- defines the type of module rather than the ABI it
- requires. For example, although all video drivers require
- the video driver ABI, not all modules that require the
- video driver ABI are video drivers. This distinction
- can be made with the moduleclass. Currently pre-defined
- module classes are:
-
- <literallayout><constant>
- MOD_CLASS_NONE
- MOD_CLASS_VIDEODRV
- MOD_CLASS_XINPUT
- MOD_CLASS_FONT
- MOD_CLASS_EXTENSION
- </constant></literallayout>
-
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>checksum</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Not currently used.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- </variablelist>
- </para>
-
- <para>
-The module version information, and the optional <function>SetupProc</function>
-and <function>TearDownProc</function> entry points are found by the loader
-by locating a data object in the module called "modnameModuleData",
-where "modname" is the canonical name of the module. Modules must
-contain such a data object, and it must be declared with global scope,
-be compile-time initialised, and is of the following type:
-
- <programlisting>
-typedef struct {
- XF86ModuleVersionInfo * vers;
- ModuleSetupProc setup;
- ModuleTearDownProc teardown;
-} XF86ModuleData;
- </programlisting>
- </para>
-
- <para>
-The vers parameter must be initialised to a pointer to a correctly
-initialised <structname>XF86ModuleVersionInfo</structname> struct. The other
-two parameter are optional, and should be initialised to
-<constant>NULL</constant> when not required. The other parameters are defined
-as
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- typedef pointer (*ModuleSetupProc)(pointer, pointer, int *, int *);
-
- typedef void (*ModuleTearDownProc)(pointer);
-
- pointer SetupProc(pointer module, pointer options,
- int *errmaj, int *errmin);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- When defined, this function is called by the loader after successfully
- loading a module. module is a handle for the newly loaded module,
- and maybe used by the <function>SetupProc</function> if it calls other
- loader functions that require a reference to it. The remaining
- arguments are those that were passed to the
- <function>LoadModule()</function> (or <function>LoadSubModule()</function>),
- and are described above. When the <function>SetupProc</function> is
- successful it must return a non-<constant>NULL</constant> value. The
- loader checks this, and if it is <constant>NULL</constant> it unloads
- the module and reports the failure to the caller of
- <function>LoadModule()</function>. If the <function>SetupProc</function>
- does things that need to be undone when the module is unloaded,
- it should define a <function>TearDownProc</function>, and return a
- pointer that the <function>TearDownProc</function> can use to undo what
- has been done.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- When a module is loaded multiple times, the <function>SetupProc</function>
- is called once for each time it is loaded.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void TearDownProc(pointer tearDownData);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- When defined, this function is called when the loader unloads a
- module. The <parameter>tearDownData</parameter> parameter is the return
- value of the <function>SetupProc()</function> that was called when the
- module was loaded. The purpose of this function is to clean up
- before the module is unloaded (for example, by freeing allocated
- resources).
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
- </para>
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>Public Loader Interface</title>
-
- <para>
-The following is the Loader interface that is available to any part of
-the server, and may also be used from within modules.
- </para>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- pointer LoadSubModule(pointer parent, const char *module,
- const char **subdirlist, const char **patternlist,
- pointer options, const XF86ModReqInfo * modreq,
- int *errmaj, int *errmin);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function is like the <function>LoadModule()</function> function
- described above, except that the module loaded is registered as a
- child of the calling module. The <parameter>parent</parameter> parameter
- is the calling module's handle. Modules loaded with this function
- are automatically unloaded when the parent module is unloaded. The
- other difference is that the path parameter may not be specified.
- The module search path used for modules loaded with this function
- is the default search path as initialised with
- <function>LoaderSetPath()</function>.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void UnloadSubModule(pointer module);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function unloads the module with handle <parameter>module</parameter>.
- If that module itself has children, they are also unloaded. It is
- like <function>UnloadModule()</function>, except that it is safe to use
- for unloading child modules.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- pointer LoaderSymbol(const char *symbol);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function returns the address of the symbol with name
- <parameter>symbol</parameter>. This may be used to locate a module entry
- point with a known name.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- char **LoaderlistDirs(const char **subdirlist,
- const char **patternlist);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function returns a <constant>NULL</constant> terminated list of
- canonical modules names for modules found in the default module
- search path. The <parameter>subdirlist</parameter> and
- <parameter>patternlist</parameter> parameters are as described above, and
- can be used to control the locations and names that are searched.
- If no modules are found, the return value is <constant>NULL</constant>.
- The returned list should be freed by calling
- <function>LoaderFreeDirList()</function> when it is no longer needed.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void LoaderFreeDirList(char **list);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function frees a module list created by
- <function>LoaderlistDirs()</function>.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void LoaderReqSymLists(const char **list0, ...);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function allows the registration of required symbols with the
- loader. It is normally used by a caller of
- <function>LoadSubModule()</function>. If any symbols registered in this
- way are found to be unresolved when
- <function>LoaderCheckUnresolved()</function> is called then
- <function>LoaderCheckUnresolved()</function> will report a failure.
- The function takes one or more <constant>NULL</constant> terminated
- lists of symbols. The end of the argument list is indicated by a
- <constant>NULL</constant> argument.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void LoaderReqSymbols(const char *sym0, ...);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function is like <function>LoaderReqSymLists()</function> except
- that its arguments are symbols rather than lists of symbols. This
- function is more convenient when single functions are to be registered,
- especially when the single function might depend on runtime factors.
- The end of the argument list is indicated by a <constant>NULL</constant>
- argument.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void LoaderRefSymLists(const char **list0, ...);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function allows the registration of possibly unresolved symbols
- with the loader. When <function>LoaderCheckUnresolved()</function> is
- run it won't generate warnings for symbols registered in this way
- unless they were also registered as required symbols.
- The function takes one or more <constant>NULL</constant> terminated
- lists of symbols. The end of the argument list is indicated by a
- <constant>NULL</constant> argument.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void LoaderRefSymbols(const char *sym0, ...);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function is like <function>LoaderRefSymLists()</function> except
- that its arguments are symbols rather than lists of symbols. This
- function is more convenient when single functions are to be registered,
- especially when the single function might depend on runtime factors.
- The end of the argument list is indicated by a <constant>NULL</constant>
- argument.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- int LoaderCheckUnresolved(int delayflag);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function checks for unresolved symbols. It generates warnings
- for unresolved symbols that have not been registered with
- <function>LoaderRefSymLists()</function>, and maps them to a dummy
- function. This behaviour may change in future. If unresolved
- symbols are found that have been registered with
- <function>LoaderReqSymLists()</function> or
- <function>LoaderReqSymbols()</function> then this function returns a
- non-zero value. If none of these symbols are unresolved the return
- value is zero, indicating success.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The <parameter>delayflag</parameter> parameter should normally be set to
- <constant>LD_RESOLV_IFDONE</constant>.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- LoaderErrorMsg(const char *name, const char *modname,
- int errmaj, int errmin);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function prints an error message that includes the text <quote>Failed
- to load module</quote>, the module name <parameter>modname</parameter>, a message
- specific to the <parameter>errmaj</parameter> value, and the value if
- <parameter>errmin</parameter>. If <parameter>name</parameter> is
- non-<constant>NULL</constant>, it is printed as an identifying prefix
- to the message (followed by a <quote>:</quote>).
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>Special Registration Functions</title>
-
- <para>
-The loader contains some functions for registering some classes of modules.
-These may be moved out of the loader at some point.
- </para>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void LoadExtension(ExtensionModule *ext);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This registers the entry points for the extension identified by
- <parameter>ext</parameter>. The <structname>ExtensionModule</structname> struct is
- defined as:
-
- <programlisting>
-typedef struct {
- InitExtension initFunc;
- char * name;
- Bool *disablePtr;
- InitExtension setupFunc;
-} ExtensionModule;
- </programlisting>
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void LoadFont(FontModule *font);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This registers the entry points for the font rasteriser module
- identified by <parameter>font</parameter>. The <structname>FontModule</structname>
- struct is defined as:
-
- <programlisting>
- typedef struct {
- InitFont initFunc;
- char * name;
- pointer module;
-} FontModule;
- </programlisting>
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- </sect2>
-
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1>
- <title>Helper Functions</title>
-
- <para>
-This section describe <quote>helper</quote> functions that video driver
-might find useful. While video drivers are not required to use any of
-these to be considered <quote>compliant</quote>, the use of appropriate helpers is
-strongly encouraged to improve the consistency of driver behaviour.
- </para>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>Functions for printing messages</title>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- ErrorF(const char *format, ...);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This is the basic function for writing to the error log (typically
- stderr and/or a log file). Video drivers should usually avoid
- using this directly in favour of the more specialised functions
- described below. This function is useful for printing messages
- while debugging a driver.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- FatalError(const char *format, ...);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This prints a message and causes the Xserver to abort. It should
- rarely be used within a video driver, as most error conditions
- should be flagged by the return values of the driver functions.
- This allows the higher layers to decide how to proceed. In rare
- cases, this can be used within a driver if a fatal unexpected
- condition is found.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- xf86ErrorF(const char *format, ...);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This is like <function>ErrorF()</function>, except that the message is
- only printed when the Xserver's verbosity level is set to the
- default (<constant>1</constant>) or higher. It means that the messages
- are not printed when the server is started with the
- <option>-quiet</option> flag. Typically this function would only be
- used for continuing messages started with one of the more specialised
- functions described below.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- xf86ErrorFVerb(int verb, const char *format, ...);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Like <function>xf86ErrorF()</function>, except the minimum verbosity
- level for which the message is to be printed is given explicitly.
- Passing a <parameter>verb</parameter> value of zero means the message
- is always printed. A value higher than <constant>1</constant> can be
- used for information would normally not be needed, but which might
- be useful when diagnosing problems.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- xf86Msg(MessageType type, const char *format, ...);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This is like <function>xf86ErrorF()</function>, except that the message
- is prefixed with a marker determined by the value of
- <parameter>type</parameter>. The marker is used to indicate the type of
- message (warning, error, probed value, config value, etc). Note
- the <varname>xf86Verbose</varname> value is ignored for messages of
- type <constant>X_ERROR</constant>.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The marker values are:
-
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>X_PROBED</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>Value was probed.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>X_CONFIG</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>Value was given in the config file.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>X_DEFAULT</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>Value is a default.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>X_CMDLINE</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>Value was given on the command line.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>X_NOTICE</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>Notice.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>X_ERROR</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>Error message.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>X_WARNING</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>Warning message.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>X_INFO</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>Informational message.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>X_NONE</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>No prefix.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>X_NOT_IMPLEMENTED</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>The message relates to functionality
- that is not yetimplemented.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
-
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- xf86MsgVerb(MessageType type, int verb, const char *format, ...);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Like <function>xf86Msg()</function>, but with the verbosity level given
- explicitly.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- xf86DrvMsg(int scrnIndex, MessageType type, const char *format, ...);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This is like <function>xf86Msg()</function> except that the driver's
- name (the <structfield>name</structfield> field of the
- <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>) followed by the
- <parameter>scrnIndex</parameter> in parentheses is printed following the
- prefix. This should be used by video drivers in most cases as it
- clearly indicates which driver/screen the message is for. If
- <parameter>scrnIndex</parameter> is negative, this function behaves
- exactly like <function>xf86Msg()</function>.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- NOTE: This function can only be used after the
- <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> and its <structfield>name</structfield> field
- have been allocated. Normally, this means that it can not be
- used before the END of the <function>ChipProbe()</function> function.
- Prior to that, use <function>xf86Msg()</function>, providing the
- driver's name explicitly. No screen number can be supplied at
- that point.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- xf86DrvMsgVerb(int scrnIndex, MessageType type, int verb,
- const char *format, ...);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Like <function>xf86DrvMsg()</function>, but with the verbosity level
- given explicitly.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
- </sect2>
-
-
- <sect2>
- <title>Functions for setting values based on command line and config file</title>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- Bool xf86SetDepthBpp(ScrnInfoPtr scrp, int depth, int bpp,
-
- int fbbpp, int depth24flags);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function sets the <structfield>depth</structfield>, <structfield>pixmapBPP</structfield> and <structfield>bitsPerPixel</structfield> fields
- of the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>. It also determines the defaults for display-wide
- attributes and pixmap formats the screen will support, and finds
- the Display subsection that matches the depth/bpp. This function
- should normally be called very early from the
- <function>ChipPreInit()</function> function.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- It requires that the <structfield>confScreen</structfield> field of the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> be
- initialised prior to calling it. This is done by the XFree86
- common layer prior to calling <function>ChipPreInit()</function>.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The parameters passed are:
-
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><parameter>depth</parameter></term>
- <listitem><para>
- driver's preferred default depth if no other is given.
- If zero, use the overall server default.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><parameter>bpp</parameter></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Same, but for the pixmap bpp.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><parameter>fbbpp</parameter></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Same, but for the framebuffer bpp.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><parameter>depth24flags</parameter></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Flags that indicate the level of 24/32bpp support
- and whether conversion between different framebuffer
- and pixmap formats is supported. The flags for this
- argument are defined as follows, and multiple flags
- may be ORed together:
-
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>NoDepth24Support</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>No depth 24 formats supported
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>Support24bppFb</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>24bpp framebuffer supported
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>Support32bppFb</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>32bpp framebuffer supported
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>SupportConvert24to32</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>Can convert 24bpp pixmap to 32bpp fb
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>SupportConvert32to24</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>Can convert 32bpp pixmap to 24bpp fb
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>ForceConvert24to32</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>Force 24bpp pixmap to 32bpp fb conversion
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>ForceConvert32to24</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>Force 32bpp pixmap to 24bpp fb conversion
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- </variablelist>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- It uses the command line, config file, and default values in the
- correct order of precedence to determine the depth and bpp values.
- It is up to the driver to check the results to see that it supports
- them. If not the <function>ChipPreInit()</function> function should
- return <constant>FALSE</constant>.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- If only one of depth/bpp is given, the other is set to a reasonable
- (and consistent) default.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- If a driver finds that the initial <parameter>depth24flags</parameter>
- it uses later results in a fb format that requires more video
- memory than is available it may call this function a second time
- with a different <parameter>depth24flags</parameter> setting.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- On success, the return value is <constant>TRUE</constant>. On failure
- it prints an error message and returns <constant>FALSE</constant>.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The following fields of the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> are
- initialised by this function:
-
- <blockquote><para>
-<structfield>depth</structfield>, <structfield>bitsPerPixel</structfield>,
-<structfield>display</structfield>, <structfield>imageByteOrder</structfield>,
-<structfield>bitmapScanlinePad</structfield>,
-<structfield>bitmapScanlineUnit</structfield>, <structfield>bitmapBitOrder</structfield>,
-<structfield>numFormats</structfield>, <structfield>formats</structfield>,
-<structfield>fbFormat</structfield>.
- </para></blockquote>
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void xf86PrintDepthBpp(scrnInfoPtr scrp);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function can be used to print out the depth and bpp settings.
- It should be called after the final call to
- <function>xf86SetDepthBpp()</function>.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- Bool xf86SetWeight(ScrnInfoPtr scrp, rgb weight, rgb mask);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function sets the <structfield>weight</structfield>, <structfield>mask</structfield>,
- <structfield>offset</structfield> and <structfield>rgbBits</structfield> fields of the
- <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>. It would normally be called fairly
- early in the <function>ChipPreInit()</function> function for
- depths > 8bpp.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- It requires that the <structfield>depth</structfield> and
- <structfield>display</structfield> fields of the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>
- be initialised prior to calling it.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The parameters passed are:
-
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><parameter>weight</parameter></term>
- <listitem><para>
- driver's preferred default weight if no other is given.
- If zero, use the overall server default.
-
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><parameter>mask</parameter></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Same, but for mask.
-
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- It uses the command line, config file, and default values in the
- correct order of precedence to determine the weight value. It
- derives the mask and offset values from the weight and the defaults.
- It is up to the driver to check the results to see that it supports
- them. If not the <function>ChipPreInit()</function> function should
- return <constant>FALSE</constant>.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- On success, this function prints a message showing the weight
- values selected, and returns <constant>TRUE</constant>.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- On failure it prints an error message and returns <constant>FALSE</constant>.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The following fields of the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> are
- initialised by this function:
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <structfield>weight</structfield>,
- <structfield>mask</structfield>,
- <structfield>offset</structfield>.
- </para></blockquote>
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- Bool xf86SetDefaultVisual(ScrnInfoPtr scrp, int visual);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function sets the <structfield>defaultVisual</structfield> field of the
- <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>. It would normally be called fairly
- early from the <function>ChipPreInit()</function> function.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- It requires that the <structfield>depth</structfield> and
- <structfield>display</structfield> fields of the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>
- be initialised prior to calling it.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The parameters passed are:
-
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><parameter>visual</parameter></term>
- <listitem><para>
- driver's preferred default visual if no other is given.
- If <constant>-1</constant>, use the overall server default.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- </variablelist>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- It uses the command line, config file, and default values in the
- correct order of precedence to determine the default visual value.
- It is up to the driver to check the result to see that it supports
- it. If not the <function>ChipPreInit()</function> function should
- return <constant>FALSE</constant>.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- On success, this function prints a message showing the default visual
- selected, and returns <constant>TRUE</constant>.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- On failure it prints an error message and returns <constant>FALSE</constant>.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- Bool xf86SetGamma(ScrnInfoPtr scrp, Gamma gamma);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function sets the <structfield>gamma</structfield> field of the
- <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>. It would normally be called fairly
- early from the <function>ChipPreInit()</function> function in cases
- where the driver supports gamma correction.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- It requires that the <structfield>monitor</structfield> field of the
- <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> be initialised prior to calling it.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The parameters passed are:
-
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><parameter>gamma</parameter></term>
- <listitem><para>
- driver's preferred default gamma if no other is given.
- If zero (<code>< 0.01</code>), use the overall server
- default.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- </variablelist>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- It uses the command line, config file, and default values in the
- correct order of precedence to determine the gamma value. It is
- up to the driver to check the results to see that it supports
- them. If not the <function>ChipPreInit()</function> function should
- return <constant>FALSE</constant>.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- On success, this function prints a message showing the gamma
- value selected, and returns <constant>TRUE</constant>.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- On failure it prints an error message and returns <constant>FALSE</constant>.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void xf86SetDpi(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, int x, int y);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function sets the <structfield>xDpi</structfield> and <structfield>yDpi</structfield>
- fields of the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>. The driver can specify
- preferred defaults by setting <parameter>x</parameter> and <parameter>y</parameter>
- to non-zero values. The <option>-dpi</option> command line option
- overrides all other settings. Otherwise, if the
- <emphasis>DisplaySize</emphasis> entry is present in the screen's &k.monitor;
- config file section, it is used together with the virtual size to
- calculate the dpi values. This function should be called after
- all the mode resolution has been done.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void xf86SetBlackWhitePixels(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This functions sets the <structfield>blackPixel</structfield> and
- <structfield>whitePixel</structfield> fields of the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>
- according to whether or not the <option>-flipPixels</option> command
- line options is present.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- const char *xf86GetVisualName(int visual);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Returns a printable string with the visual name matching the
- numerical visual class provided. If the value is outside the
- range of valid visual classes, <constant>NULL</constant> is returned.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>Primary Mode functions</title>
-
- <para>
-The primary mode helper functions are those which would normally be
-used by a driver, unless it has unusual requirements which cannot
-be catered for the by the helpers.
- </para>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- int xf86ValidateModes(ScrnInfoPtr scrp, DisplayModePtr availModes,
- char **modeNames, ClockRangePtr clockRanges,
- int *linePitches, int minPitch, int maxPitch,
- int pitchInc, int minHeight, int maxHeight,
- int virtualX, int virtualY,
- unsigned long apertureSize,
- LookupModeFlags strategy);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function basically selects the set of modes to use based on
- those available and the various constraints. It also sets some
- other related parameters. It is normally called near the end of
- the <function>ChipPreInit()</function> function.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The parameters passed to the function are:
-
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><parameter>availModes</parameter></term>
- <listitem><para>
- List of modes available for the monitor.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><parameter>modeNames</parameter></term>
- <listitem><para>
- List of mode names that the screen is requesting.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><parameter>clockRanges</parameter></term>
- <listitem><para>
- A list of clock ranges allowed by the driver. Each
- range includes whether interlaced or multiscan modes
- are supported for that range. See below for more on
- <parameter>clockRanges</parameter>.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><parameter>linePitches</parameter></term>
- <listitem><para>
- List of line pitches supported by the driver.
- This is optional and should be <constant>NULL</constant> when
- not used.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><parameter>minPitch</parameter></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Minimum line pitch supported by the driver. This must
- be supplied when <parameter>linePitches</parameter> is
- <constant>NULL</constant>, and is ignored otherwise.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><parameter>maxPitch</parameter></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Maximum line pitch supported by the driver. This is
- required when <parameter>minPitch</parameter> is required.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><parameter>pitchInc</parameter></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Granularity of horizontal pitch values as supported by
- the chipset. This is expressed in bits. This must be
- supplied.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><parameter>minHeight</parameter></term>
- <listitem><para>
- minimum virtual height allowed. If zero, no limit is
- imposed.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><parameter>maxHeight</parameter></term>
- <listitem><para>
- maximum virtual height allowed. If zero, no limit is
- imposed.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><parameter>virtualX</parameter></term>
- <listitem><para>
- If greater than zero, this is the virtual width value
- that will be used. Otherwise, the virtual width is
- chosen to be the smallest that can accommodate the modes
- selected.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><parameter>virtualY</parameter></term>
- <listitem><para>
- If greater than zero, this is the virtual height value
- that will be used. Otherwise, the virtual height is
- chosen to be the smallest that can accommodate the modes
- selected.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><parameter>apertureSize</parameter></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The size (in bytes) of the aperture used to access video
- memory.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><parameter>strategy</parameter></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The strategy to use when choosing from multiple modes
- with the same name. The options are:
-
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>LOOKUP_DEFAULT</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>???
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>LOOKUP_BEST_REFRESH</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>mode with best refresh rate
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>LOOKUP_CLOSEST_CLOCK</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>mode with closest matching clock
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>LOOKUP_LIST_ORDER</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>first usable mode in list
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
-
- The following options can also be combined (OR'ed) with
- one of the above:
-
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>LOOKUP_CLKDIV2</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>Allow halved clocks
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>LOOKUP_OPTIONAL_TOLERANCES</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Allow missing horizontal sync and/or vertical refresh
- ranges in the xorg.conf Monitor section
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
-
- <constant>LOOKUP_OPTIONAL_TOLERANCES</constant> should only be
- specified when the driver can ensure all modes it generates
- can sync on, or at least not damage, the monitor or digital
- flat panel. Horizontal sync and/or vertical refresh ranges
- specified by the user will still be honoured (and acted upon).
-
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- This function requires that the following fields of the
- <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> are initialised prior to calling it:
-
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>clock[]</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- List of discrete clocks (when non-programmable)
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>numClocks</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Number of discrete clocks (when non-programmable)
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>progClock</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Whether the clock is programmable or not
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>monitor</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Pointer to the applicable xorg.conf monitor section
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>fdFormat</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Format of the screen buffer
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>videoRam</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- total video memory size (in bytes)
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>maxHValue</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Maximum horizontal timing value allowed
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>maxVValue</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Maximum vertical timing value allowed
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>xInc</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Horizontal timing increment in pixels (defaults to 8)
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- This function fills in the following <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>
- fields:
-
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>modePool</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- A subset of the modes available to the monitor which
- are compatible with the driver.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>modes</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- One mode entry for each of the requested modes, with
- the status field of each filled in to indicate if
- the mode has been accepted or not. This list of
- modes is a circular list.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>virtualX</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The resulting virtual width.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>virtualY</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The resulting virtual height.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>displayWidth</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The resulting line pitch.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>virtualFrom</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Where the virtual size was determined from.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- </variablelist>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The first stage of this function checks that the
- <parameter>virtualX</parameter> and <parameter>virtualY</parameter> values
- supplied (if greater than zero) are consistent with the line pitch
- and <parameter>maxHeight</parameter> limitations. If not, an error
- message is printed, and the return value is <constant>-1</constant>.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The second stage sets up the mode pool, eliminating immediately
- any modes that exceed the driver's line pitch limits, and also
- the virtual width and height limits (if greater than zero). For
- each mode removed an informational message is printed at verbosity
- level <constant>2</constant>. If the mode pool ends up being empty,
- a warning message is printed, and the return value is
- <constant>0</constant>.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The final stage is to lookup each mode name, and fill in the remaining
- parameters. If an error condition is encountered, a message is
- printed, and the return value is <constant>-1</constant>. Otherwise,
- the return value is the number of valid modes found
- (<constant>0</constant> if none are found).
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Even if the supplied mode names include duplicates, no two names will
- ever match the same mode. Furthermore, if the supplied mode names do not
- yield a valid mode (including the case where no names are passed at all),
- the function will continue looking through the mode pool until it finds
- a mode that survives all checks, or until the mode pool is exhausted.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- A message is only printed by this function when a fundamental
- problem is found. It is intended that this function may be called
- more than once if there is more than one set of constraints that
- the driver can work within.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- If this function returns <constant>-1</constant>, the
- <function>ChipPreInit()</function> function should return
- <constant>FALSE</constant>.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- <parameter>clockRanges</parameter> is a linked list of clock ranges
- allowed by the driver. If a mode doesn't fit in any of the defined
- <parameter>clockRanges</parameter>, it is rejected. The first
- <literal remap="tt">clockRange</literal> that matches all requirements is used.
- This structure needs to be initialized to NULL when allocated.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- <parameter>clockRanges</parameter> contains the following fields:
-
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>minClock</structfield></term>
- <term><structfield>maxClock</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The lower and upper mode clock bounds for which the rest
- of the <structname>clockRange</structname> parameters apply.
- Since these are the mode clocks, they are not scaled
- with the <structfield>ClockMulFactor</structfield> and
- <structfield>ClockDivFactor</structfield>. It is up to the driver
- to adjust these values if they depend on the clock
- scaling factors.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>clockIndex</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- (not used yet) <constant>-1</constant> for programmable clocks
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>interlaceAllowed</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- <constant>TRUE</constant> if interlacing is allowed for this
- range
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>doubleScanAllowed</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- <constant>TRUE</constant> if doublescan or multiscan is allowed
- for this range
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>ClockMulFactor</structfield></term>
- <term><structfield>ClockDivFactor</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Scaling factors that are applied to the mode clocks ONLY
- before selecting a clock index (when there is no
- programmable clock) or a <structfield>SynthClock</structfield>
- value. This is useful for drivers that support pixel
- multiplexing or that need to scale the clocks because
- of hardware restrictions (like sending 24bpp data to an
- 8 bit RAMDAC using a tripled clock).
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Note that these parameters describe what must be done
- to the mode clock to achieve the data transport clock
- between graphics controller and RAMDAC. For example
- for <literal remap="tt">2:1</literal> pixel multiplexing, two pixels
- are sent to the RAMDAC on each clock. This allows the
- RAMDAC clock to be half of the actual pixel clock.
- Hence, <code>ClockMulFactor=1</code> and
- <code>ClockDivFactor=2</code>. This means that the
- clock used for clock selection (ie, determining the
- correct clock index from the list of discrete clocks)
- or for the <structfield>SynthClock</structfield> field in case of
- a programmable clock is: (<code>mode->Clock *
- ClockMulFactor) / ClockDivFactor</code>.
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>PrivFlags</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>
- This field is copied into the
- <literal remap="tt">mode->PrivFlags</literal> field when this
- <literal remap="tt">clockRange</literal> is selected by
- <function>xf86ValidateModes()</function>. It allows the
- driver to find out what clock range was selected, so it
- knows it needs to set up pixel multiplexing or any other
- range-dependent feature. This field is purely
- driver-defined: it may contain flag bits, an index or
- anything else (as long as it is an <literal remap="tt">INT</literal>).
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Note that the <structfield>mode->SynthClock</structfield> field is always
- filled in by <function>xf86ValidateModes()</function>: it will contain
- the <quote>data transport clock</quote>, which is the clock that will have
- to be programmed in the chip when it has a programmable clock, or
- the clock that will be picked from the clocks list when it is not
- a programmable one. Thus:
-
- <programlisting>
- mode->SynthClock = (mode->Clock * ClockMulFactor) / ClockDivFactor
- </programlisting>
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void xf86PruneDriverModes(ScrnInfoPtr scrp);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function deletes modes in the modes field of the
- <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> that have been marked as invalid.
- This is normally run after having run
- <function>xf86ValidateModes()</function> for the last time. For each
- mode that is deleted, a warning message is printed out indicating
- the reason for it being deleted.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void xf86SetCrtcForModes(ScrnInfoPtr scrp, int adjustFlags);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function fills in the <structname>Crtc*</structname> fields for all
- the modes in the <structfield>modes</structfield> field of the
- <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>. The <parameter>adjustFlags</parameter>
- parameter determines how the vertical CRTC values are scaled for
- interlaced modes. They are halved if it is
- <constant>INTERLACE_HALVE_V</constant>. The vertical CRTC values are
- doubled for doublescan modes, and are further multiplied by the
- <literal remap="tt">VScan</literal> value.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- This function is normally called after calling
- <function>xf86PruneDriverModes()</function>.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void xf86PrintModes(ScrnInfoPtr scrp);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function prints out the virtual size setting, and the line
- pitch being used. It also prints out two lines for each mode being
- used. The first line includes the mode's pixel clock, horizontal sync
- rate, refresh rate, and whether it is interlaced, doublescanned and/or
- multi-scanned. The second line is the mode's Modeline.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- This function is normally called after calling
- <function>xf86SetCrtcForModes()</function>.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>Secondary Mode functions</title>
-
- <para>
-The secondary mode helper functions are functions which are normally
-used by the primary mode helper functions, and which are not normally
-called directly by a driver. If a driver has unusual requirements
-and needs to do its own mode validation, it might be able to make
-use of some of these secondary mode helper functions.
- </para>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- int xf86GetNearestClock(ScrnInfoPtr scrp, int freq, Bool allowDiv2,
- int *divider);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function returns the index of the closest clock to the
- frequency <parameter>freq</parameter> given (in kHz). It assumes that
- the number of clocks is greater than zero. It requires that the
- <structfield>numClocks</structfield> and <structfield>clock</structfield> fields of the
- <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> are initialised. The
- <structfield>allowDiv2</structfield> field determines if the clocks can be
- halved. The <parameter>*divider</parameter> return value indicates
- whether clock division is used when determining the clock returned.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- This function is only for non-programmable clocks.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- const char *xf86ModeStatusToString(ModeStatus status);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function converts the <parameter>status</parameter> value to a
- descriptive printable string.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- ModeStatus xf86LookupMode(ScrnInfoPtr scrp, DisplayModePtr modep,
- ClockRangePtr clockRanges, LookupModeFlags strategy);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function takes a pointer to a mode with the name filled in,
- and looks for a mode in the <structfield>modePool</structfield> list which
- matches. The parameters of the matching mode are filled in to
- <parameter>*modep</parameter>. The <parameter>clockRanges</parameter> and
- <parameter>strategy</parameter> parameters are as for the
- <function>xf86ValidateModes()</function> function above.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- This function requires the <structfield>modePool</structfield>,
- <structfield>clock[]</structfield>, <structfield>numClocks</structfield> and
- <structfield>progClock</structfield> fields of the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>
- to be initialised before being called.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The return value is <constant>MODE_OK</constant> if a mode was found.
- Otherwise it indicates why a matching mode could not be found.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- ModeStatus xf86InitialCheckModeForDriver(ScrnInfoPtr scrp,
- DisplayModePtr mode, ClockRangePtr clockRanges,
- LookupModeFlags strategy, int maxPitch,
- int virtualX, int virtualY);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function checks the passed mode against some basic driver
- constraints. Apart from the ones passed explicitly, the
- <structfield>maxHValue</structfield> and <structfield>maxVValue</structfield> fields of
- the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> are also used. If the
- <structfield>ValidMode</structfield> field of the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>
- is set, that function is also called to check the mode. Next, the
- mode is checked against the monitor's constraints.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- If the mode is consistent with all constraints, the return value
- is <constant>MODE_OK</constant>. Otherwise the return value indicates
- which constraint wasn't met.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void xf86DeleteMode(DisplayModePtr *modeList, DisplayModePtr mode);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function deletes the <parameter>mode</parameter> given from the
- <parameter>modeList</parameter>. It never prints any messages, so it is
- up to the caller to print a message if required.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>Functions for handling strings and tokens</title>
-
- <para>
- Tables associating strings and numerical tokens combined with the
- following functions provide a compact way of handling strings from
- the config file, and for converting tokens into printable strings.
- The table data structure is:
-
- <programlisting>
-typedef struct {
- int token;
- const char * name;
-} SymTabRec, *SymTabPtr;
- </programlisting>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- A table is an initialised array of <structname>SymTabRec</structname>. The
- tokens must be non-negative integers. Multiple names may be mapped
- to a single token. The table is terminated with an element with a
- <structfield>token</structfield> value of <constant>-1</constant> and
- <constant>NULL</constant> for the <structfield>name</structfield>.
- </para>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- const char *xf86TokenToString(SymTabPtr table, int token);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function returns the first string in <parameter>table</parameter>
- that matches <parameter>token</parameter>. If no match is found,
- <constant>NULL</constant> is returned (NOTE, older versions of this
- function would return the string "unknown" when no match is found).
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- int xf86StringToToken(SymTabPtr table, const char *string);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function returns the first token in <parameter>table</parameter>
- that matches <parameter>string</parameter>. The
- <function>xf86NameCmp()</function> function is used to determine the
- match. If no match is found, <constant>-1</constant> is returned.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>Functions for finding which config file entries to use</title>
-
- <para>
- These functions can be used to select the appropriate config file
- entries that match the detected hardware. They are described above
- in the <link linkend="probe">Probe</link> and
- <link linkend="avail">Available Functions</link> sections.
- </para>
-
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>Probing discrete clocks on old hardware</title>
-
- <para>
- The <function>xf86GetClocks()</function> function may be used to assist
- in finding the discrete pixel clock values on older hardware.
- </para>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void xf86GetClocks(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, int num,
- Bool (*ClockFunc)(ScrnInfoPtr, int),
- void (*ProtectRegs)(ScrnInfoPtr, Bool),
- void (*BlankScreen)(ScrnInfoPtr, Bool),
- int vertsyncreg, int maskval, int knownclkindex,
- int knownclkvalue);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function uses a comparative sampling method to measure the
- discrete pixel clock values. The number of discrete clocks to
- measure is given by <parameter>num</parameter>. <parameter>clockFunc</parameter>
- is a function that selects the <parameter>n</parameter>'th clock. It
- should also save or restore any state affected by programming the
- clocks when the index passed is <constant>CLK_REG_SAVE</constant> or
- <constant>CLK_REG_RESTORE</constant>. <parameter>ProtectRegs</parameter> is
- a function that does whatever is required to protect the hardware
- state while selecting a new clock. <parameter>BlankScreen</parameter>
- is a function that blanks the screen. <parameter>vertsyncreg</parameter>
- and <parameter>maskval</parameter> are the register and bitmask to
- check for the presence of vertical sync pulses.
- <parameter>knownclkindex</parameter> and <parameter>knownclkvalue</parameter>
- are the index and value of a known clock. These are the known
- references on which the comparative measurements are based. The
- number of clocks probed is set in <structfield>pScrn->numClocks</structfield>,
- and the probed clocks are set in the <structfield>pScrn->clock[]</structfield>
- array. All of the clock values are in units of kHz.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void xf86ShowClocks(ScrnInfoPtr scrp, MessageType from);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Print out the pixel clocks <parameter>scrp->clock[]</parameter>.
- <parameter>from</parameter> indicates whether the clocks were probed
- or from the config file.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>Other helper functions</title>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- Bool xf86IsUnblank(int mode);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Returns <constant>TRUE</constant> when the screen saver mode specified
- by <parameter>mode</parameter> requires the screen be unblanked,
- and <constant>FALSE</constant> otherwise. The screen saver modes that
- require blanking are <constant>SCREEN_SAVER_ON</constant> and
- <constant>SCREEN_SAVER_CYCLE</constant>, and the screen saver modes that
- require unblanking are <constant>SCREEN_SAVER_OFF</constant> and
- <constant>SCREEN_SAVER_FORCER</constant>. Drivers may call this helper
- from their <function>SaveScreen()</function> function to interpret the
- screen saver modes.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
- </sect2>
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1>
- <title>The vgahw module</title>
-
- <para>
-The vgahw modules provides an interface for saving, restoring and
-programming the standard VGA registers, and for handling VGA colourmaps.
- </para>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>Data Structures</title>
-
- <para>
- The public data structures used by the vgahw module are
- <structname>vgaRegRec</structname> and <structname>vgaHWRec</structname>. They are
- defined in <filename>vgaHW.h.</filename>
- </para>
-
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>General vgahw Functions</title>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- Bool vgaHWGetHWRec(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function allocates a <structname>vgaHWRec</structname> structure, and
- hooks it into the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>'s
- <structfield>privates</structfield>. Like all information hooked into the
- <structfield>privates</structfield>, it is persistent, and only needs to be
- allocated once per screen. This function should normally be called
- from the driver's <function>ChipPreInit()</function> function. The
- <structname>vgaHWRec</structname> is zero-allocated, and the following
- fields are explicitly initialised:
-
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>ModeReg.DAC[]</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>initialised with a default colourmap
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>ModeReg.Attribute[0x11]</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>initialised with the default overscan index
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>ShowOverscan</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>initialised according to the "ShowOverscan" option
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>paletteEnabled</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>initialised to FALSE
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>cmapSaved</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>initialised to FALSE
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><structfield>pScrn</structfield></term>
- <listitem><para>initialised to pScrn
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- In addition to the above, <function>vgaHWSetStdFuncs()</function> is
- called to initialise the register access function fields with the
- standard VGA set of functions.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Once allocated, a pointer to the <structname>vgaHWRec</structname> can be
- obtained from the <literal remap="tt">ScrnInfoPtr</literal> with the
- <literal remap="tt">VGAHWPTR(pScrn)</literal> macro.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void vgaHWFreeHWRec(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function frees a <structname>vgaHWRec</structname> structure. It
- should be called from a driver's <function>ChipFreeScreen()</function>
- function.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- Bool vgaHWSetRegCounts(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, int numCRTC,
- int numSequencer, int numGraphics, int numAttribute);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function allows the number of CRTC, Sequencer, Graphics and
- Attribute registers to be changed. This makes it possible for
- extended registers to be saved and restored with
- <function>vgaHWSave()</function> and <function>vgaHWRestore()</function>.
- This function should be called after a <structname>vgaHWRec</structname>
- has been allocated with <function>vgaHWGetHWRec()</function>. The
- default values are defined in <filename>vgaHW.h</filename> as follows:
-
- <programlisting>
-#define VGA_NUM_CRTC 25
-#define VGA_NUM_SEQ 5
-#define VGA_NUM_GFX 9
-#define VGA_NUM_ATTR 21
- </programlisting>
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- Bool vgaHWCopyReg(vgaRegPtr dst, vgaRegPtr src);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function copies the contents of the VGA saved registers in
- <parameter>src</parameter> to <parameter>dst</parameter>. Note that it isn't
- possible to simply do this with <function>memcpy()</function> (or
- similar). This function returns <constant>TRUE</constant> unless there
- is a problem allocating space for the <structfield>CRTC</structfield> and
- related fields in <parameter>dst</parameter>.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void vgaHWSetStdFuncs(vgaHWPtr hwp);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function initialises the register access function fields of
- <parameter>hwp</parameter> with the standard VGA set of functions. This
- is called by <function>vgaHWGetHWRec()</function>, so there is usually
- no need to call this explicitly. The register access functions
- are described below. If the registers are shadowed in some other
- port I/O space (for example a PCI I/O region), these functions
- can be used to access the shadowed registers if
- <structfield>hwp->PIOOffset</structfield> is initialised with
- <literal remap="tt">offset</literal>, calculated in such a way that when the
- standard VGA I/O port value is added to it the correct offset into
- the PIO area results. This value is initialised to zero in
- <function>vgaHWGetHWRec()</function>. (Note: the PIOOffset functionality
- is present in XFree86 4.1.0 and later.)
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void vgaHWSetMmioFuncs(vgaHWPtr hwp, CARD8 *base, int offset);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function initialised the register access function fields of
- hwp with a generic MMIO set of functions.
- <structfield>hwp->MMIOBase</structfield> is initialised with
- <parameter>base</parameter>, which must be the virtual address that the
- start of MMIO area is mapped to. <structfield>hwp->MMIOOffset</structfield>
- is initialised with <parameter>offset</parameter>, which must be calculated
- in such a way that when the standard VGA I/O port value is added
- to it the correct offset into the MMIO area results. That means
- that these functions are only suitable when the VGA I/O ports are
- made available in a direct mapping to the MMIO space. If that is
- not the case, the driver will need to provide its own register
- access functions. The register access functions are described
- below.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- Bool vgaHWMapMem(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function maps the VGA memory window. It requires that the
- <structname>vgaHWRec</structname> be allocated. If a driver requires
- non-default <structfield>MapPhys</structfield> or <structfield>MapSize</structfield>
- settings (the physical location and size of the VGA memory window)
- then those fields of the <structname>vgaHWRec</structname> must be initialised
- before calling this function. Otherwise, this function initialiases
- the default values of <constant>0xA0000</constant> for
- <structfield>MapPhys</structfield> and <code>(64 * 1024)</code> for
- <structfield>MapSize</structfield>. This function must be called before
- attempting to save or restore the VGA state. If the driver doesn't
- call it explicitly, the <function>vgaHWSave()</function> and
- <function>vgaHWRestore()</function> functions may call it if they need
- to access the VGA memory (in which case they will also call
- <function>vgaHWUnmapMem()</function> to unmap the VGA memory before
- exiting).
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void vgaHWUnmapMem(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function unmaps the VGA memory window. It must only be called
- after the memory has been mapped. The <structfield>Base</structfield> field
- of the <structname>vgaHWRec</structname> field is set to <constant>NULL</constant>
- to indicate that the memory is no longer mapped.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void vgaHWGetIOBase(vgaHWPtr hwp);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function initialises the <structfield>IOBase</structfield> field of the
- <structname>vgaHWRec</structname>. This function must be called before
- using any other functions that access the video hardware.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- A macro <function>VGAHW_GET_IOBASE()</function> is also available in
- <filename>vgaHW.h</filename> that returns the I/O base, and this may
- be used when the vgahw module is not loaded (for example, in the
- <function>ChipProbe()</function> function).
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void vgaHWUnlock(vgaHWPtr hwp);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function unlocks the VGA <literal remap="tt">CRTC[0-7]</literal> registers,
- and must be called before attempting to write to those registers.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void vgaHWLock(vgaHWPtr hwp);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function locks the VGA <literal remap="tt">CRTC[0-7]</literal> registers.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void vgaHWEnable(vgaHWPtr hwp);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function enables the VGA subsystem. (Note, this function is
- present in XFree86 4.1.0 and later.).
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void vgaHWDisable(vgaHWPtr hwp);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function disables the VGA subsystem. (Note, this function is
- present in XFree86 4.1.0 and later.).
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void vgaHWSave(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, vgaRegPtr save, int flags);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function saves the VGA state. The state is written to the
- <structname>vgaRegRec</structname> pointed to by <parameter>save</parameter>.
- <parameter>flags</parameter> is set to one or more of the following flags
- ORed together:
-
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>VGA_SR_MODE</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>the mode setting registers are saved
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>VGA_SR_FONTS</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>the text mode font/text data is saved
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>VGA_SR_CMAP</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>the colourmap (LUT) is saved
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><constant>VGA_SR_ALL</constant></term>
- <listitem><para>all of the above are saved
- </para></listitem></varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The <structname>vgaHWRec</structname> and its <structfield>IOBase</structfield> fields
- must be initialised before this function is called. If
- <constant>VGA_SR_FONTS</constant> is set in <parameter>flags</parameter>, the
- VGA memory window must be mapped. If it isn't then
- <function>vgaHWMapMem()</function> will be called to map it, and
- <function>vgaHWUnmapMem()</function> will be called to unmap it
- afterwards. <function>vgaHWSave()</function> uses the three functions
- below in the order <function>vgaHWSaveColormap()</function>,
- <function>vgaHWSaveMode()</function>, <function>vgaHWSaveFonts()</function> to
- carry out the different save phases. It is undecided at this
- stage whether they will remain part of the vgahw module's public
- interface or not.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void vgaHWSaveMode(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, vgaRegPtr save);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function saves the VGA mode registers. They are saved to
- the <structname>vgaRegRec</structname> pointed to by <parameter>save</parameter>.
- The registers saved are:
-
- <literallayout>
- MiscOut
- CRTC[0-0x18]
- Attribute[0-0x14]
- Graphics[0-8]
- Sequencer[0-4]
- </literallayout>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The number of registers actually saved may be modified by a prior call
- to <function>vgaHWSetRegCounts()</function>.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void vgaHWSaveFonts(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, vgaRegPtr save);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function saves the text mode font and text data held in the
- video memory. If called while in a graphics mode, no save is
- done. The VGA memory window must be mapped with
- <function>vgaHWMapMem()</function> before to calling this function.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- On some platforms, one or more of the font/text plane saves may be
- no-ops. This is the case when the platform's VC driver already
- takes care of this.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void vgaHWSaveColormap(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, vgaRegPtr save);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function saves the VGA colourmap (LUT). Before saving it, it
- attempts to verify that the colourmap is readable. In rare cases
- where it isn't readable, a default colourmap is saved instead.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void vgaHWRestore(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, vgaRegPtr restore, int flags);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function programs the VGA state. The state programmed is
- that contained in the <structname>vgaRegRec</structname> pointed to by
- <parameter>restore</parameter>. <parameter>flags</parameter> is the same
- as described above for the <function>vgaHWSave()</function> function.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The <structname>vgaHWRec</structname> and its <structfield>IOBase</structfield> fields
- must be initialised before this function is called. If
- <constant>VGA_SR_FONTS</constant> is set in <parameter>flags</parameter>, the
- VGA memory window must be mapped. If it isn't then
- <function>vgaHWMapMem()</function> will be called to map it, and
- <function>vgaHWUnmapMem()</function> will be called to unmap it
- afterwards. <function>vgaHWRestore()</function> uses the three functions
- below in the order <function>vgaHWRestoreFonts()</function>,
- <function>vgaHWRestoreMode()</function>,
- <function>vgaHWRestoreColormap()</function> to carry out the different
- restore phases. It is undecided at this stage whether they will
- remain part of the vgahw module's public interface or not.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void vgaHWRestoreMode(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, vgaRegPtr restore);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function restores the VGA mode registers. They are restored
- from the data in the <structname>vgaRegRec</structname> pointed to by
- <parameter>restore</parameter>. The registers restored are:
-
- <literallayout>
- MiscOut
- CRTC[0-0x18]
- Attribute[0-0x14]
- Graphics[0-8]
- Sequencer[0-4]
- </literallayout>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The number of registers actually restored may be modified by a prior call
- to <function>vgaHWSetRegCounts()</function>.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void vgaHWRestoreFonts(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, vgaRegPtr restore);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function restores the text mode font and text data to the
- video memory. The VGA memory window must be mapped with
- <function>vgaHWMapMem()</function> before to calling this function.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- On some platforms, one or more of the font/text plane restores
- may be no-ops. This is the case when the platform's VC driver
- already takes care of this.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void vgaHWRestoreColormap(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, vgaRegPtr restore);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function restores the VGA colourmap (LUT).
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void vgaHWInit(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, DisplayModePtr mode);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function fills in the <structname>vgaHWRec</structname>'s
- <structfield>ModeReg</structfield> field with the values appropriate for
- programming the given video mode. It requires that the
- <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>'s <structfield>depth</structfield> field is
- initialised, which determines how the registers are programmed.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void vgaHWSeqReset(vgaHWPtr hwp, Bool start);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Do a VGA sequencer reset. If start is <constant>TRUE</constant>, the
- reset is started. If start is <constant>FALSE</constant>, the reset
- is ended.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void vgaHWProtect(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, Bool on);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function protects VGA registers and memory from corruption
- during loads. It is typically called with on set to
- <constant>TRUE</constant> before programming, and with on set to
- <constant>FALSE</constant> after programming.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- Bool vgaHWSaveScreen(ScreenPtr pScreen, int mode);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function blanks and unblanks the screen. It is blanked when
- <parameter>mode</parameter> is <constant>SCREEN_SAVER_ON</constant> or
- <constant>SCREEN_SAVER_CYCLE</constant>, and unblanked when
- <parameter>mode</parameter> is <constant>SCREEN_SAVER_OFF</constant> or
- <constant>SCREEN_SAVER_FORCER</constant>.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void vgaHWBlankScreen(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, Bool on);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- This function blanks and unblanks the screen. It is blanked when
- <parameter>on</parameter> is <constant>FALSE</constant>, and unblanked when
- <parameter>on</parameter> is <constant>TRUE</constant>. This function is
- provided for use in cases where the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>
- can't be derived from the <structname>ScreenRec</structname> (while probing
- for clocks, for example).
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>VGA Colormap Functions</title>
-
- <para>
- The vgahw module uses the standard colormap support (see the
- <link linkend="cmap">Colormap Handling</link> section. This is initialised
- with the following function:
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- Bool vgaHWHandleColormaps(ScreenPtr pScreen);
- </programlisting>
- </para></blockquote>
- </para>
-
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>VGA Register Access Functions</title>
-
- <para>
- The vgahw module abstracts access to the standard VGA registers by
- using a set of functions held in the <structname>vgaHWRec</structname>. When
- the <structname>vgaHWRec</structname> is created these function pointers are
- initialised with the set of standard VGA I/O register access functions.
- In addition to these, the vgahw module includes a basic set of MMIO
- register access functions, and the <structname>vgaHWRec</structname> function
- pointers can be initialised to these by calling the
- <function>vgaHWSetMmioFuncs()</function> function described above. Some
- drivers/platforms may require a different set of functions for VGA
- access. The access functions are described here.
- </para>
-
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void writeCrtc(vgaHWPtr hwp, CARD8 index, CARD8 value);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Write <parameter>value</parameter> to CRTC register <parameter>index</parameter>.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- CARD8 readCrtc(vgaHWPtr hwp, CARD8 index);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Return the value read from CRTC register <parameter>index</parameter>.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void writeGr(vgaHWPtr hwp, CARD8 index, CARD8 value);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Write <parameter>value</parameter> to Graphics Controller register
- <parameter>index</parameter>.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- CARD8 readGR(vgaHWPtr hwp, CARD8 index);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Return the value read from Graphics Controller register
- <parameter>index</parameter>.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void writeSeq(vgaHWPtr hwp, CARD8 index, CARD8, value);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Write <parameter>value</parameter> to Sequencer register
- <parameter>index</parameter>.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- CARD8 readSeq(vgaHWPtr hwp, CARD8 index);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Return the value read from Sequencer register <parameter>index</parameter>.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void writeAttr(vgaHWPtr hwp, CARD8 index, CARD8, value);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Write <parameter>value</parameter> to Attribute Controller register
- <parameter>index</parameter>. When writing out the index value this
- function should set bit 5 (<constant>0x20</constant>) according to the
- setting of <structfield>hwp->paletteEnabled</structfield> in order to
- preserve the palette access state. It should be cleared when
- <structfield>hwp->paletteEnabled</structfield> is <constant>TRUE</constant>
- and set when it is <constant>FALSE</constant>.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- CARD8 readAttr(vgaHWPtr hwp, CARD8 index);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Return the value read from Attribute Controller register
- <parameter>index</parameter>. When writing out the index value this
- function should set bit 5 (<constant>0x20</constant>) according to the
- setting of <structfield>hwp->paletteEnabled</structfield> in order to
- preserve the palette access state. It should be cleared when
- <structfield>hwp->paletteEnabled</structfield> is <constant>TRUE</constant>
- and set when it is <constant>FALSE</constant>.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void writeMiscOut(vgaHWPtr hwp, CARD8 value);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Write <quote><parameter>value</parameter></quote> to the Miscellaneous Output register.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- CARD8 readMiscOut(vgwHWPtr hwp);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Return the value read from the Miscellaneous Output register.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void enablePalette(vgaHWPtr hwp);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Clear the palette address source bit in the Attribute Controller
- index register and set <literal remap="tt">hwp->paletteEnabled</literal> to
- <constant>TRUE</constant>.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void disablePalette(vgaHWPtr hwp);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Set the palette address source bit in the Attribute Controller
- index register and set <literal remap="tt">hwp->paletteEnabled</literal> to
- <constant>FALSE</constant>.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void writeDacMask(vgaHWPtr hwp, CARD8 value);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Write <parameter>value</parameter> to the DAC Mask register.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- CARD8 readDacMask(vgaHWptr hwp);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Return the value read from the DAC Mask register.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void writeDacReadAddress(vgaHWPtr hwp, CARD8 value);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Write <parameter>value</parameter> to the DAC Read Address register.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void writeDacWriteAddress(vgaHWPtr hwp, CARD8 value);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Write <parameter>value</parameter> to the DAC Write Address register.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void writeDacData(vgaHWPtr hwp, CARD8 value);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Write <parameter>value</parameter> to the DAC Data register.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- CARD8 readDacData(vgaHWptr hwp);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Return the value read from the DAC Data register.
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- CARD8 readEnable(vgaHWptr hwp);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Return the value read from the VGA Enable register. (Note: This
- function is present in XFree86 4.1.0 and later.)
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
-
- <blockquote><para>
- <programlisting>
- void writeEnable(vgaHWPtr hwp, CARD8 value);
- </programlisting>
- <blockquote><para>
- Write <parameter>value</parameter> to the VGA Enable register. (Note: This
- function is present in XFree86 4.1.0 and later.)
- </para>
-
- </blockquote></para></blockquote>
- </sect2>
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1 id="sample">
- <title>Some notes about writing a driver</title>
-
- <note><para>NOTE: some parts of this are not up to date</para></note>
-
- <para>
-The following is an outline for writing a basic unaccelerated driver
-for a PCI video card with a linear mapped framebuffer, and which has a
-VGA core. It is includes some general information that is relevant to
-most drivers (even those which don't fit that basic description).
- </para>
-
- <para>
-The information here is based on the initial conversion of the Matrox
-Millennium driver to the <quote>new design</quote>. For a fleshing out and sample
-implementation of some of the bits outlined here, refer to that driver.
-Note that this is an example only. The approach used here will not be
-appropriate for all drivers.
- </para>
-
- <para>
-Each driver must reserve a unique driver name, and a string that is used
-to prefix all of its externally visible symbols. This is to avoid name
-space clashes when loading multiple drivers. The examples here are for
-the <quote>ZZZ</quote> driver, which uses the <quote>ZZZ</quote> or <quote>zzz</quote> prefix for its externally
-visible symbols.
- </para>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>Include files</title>
-
- <para>
- All drivers normally include the following headers:
- <literallayout><filename>
- "xf86.h"
- "xf86_OSproc.h"
- "xf86_ansic.h"
- "xf86Resources.h"
- </filename></literallayout>
- Wherever inb/outb (and related things) are used the following should be
- included:
- <literallayout><filename>
- "compiler.h"
- </filename></literallayout>
- Note: in drivers, this must be included after <filename>"xf86_ansic.h"</filename>.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Drivers that need to access PCI vendor/device definitions need this:
- <literallayout><filename>
- "xf86PciInfo.h"
- </filename></literallayout>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Drivers that need to access the PCI config space need this:
- <literallayout><filename>
- "xf86Pci.h"
- </filename></literallayout>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Drivers using the mi banking wrapper need:
-
- <literallayout><filename>
- "mibank.h"
- </filename></literallayout>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Drivers that initialise a SW cursor need this:
- <literallayout><filename>
- "mipointer.h"
- </filename></literallayout>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- All drivers implementing backing store need this:
- <literallayout><filename>
- "mibstore.h"
- </filename></literallayout>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- All drivers using the mi colourmap code need this:
- <literallayout><filename>
- "micmap.h"
- </filename></literallayout>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- If a driver uses the vgahw module, it needs this:
- <literallayout><filename>
- "vgaHW.h"
- </filename></literallayout>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Drivers supporting VGA or Hercules monochrome screens need:
- <literallayout><filename>
- "xf1bpp.h"
- </filename></literallayout>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Drivers supporting VGA or EGC 16-colour screens need:
- <literallayout><filename>
- "xf4bpp.h"
- </filename></literallayout>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Drivers using cfb need:
- <programlisting>
- #define PSZ 8
- #include "cfb.h"
- #undef PSZ
- </programlisting>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Drivers supporting bpp 16, 24 or 32 with cfb need one or more of:
- <literallayout><filename>
- "cfb16.h"
- "cfb24.h"
- "cfb32.h"
- </filename></literallayout>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The driver's own header file:
- <literallayout><filename>
- "zzz.h"
- </filename></literallayout>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Drivers must NOT include the following:
-
- <literallayout><filename>
- "xf86Priv.h"
- "xf86Privstr.h"
- "xf86_libc.h"
- "xf86_OSlib.h"
- "Xos.h"</filename>
- any OS header
- </literallayout>
- </para>
-
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>Data structures and initialisation</title>
-
- <itemizedlist>
- <listitem>
- <para>The following macros should be defined:
- <programlisting>
-#define VERSION <version-as-an-int>
-#define ZZZ_NAME "ZZZ" /* the name used to prefix messages */
-#define ZZZ_DRIVER_NAME "zzz" /* the driver name as used in config file */
-#define ZZZ_MAJOR_VERSION <int>
-#define ZZZ_MINOR_VERSION <int>
-#define ZZZ_PATCHLEVEL <int>
- </programlisting>
- </para>
- <para>
- NOTE: <constant>ZZZ_DRIVER_NAME</constant> should match the name of the
- driver module without things like the "lib" prefix, the "_drv" suffix
- or filename extensions.
- </para>
- </listitem>
-
- <listitem>
- <para>
- A DriverRec must be defined, which includes the functions required
- at the pre-probe phase. The name of this DriverRec must be an
- upper-case version of ZZZ_DRIVER_NAME (for the purposes of static
- linking).
- <programlisting>
-DriverRec ZZZ = {
- VERSION,
- ZZZ_DRIVER_NAME,
- ZZZIdentify,
- ZZZProbe,
- ZZZAvailableOptions,
- NULL,
- 0
-};
- </programlisting>
- </para>
- </listitem>
-
- <listitem>
- <para>Define list of supported chips and their matching ID:
- <programlisting>
-static SymTabRec ZZZChipsets[] = {
- { PCI_CHIP_ZZZ1234, "zzz1234a" },
- { PCI_CHIP_ZZZ5678, "zzz5678a" },
- { -1, NULL }
-};
- </programlisting>
- </para>
- <para>
- The token field may be any integer value that the driver may use to
- uniquely identify the supported chipsets. For drivers that support
- only PCI devices using the PCI device IDs might be a natural choice,
- but this isn't mandatory. For drivers that support both PCI and other
- devices (like ISA), some other ID should probably used. When other
- IDs are used as the tokens it is recommended that the names be
- defined as an <type>enum</type> type.
- </para>
- </listitem>
-
- <listitem>
- <para>
- If the driver uses the <function>xf86MatchPciInstances()</function>
- helper (recommended for drivers that support PCI cards) a list that
- maps PCI IDs to chip IDs and fixed resources must be defined:
- <programlisting>
-static PciChipsets ZZZPciChipsets[] = {
- { PCI_CHIP_ZZZ1234, PCI_CHIP_ZZZ1234, RES_SHARED_VGA },
- { PCI_CHIP_ZZZ5678, PCI_CHIP_ZZZ5678, RES_SHARED_VGA },
- { -1, -1, RES_UNDEFINED }
-}
- </programlisting>
- </para>
- </listitem>
-
- <listitem>
- <para>
- Define the <structname>XF86ModuleVersionInfo</structname> struct for the
- driver. This is required for the dynamically loaded version:
- <programlisting>
-static XF86ModuleVersionInfo zzzVersRec =
-{
- "zzz",
- MODULEVENDORSTRING,
- MODINFOSTRING1,
- MODINFOSTRING2,
- XF86_VERSION_CURRENT,
- ZZZ_MAJOR_VERSION, ZZZ_MINOR_VERSION, ZZZ_PATCHLEVEL,
- ABI_CLASS_VIDEODRV,
- ABI_VIDEODRV_VERSION,
- MOD_CLASS_VIDEODRV,
- {0,0,0,0}
-};
- </programlisting>
- </para>
- </listitem>
-
- <listitem>
- <para>
- Define a data structure to hold the driver's screen-specific data.
- This must be used instead of global variables. This would be defined
- in the <filename>"zzz.h"</filename> file, something like:
- <programlisting>
-typedef struct {
- type1 field1;
- type2 field2;
- int fooHack;
- Bool pciRetry;
- Bool noAccel;
- Bool hwCursor;
- CloseScreenProcPtr CloseScreen;
- OptionInfoPtr Options;
- ...
-} ZZZRec, *ZZZPtr;
- </programlisting>
- </para>
- </listitem>
-
- <listitem>
- <para>
- Define the list of config file Options that the driver accepts. For
- consistency between drivers those in the list of <quote>standard</quote> options
- should be used where appropriate before inventing new options.
-
- <programlisting>
-typedef enum {
- OPTION_FOO_HACK,
- OPTION_PCI_RETRY,
- OPTION_HW_CURSOR,
- OPTION_NOACCEL
-} ZZZOpts;
-
-static const OptionInfoRec ZZZOptions[] = {
- { OPTION_FOO_HACK, "FooHack", OPTV_INTEGER, {0}, FALSE },
- { OPTION_PCI_RETRY, "PciRetry", OPTV_BOOLEAN, {0}, FALSE },
- { OPTION_HW_CURSOR, "HWcursor", OPTV_BOOLEAN, {0}, FALSE },
- { OPTION_NOACCEL, "NoAccel", OPTV_BOOLEAN, {0}, FALSE },
- { -1, NULL, OPTV_NONE, {0}, FALSE }
-};
- </programlisting>
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </itemizedlist>
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2>
- <title>Functions</title>
-
-
- <sect3>
- <title>SetupProc</title>
-
- <para>
- For dynamically loaded modules, a <varname>ModuleData</varname>
- variable is required. It is should be the name of the driver
- prepended to "ModuleData". A <function>Setup()</function> function is
- also required, which calls <function>xf86AddDriver()</function> to add
- the driver to the main list of drivers.
- </para>
-
- <programlisting>
-static MODULESETUPPROTO(zzzSetup);
-
-XF86ModuleData zzzModuleData = { &zzzVersRec, zzzSetup, NULL };
-
-static pointer
-zzzSetup(pointer module, pointer opts, int *errmaj, int *errmin)
-{
- static Bool setupDone = FALSE;
-
- /* This module should be loaded only once, but check to be sure. */
-
- if (!setupDone) {
- /*
- * Modules that this driver always requires may be loaded
- * here by calling LoadSubModule().
- */
-
- setupDone = TRUE;
- xf86AddDriver(&MGA, module, 0);
-
- /*
- * The return value must be non-NULL on success even though
- * there is no TearDownProc.
- */
- return (pointer)1;
- } else {
- if (errmaj) *errmaj = LDR_ONCEONLY;
- return NULL;
- }
-}
- </programlisting>
- </sect3>
-
- <sect3>
- <title>GetRec, FreeRec</title>
-
- <para>
- A function is usually required to allocate the driver's
- screen-specific data structure and hook it into the
- <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>'s <structfield>driverPrivate</structfield> field.
- The <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>'s <structfield>driverPrivate</structfield> is
- initialised to <constant>NULL</constant>, so it is easy to check if the
- initialisation has already been done. After allocating it, initialise
- the fields. By using <function>xnfcalloc()</function> to do the allocation
- it is zeroed, and if the allocation fails the server exits.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- NOTE:
- When allocating structures from inside the driver which are defined
- on the common level it is important to initialize the structure to
- zero.
- Only this guarantees that the server remains source compatible to
- future changes in common level structures.
- </para>
-
- <programlisting>
-static Bool
-ZZZGetRec(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn)
-{
- if (pScrn->driverPrivate != NULL)
- return TRUE;
- pScrn->driverPrivate = xnfcalloc(sizeof(ZZZRec), 1);
- /* Initialise as required */
- ...
- return TRUE;
-}
- </programlisting>
-
- <para>
- Define a macro in <filename>"zzz.h"</filename> which gets a pointer to
- the <structname>ZZZRec</structname> when given <parameter>pScrn</parameter>:
-
- <programlisting>
-#define ZZZPTR(p) ((ZZZPtr)((p)->driverPrivate))
- </programlisting>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Define a function to free the above, setting it to <constant>NULL</constant>
- once it has been freed:
-
- <programlisting>
-static void
-ZZZFreeRec(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn)
-{
- if (pScrn->driverPrivate == NULL)
- return;
- xfree(pScrn->driverPrivate);
- pScrn->driverPrivate = NULL;
-}
- </programlisting>
- </para>
- </sect3>
-
- <sect3>
- <title>Identify</title>
-
- <para>
- Define the <function>Identify()</function> function. It is run before
- the Probe, and typically prints out an identifying message, which
- might include the chipsets it supports. This function is mandatory:
-
- <programlisting>
-static void
-ZZZIdentify(int flags)
-{
- xf86PrintChipsets(ZZZ_NAME, "driver for ZZZ Tech chipsets",
- ZZZChipsets);
-}
- </programlisting>
- </para>
- </sect3>
-
- <sect3>
- <title>Probe</title>
-
- <para>
- Define the <function>Probe()</function> function. The purpose of this
- is to find all instances of the hardware that the driver supports,
- and for the ones not already claimed by another driver, claim the
- slot, and allocate a <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>. This should be
- a minimal probe, and it should under no circumstances leave the
- state of the hardware changed. Because a device is found, don't
- assume that it will be used. Don't do any initialisations other
- than the required <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> initialisations.
- Don't allocate any new data structures.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- This function is mandatory.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- NOTE: The <function>xf86DrvMsg()</function> functions cannot be used from
- the Probe.
- </para>
-
- <programlisting>
-static Bool
-ZZZProbe(DriverPtr drv, int flags)
-{
- Bool foundScreen = FALSE;
- int numDevSections, numUsed;
- GDevPtr *devSections;
- int *usedChips;
- int i;
-
- /*
- * Find the config file Device sections that match this
- * driver, and return if there are none.
- */
- if ((numDevSections = xf86MatchDevice(ZZZ_DRIVER_NAME,
- &devSections)) <= 0) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- /*
- * Since this is a PCI card, "probing" just amounts to checking
- * the PCI data that the server has already collected. If there
- * is none, return.
- *
- * Although the config file is allowed to override things, it
- * is reasonable to not allow it to override the detection
- * of no PCI video cards.
- *
- * The provided xf86MatchPciInstances() helper takes care of
- * the details.
- */
- /* test if PCI bus present */
- if (xf86GetPciVideoInfo()) {
-
- numUsed = xf86MatchPciInstances(ZZZ_NAME, PCI_VENDOR_ZZZ,
- ZZZChipsets, ZZZPciChipsets, devSections,
- numDevSections, drv, &usedChips);
-
- for (i = 0; i < numUsed; i++) {
- ScrnInfoPtr pScrn = NULL;
- if ((pScrn = xf86ConfigPciEntity(pScrn, flags, usedChips[i],
- ZZZPciChipsets, NULL, NULL,
- NULL, NULL, NULL))) {
- /* Allocate a ScrnInfoRec */
- pScrn->driverVersion = VERSION;
- pScrn->driverName = ZZZ_DRIVER_NAME;
- pScrn->name = ZZZ_NAME;
- pScrn->Probe = ZZZProbe;
- pScrn->PreInit = ZZZPreInit;
- pScrn->ScreenInit = ZZZScreenInit;
- pScrn->SwitchMode = ZZZSwitchMode;
- pScrn->AdjustFrame = ZZZAdjustFrame;
- pScrn->EnterVT = ZZZEnterVT;
- pScrn->LeaveVT = ZZZLeaveVT;
- pScrn->FreeScreen = ZZZFreeScreen;
- pScrn->ValidMode = ZZZValidMode;
- foundScreen = TRUE;
- /* add screen to entity */
- }
- }
- xfree(usedChips);
- }
-
-#ifdef HAS_ISA_DEVS
- /*
- * If the driver supports ISA hardware, the following block
- * can be included too.
- */
- numUsed = xf86MatchIsaInstances(ZZZ_NAME, ZZZChipsets,
- ZZZIsaChipsets, drv, ZZZFindIsaDevice,
- devSections, numDevSections, &usedChips);
- for (i = 0; i < numUsed; i++) {
- ScrnInfoPtr pScrn = NULL;
- if ((pScrn = xf86ConfigIsaEntity(pScrn, flags, usedChips[i],
- ZZZIsaChipsets, NULL, NULL, NULL,
- NULL, NULL))) {
- pScrn->driverVersion = VERSION;
- pScrn->driverName = ZZZ_DRIVER_NAME;
- pScrn->name = ZZZ_NAME;
- pScrn->Probe = ZZZProbe;
- pScrn->PreInit = ZZZPreInit;
- pScrn->ScreenInit = ZZZScreenInit;
- pScrn->SwitchMode = ZZZSwitchMode;
- pScrn->AdjustFrame = ZZZAdjustFrame;
- pScrn->EnterVT = ZZZEnterVT;
- pScrn->LeaveVT = ZZZLeaveVT;
- pScrn->FreeScreen = ZZZFreeScreen;
- pScrn->ValidMode = ZZZValidMode;
- foundScreen = TRUE;
- }
- }
- xfree(usedChips);
-#endif /* HAS_ISA_DEVS */
-
- xfree(devSections);
- return foundScreen;
- </programlisting>
- </sect3>
-
- <sect3>
- <title>AvailableOptions</title>
-
- <para>
- Define the <function>AvailableOptions()</function> function. The purpose
- of this is to return the available driver options back to the
- -configure option, so that an xorg.conf file can be built and the
- user can see which options are available for them to use.
- </para>
- </sect3>
-
- <sect3>
- <title>PreInit</title>
-
- <para>
- Define the <function>PreInit()</function> function. The purpose of
- this is to find all the information required to determine if the
- configuration is usable, and to initialise those parts of the
- <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> that can be set once at the beginning
- of the first server generation. The information should be found in
- the least intrusive way possible.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- This function is mandatory.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- NOTES:
- <orderedlist>
- <listitem><para>
- The <function>PreInit()</function> function is only called once
- during the life of the X server (at the start of the first
- generation).
- </para></listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>
- Data allocated here must be of the type that persists for
- the life of the X server. This means that data that hooks into
- the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>'s <structfield>privates</structfield>
- field should be allocated here, but data that hooks into the
- <structname>ScreenRec</structname>'s <structfield>devPrivates</structfield> field
- should not be allocated here. The <structfield>driverPrivate</structfield>
- field should also be allocated here.
- </para></listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>
- Although the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> has been allocated
- before this function is called, the <structname>ScreenRec</structname>
- has not been allocated. That means that things requiring it
- cannot be used in this function.
- </para></listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>
- Very little of the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> has been
- initialised when this function is called. It is important to
- get the order of doing things right in this function.
- </para></listitem>
-
- </orderedlist>
- </para>
-
- <programlisting>
-static Bool
-ZZZPreInit(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, int flags)
-{
- /* Fill in the monitor field */
- pScrn->monitor = pScrn->confScreen->monitor;
-
- /*
- * If using the vgahw module, it will typically be loaded
- * here by calling xf86LoadSubModule(pScrn, "vgahw");
- */
-
- /*
- * Set the depth/bpp. Use the globally preferred depth/bpp. If the
- * driver has special default depth/bpp requirements, the defaults should
- * be specified here explicitly.
- * We support both 24bpp and 32bpp framebuffer layouts.
- * This sets pScrn->display also.
- */
- if (!xf86SetDepthBpp(pScrn, 0, 0, 0,
- Support24bppFb | Support32bppFb)) {
- return FALSE;
- } else {
- if (depth/bpp isn't one we support) {
- print error message;
- return FALSE;
- }
- }
- /* Print out the depth/bpp that was set */
- xf86PrintDepthBpp(pScrn);
-
- /* Set bits per RGB for 8bpp */
- if (pScrn->depth <= 8) {
- /* Take into account a dac_6_bit option here */
- pScrn->rgbBits = 6 or 8;
- }
-
- /*
- * xf86SetWeight() and xf86SetDefaultVisual() must be called
- * after pScrn->display is initialised.
- */
-
- /* Set weight/mask/offset for depth > 8 */
- if (pScrn->depth > 8) {
- if (!xf86SetWeight(pScrn, defaultWeight, defaultMask)) {
- return FALSE;
- } else {
- if (weight isn't one we support) {
- print error message;
- return FALSE;
- }
- }
- }
-
- /* Set the default visual. */
- if (!xf86SetDefaultVisual(pScrn, -1)) {
- return FALSE;
- } else {
- if (visual isn't one we support) {
- print error message;
- return FALSE;
- }
- }
-
- /* If the driver supports gamma correction, set the gamma. */
- if (!xf86SetGamma(pScrn, default_gamma)) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- /* This driver uses a programmable clock */
- pScrn->progClock = TRUE;
-
- /* Allocate the ZZZRec driverPrivate */
- if (!ZZZGetRec(pScrn)) {
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- pZzz = ZZZPTR(pScrn);
-
- /* Collect all of the option flags (fill in pScrn->options) */
- xf86CollectOptions(pScrn, NULL);
-
- /*
- * Process the options based on the information in ZZZOptions.
- * The results are written to pZzz->Options. If all of the options
- * processing is done within this function a local variable "options"
- * can be used instead of pZzz->Options.
- */
- if (!(pZzz->Options = xalloc(sizeof(ZZZOptions))))
- return FALSE;
- (void)memcpy(pZzz->Options, ZZZOptions, sizeof(ZZZOptions));
- xf86ProcessOptions(pScrn->scrnIndex, pScrn->options, pZzz->Options);
-
- /*
- * Set various fields of ScrnInfoRec and/or ZZZRec based on
- * the options found.
- */
- from = X_DEFAULT;
- pZzz->hwCursor = FALSE;
- if (xf86IsOptionSet(pZzz->Options, OPTION_HW_CURSOR)) {
- from = X_CONFIG;
- pZzz->hwCursor = TRUE;
- }
- xf86DrvMsg(pScrn->scrnIndex, from, "Using %s cursor\n",
- pZzz->hwCursor ? "HW" : "SW");
- if (xf86IsOptionSet(pZzz->Options, OPTION_NOACCEL)) {
- pZzz->noAccel = TRUE;
- xf86DrvMsg(pScrn->scrnIndex, X_CONFIG,
- "Acceleration disabled\n");
- } else {
- pZzz->noAccel = FALSE;
- }
- if (xf86IsOptionSet(pZzz->Options, OPTION_PCI_RETRY)) {
- pZzz->UsePCIRetry = TRUE;
- xf86DrvMsg(pScrn->scrnIndex, X_CONFIG, "PCI retry enabled\n");
- }
- pZzz->fooHack = 0;
- if (xf86GetOptValInteger(pZzz->Options, OPTION_FOO_HACK,
- &pZzz->fooHack)) {
- xf86DrvMsg(pScrn->scrnIndex, X_CONFIG, "Foo Hack set to %d\n",
- pZzz->fooHack);
- }
-
- /*
- * Find the PCI slot(s) that this screen claimed in the probe.
- * In this case, exactly one is expected, so complain otherwise.
- * Note in this case we're not interested in the card types so
- * that parameter is set to NULL.
- */
- if ((i = xf86GetPciInfoForScreen(pScrn->scrnIndex, &pciList, NULL))
- != 1) {
- print error message;
- ZZZFreeRec(pScrn);
- if (i > 0)
- xfree(pciList);
- return FALSE;
- }
- /* Note that pciList should be freed below when no longer needed */
-
- /*
- * Determine the chipset, allowing config file chipset and
- * chipid values to override the probed information. The config
- * chipset value has precedence over its chipid value if both
- * are present.
- *
- * It isn't necessary to fill in pScrn->chipset if the driver
- * keeps track of the chipset in its ZZZRec.
- */
-
- ...
-
- /*
- * Determine video memory, fb base address, I/O addresses, etc,
- * allowing the config file to override probed values.
- *
- * Set the appropriate pScrn fields (videoRam is probably the
- * most important one that other code might require), and
- * print out the settings.
- */
-
- ...
-
- /* Initialise a clockRanges list. */
-
- ...
-
- /* Set any other chipset specific things in the ZZZRec */
-
- ...
-
- /* Select valid modes from those available */
-
- i = xf86ValidateModes(pScrn, pScrn->monitor->Modes,
- pScrn->display->modes, clockRanges,
- NULL, minPitch, maxPitch, rounding,
- minHeight, maxHeight,
- pScrn->display->virtualX,
- pScrn->display->virtualY,
- pScrn->videoRam * 1024,
- LOOKUP_BEST_REFRESH);
- if (i == -1) {
- ZZZFreeRec(pScrn);
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- /* Prune the modes marked as invalid */
-
- xf86PruneDriverModes(pScrn);
-
- /* If no valid modes, return */
-
- if (i == 0 || pScrn->modes == NULL) {
- print error message;
- ZZZFreeRec(pScrn);
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- /*
- * Initialise the CRTC fields for the modes. This driver expects
- * vertical values to be halved for interlaced modes.
- */
- xf86SetCrtcForModes(pScrn, INTERLACE_HALVE_V);
-
- /* Set the current mode to the first in the list. */
- pScrn->currentMode = pScrn->modes;
-
- /* Print the list of modes being used. */
- xf86PrintModes(pScrn);
-
- /* Set the DPI */
- xf86SetDpi(pScrn, 0, 0);
-
- /* Load bpp-specific modules */
- switch (pScrn->bitsPerPixel) {
- case 1:
- mod = "xf1bpp";
- break;
- case 4:
- mod = "xf4bpp";
- break;
- case 8:
- mod = "cfb";
- break;
- case 16:
- mod = "cfb16";
- break;
- case 24:
- mod = "cfb24";
- break;
- case 32:
- mod = "cfb32";
- break;
- }
- if (mod && !xf86LoadSubModule(pScrn, mod))
- ZZZFreeRec(pScrn);
- return FALSE;
-
- /* Load XAA if needed */
- if (!pZzz->noAccel || pZzz->hwCursor)
- if (!xf86LoadSubModule(pScrn, "xaa")) {
- ZZZFreeRec(pScrn);
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- /* Done */
- return TRUE;
-}
- </programlisting>
- </sect3>
-
- <sect3>
- <title>MapMem, UnmapMem</title>
-
- <para>
- Define functions to map and unmap the video memory and any other
- memory apertures required. These functions are not mandatory, but
- it is often useful to have such functions.
- </para>
-
- <programlisting>
-static Bool
-ZZZMapMem(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn)
-{
- /* Call xf86MapPciMem() to map each PCI memory area */
- ...
- return TRUE or FALSE;
-}
-
-static Bool
-ZZZUnmapMem(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn)
-{
- /* Call xf86UnMapVidMem() to unmap each memory area */
- ...
- return TRUE or FALSE;
-}
- </programlisting>
- </sect3>
-
- <sect3>
- <title>Save, Restore</title>
-
- <para>
- Define functions to save and restore the original video state. These
- functions are not mandatory, but are often useful.
- </para>
-
- <programlisting>
-static void
-ZZZSave(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn)
-{
- /*
- * Save state into per-screen data structures.
- * If using the vgahw module, vgaHWSave will typically be
- * called here.
- */
- ...
-}
-
-static void
-ZZZRestore(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn)
-{
- /*
- * Restore state from per-screen data structures.
- * If using the vgahw module, vgaHWRestore will typically be
- * called here.
- */
- ...
-}
- </programlisting>
- </sect3>
-
- <sect3>
- <title>ModeInit</title>
-
- <para>
- Define a function to initialise a new video mode. This function isn't
- mandatory, but is often useful.
- </para>
-
- <programlisting>
-static Bool
-ZZZModeInit(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, DisplayModePtr mode)
-{
- /*
- * Program a video mode. If using the vgahw module,
- * vgaHWInit and vgaRestore will typically be called here.
- * Once up to the point where there can't be a failure
- * set pScrn->vtSema to TRUE.
- */
- ...
-}
- </programlisting>
- </sect3>
-
- <sect3>
- <title>ScreenInit</title>
-
- <para>
- Define the <function>ScreenInit()</function> function. This is called
- at the start of each server generation, and should fill in as much
- of the <structname>ScreenRec</structname> as possible as well as any other
- data that is initialised once per generation. It should initialise
- the framebuffer layers it is using, and initialise the initial video
- mode.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- This function is mandatory.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- NOTE: The <structname>ScreenRec</structname> (<parameter>pScreen</parameter>) is
- passed to this driver, but it and the
- <varname>ScrnInfoRecs</varname> are not yet hooked into each
- other. This means that in this function, and functions it
- calls, one cannot be found from the other.
- </para>
-
- <programlisting>
-static Bool
-ZZZScreenInit(int scrnIndex, ScreenPtr pScreen, int argc, char **argv)
-{
- /* Get the ScrnInfoRec */
- pScrn = xf86Screens[pScreen->myNum];
-
- /*
- * If using the vgahw module, its data structures and related
- * things are typically initialised/mapped here.
- */
-
- /* Save the current video state */
- ZZZSave(pScrn);
-
- /* Initialise the first mode */
- ZZZModeInit(pScrn, pScrn->currentMode);
-
- /* Set the viewport if supported */
-
- ZZZAdjustFrame(scrnIndex, pScrn->frameX0, pScrn->frameY0, 0);
-
- /*
- * Setup the screen's visuals, and initialise the framebuffer
- * code.
- */
-
- /* Reset the visual list */
- miClearVisualTypes();
-
- /*
- * Setup the visuals supported. This driver only supports
- * TrueColor for bpp > 8, so the default set of visuals isn't
- * acceptable. To deal with this, call miSetVisualTypes with
- * the appropriate visual mask.
- */
-
- if (pScrn->bitsPerPixel > 8) {
- if (!miSetVisualTypes(pScrn->depth, TrueColorMask,
- pScrn->rgbBits, pScrn->defaultVisual))
- return FALSE;
- } else {
- if (!miSetVisualTypes(pScrn->depth,
- miGetDefaultVisualMask(pScrn->depth),
- pScrn->rgbBits, pScrn->defaultVisual))
- return FALSE;
- }
-
- /*
- * Initialise the framebuffer.
- */
-
- switch (pScrn->bitsPerPixel) {
- case 1:
- ret = xf1bppScreenInit(pScreen, FbBase,
- pScrn->virtualX, pScrn->virtualY,
- pScrn->xDpi, pScrn->yDpi,
- pScrn->displayWidth);
- break;
- case 4:
- ret = xf4bppScreenInit(pScreen, FbBase,
- pScrn->virtualX, pScrn->virtualY,
- pScrn->xDpi, pScrn->yDpi,
- pScrn->displayWidth);
- break;
- case 8:
- ret = cfbScreenInit(pScreen, FbBase,
- pScrn->virtualX, pScrn->virtualY,
- pScrn->xDpi, pScrn->yDpi,
- pScrn->displayWidth);
- break;
- case 16:
- ret = cfb16ScreenInit(pScreen, FbBase,
- pScrn->virtualX, pScrn->virtualY,
- pScrn->xDpi, pScrn->yDpi,
- pScrn->displayWidth);
- break;
- case 24:
- ret = cfb24ScreenInit(pScreen, FbBase,
- pScrn->virtualX, pScrn->virtualY,
- pScrn->xDpi, pScrn->yDpi,
- pScrn->displayWidth);
- break;
- case 32:
- ret = cfb32ScreenInit(pScreen, FbBase,
- pScrn->virtualX, pScrn->virtualY,
- pScrn->xDpi, pScrn->yDpi,
- pScrn->displayWidth);
- break;
- default:
- print a message about an internal error;
- ret = FALSE;
- break;
- }
-
- if (!ret)
- return FALSE;
-
- /* Override the default mask/offset settings */
- if (pScrn->bitsPerPixel > 8) {
- for (i = 0, visual = pScreen->visuals;
- i < pScreen->numVisuals; i++, visual++) {
- if ((visual->class | DynamicClass) == DirectColor) {
- visual->offsetRed = pScrn->offset.red;
- visual->offsetGreen = pScrn->offset.green;
- visual->offsetBlue = pScrn->offset.blue;
- visual->redMask = pScrn->mask.red;
- visual->greenMask = pScrn->mask.green;
- visual->blueMask = pScrn->mask.blue;
- }
- }
- }
-
- /*
- * If banking is needed, initialise an miBankInfoRec (defined in
- * "mibank.h"), and call miInitializeBanking().
- */
- if (!miInitializeBanking(pScreen, pScrn->virtualX, pScrn->virtualY,
- pScrn->displayWidth, pBankInfo))
- return FALSE;
-
- /*
- * If backing store is to be supported (as is usually the case),
- * initialise it.
- */
- miInitializeBackingStore(pScreen);
-
- /*
- * Set initial black & white colourmap indices.
- */
- xf86SetBlackWhitePixels(pScreen);
-
- /*
- * Install colourmap functions. If using the vgahw module,
- * vgaHandleColormaps would usually be called here.
- */
-
- ...
-
- /*
- * Initialise cursor functions. This example is for the mi
- * software cursor.
- */
- miDCInitialize(pScreen, xf86GetPointerScreenFuncs());
-
- /* Initialise the default colourmap */
- switch (pScrn->depth) {
- case 1:
- if (!xf1bppCreateDefColormap(pScreen))
- return FALSE;
- break;
- case 4:
- if (!xf4bppCreateDefColormap(pScreen))
- return FALSE;
- break;
- default:
- if (!cfbCreateDefColormap(pScreen))
- return FALSE;
- break;
- }
-
- /*
- * Wrap the CloseScreen vector and set SaveScreen.
- */
- ZZZPTR(pScrn)->CloseScreen = pScreen->CloseScreen;
- pScreen->CloseScreen = ZZZCloseScreen;
- pScreen->SaveScreen = ZZZSaveScreen;
-
- /* Report any unused options (only for the first generation) */
- if (serverGeneration == 1) {
- xf86ShowUnusedOptions(pScrn->scrnIndex, pScrn->options);
- }
-
- /* Done */
- return TRUE;
-}
- </programlisting>
- </sect3>
-
- <sect3>
- <title>SwitchMode</title>
-
- <para>
- Define the <function>SwitchMode()</function> function if mode switching
- is supported by the driver.
- </para>
-
- <programlisting>
-static Bool
-ZZZSwitchMode(int scrnIndex, DisplayModePtr mode, int flags)
-{
- return ZZZModeInit(xf86Screens[scrnIndex], mode);
-}
- </programlisting>
- </sect3>
-
- <sect3>
- <title>AdjustFrame</title>
-
- <para>
- Define the <function>AdjustFrame()</function> function if the driver
- supports this.
- </para>
-
- <programlisting>
-static void
-ZZZAdjustFrame(int scrnIndex, int x, int y, int flags)
-{
- /* Adjust the viewport */
-}
- </programlisting>
- </sect3>
-
- <sect3>
- <title>EnterVT, LeaveVT</title>
-
- <para>
- Define the <function>EnterVT()</function> and <function>LeaveVT()</function>
- functions.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- These functions are mandatory.
- </para>
-
- <programlisting>
-static Bool
-ZZZEnterVT(int scrnIndex, int flags)
-{
- ScrnInfoPtr pScrn = xf86Screens[scrnIndex];
- return ZZZModeInit(pScrn, pScrn->currentMode);
-}
-
-static void
-ZZZLeaveVT(int scrnIndex, int flags)
-{
- ScrnInfoPtr pScrn = xf86Screens[scrnIndex];
- ZZZRestore(pScrn);
-}
- </programlisting>
- </sect3>
-
- <sect3>
- <title>CloseScreen</title>
-
- <para>
- Define the <function>CloseScreen()</function> function:
- </para>
-
- <para>
- This function is mandatory. Note that it unwraps the previously
- wrapped <structfield>pScreen->CloseScreen</structfield>, and finishes by
- calling it.
- </para>
-
- <programlisting>
-static Bool
-ZZZCloseScreen(int scrnIndex, ScreenPtr pScreen)
-{
- ScrnInfoPtr pScrn = xf86Screens[scrnIndex];
- if (pScrn->vtSema) {
- ZZZRestore(pScrn);
- ZZZUnmapMem(pScrn);
- }
- pScrn->vtSema = FALSE;
- pScreen->CloseScreen = ZZZPTR(pScrn)->CloseScreen;
- return (*pScreen->CloseScreen)(scrnIndex, pScreen);
-}
- </programlisting>
- </sect3>
-
- <sect3>
- <title>SaveScreen</title>
-
- <para>
- Define the <function>SaveScreen()</function> function (the screen
- blanking function). When using the vgahw module, this will typically
- be:
-
- <programlisting>
-static Bool
-ZZZSaveScreen(ScreenPtr pScreen, int mode)
-{
- return vgaHWSaveScreen(pScreen, mode);
-}
- </programlisting>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- This function is mandatory. Before modifying any hardware register
- directly this function needs to make sure that the Xserver is active
- by checking if <parameter>pScrn</parameter> is non-NULL and for
- <literal remap="tt">pScrn->vtSema == TRUE</literal>.
- </para>
- </sect3>
-
- <sect3>
- <title>FreeScreen</title>
-
- <para>
- Define the <function>FreeScreen()</function> function. This function
- is optional. It should be defined if the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>
- <structfield>driverPrivate</structfield> field is used so that it can be freed
- when a screen is deleted by the common layer for reasons possibly
- beyond the driver's control. This function is not used in during
- normal (error free) operation. The per-generation data is freed by
- the <function>CloseScreen()</function> function.
- </para>
-
- <programlisting>
-static void
-ZZZFreeScreen(int scrnIndex, int flags)
-{
- /*
- * If the vgahw module is used vgaHWFreeHWRec() would be called
- * here.
- */
- ZZZFreeRec(xf86Screens[scrnIndex]);
-}
-
- </programlisting>
-
- </sect3>
-
- </sect2>
-
- </sect1>
-
-</article>
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="ISO-8859-1"?> +<!DOCTYPE article PUBLIC "-//OASIS//DTD DocBook XML V4.3//EN" + "http://www.oasis-open.org/docbook/xml/4.3/docbookx.dtd" [ + <!ENTITY % defs SYSTEM "/xserver/doc/xml/xserver.ent"> %defs; + <!-- config file keyword markup --> + <!-- specific config file keywords --> + <!ENTITY k.device "<emphasis>Device</emphasis>"> + <!ENTITY k.monitor "<emphasis>Monitor</emphasis>"> + <!ENTITY k.display "<emphasis>Display</emphasis>"> + <!ENTITY k.inputdevice "<emphasis>InputDevice</emphasis>"> + <!ENTITY k.screen "<emphasis>Screen</emphasis>"> + <!ENTITY k.serverlayout "<emphasis>ServerLayout</emphasis>"> + <!ENTITY k.driver "<emphasis>Driver</emphasis>"> + <!ENTITY k.module "<emphasis>Module</emphasis>"> + <!ENTITY k.identifier "<emphasis>Identifier</emphasis>"> + <!ENTITY k.serverflags "<emphasis>ServerFlags</emphasis>"> +] > + +<article id="ddxDesign"> + <articleinfo> + + <title>XFree86 DDX Design (Xorg server version &xserver.version;)</title> + + <authorgroup> + <corpauthor><ulink url="http://www.xfree86.org/"> + The XFree86 Project, Inc.</ulink></corpauthor> + <corpauthor><ulink url="http://www.x.org/"> + The X.Org Foundation, Inc.</ulink></corpauthor> + + <othercredit> + <firstname>Jim</firstname><surname>Gettys</surname> + <contrib>Updates for X11R6.7</contrib> + </othercredit> + </authorgroup> + + <pubdate>&xserver.reldate;</pubdate> + <releaseinfo>Xorg server version &xserver.version;</releaseinfo> + + </articleinfo> + + <note><para> +This document describes software undergoing continual evolution, and +the interfaces described here are subject to change without notice. +This document is intended to cover the interfaces as found in the +xorg-server-&xserver.version; release, but is probably not completely +in sync with the code base. + </para></note> + + + <sect1> + <title>Preface</title> + + <para> +This document was originally the design spec for the DDX layer of the +XFree86 4.0 X server. The X.Org Foundation adopted the XFree86 4.4rc2 +version of that server as the basis of the Xorg server project, and has +evolved the XFree86 DDX layer greatly since forking. This document thus +covers only the current implementation of the XFree86 DDX as found in the +Xorg server &xserver.version; release, and no longer matches the XFree86 +server itself. + </para> + + <para> +The XFree86 Project's broad design principles for XFree86 4.0 were: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem><para>keep it reasonable + <itemizedlist> + <listitem><para>We cannot rewrite the complete server + </para></listitem> + <listitem><para>We don't want to re-invent the wheel + </para></listitem> + </itemizedlist></para></listitem> + <listitem><para>keep it modular + <itemizedlist> + <listitem><para>As many things as possible should go into modules + </para></listitem> + <listitem><para>The basic loader binary should be minimal + </para></listitem> + <listitem><para>A clean design with well defined layering is + important</para></listitem> + <listitem><para>DDX specific global variables are a nono + </para></listitem> + <listitem><para>The structure should be flexible enough to allow + future extensions</para></listitem> + <listitem><para>The structure should minimize duplication of + common code</para></listitem> + </itemizedlist></para></listitem> + <listitem><para>keep important features in mind + <itemizedlist> + <listitem><para>multiple screens, including multiple instances + of drivers</para></listitem> + <listitem><para>mixing different color depths and visuals on + different and ideally even on the same screen + </para></listitem> + <listitem><para>better control of the PCI device used + </para></listitem> + <listitem><para>better config file parser</para></listitem> + <listitem><para>get rid of all VGA compatibility assumptions + </para></listitem> + </itemizedlist></para></listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + + <para> +While the XFree86 project had a goal of avoiding changes to the DIX +layer unless they found major deficiencies there, to avoid divergence from +the X.Org sample implementation they were integrating changes from, the +X.Org developers now maintain both sides, and make changes where they are +most appropriate. This document concentrates on the XFree86 DDX layer used +in the Xorg server itself (the code found in <filename>hw/xfree86</filename> +in the source tree), and developers will also want to refer to the +<filename>Xserver-spec</filename> documentation that covers the DIX layer +routines common to all the X servers in the sample implementation. + </para> + </sect1> + + <sect1> + <title>The xorg.conf File</title> + + <para> +The xorg.conf file format is based on the XF86Config format from XFree86 4.4, +which is in turn similar to the old XFree86 3.x XF86Config format, with the +following changes: + </para> + + <sect2> + <title>&k.device; section</title> + + <para> + The &k.device; sections are similar to what they used to be, and + describe hardware-specific information for a single video card. + &k.device; + Some new keywords are added: + + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry><term>Driver "drivername"</term> + <listitem><para> + Specifies the name of the driver to be used for the card. This + is mandatory. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + <varlistentry><term>BusID "busslot"</term> + <listitem><para> + Specifies uniquely the location of the card on the bus. The + purpose is to identify particular cards in a multi-headed + configuration. The format of the argument is intentionally + vague, and may be architecture dependent. For a PCI bus, it + is something like "bus:slot:func". + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + A &k.device; section is considered <quote>active</quote> if there is a reference + to it in an active &k.screen; section. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>&k.screen; section</title> + + <para> + The &k.screen; sections are similar to what they used to be. They + no longer have a &k.driver; keyword, but an &k.identifier; keyword + is added. (The &k.driver; keyword may be accepted in place of the + &k.identifier; keyword for compatibility purposes.) The identifier + can be used to identify which screen is to be active when multiple + &k.screen; sections are present. It is possible to specify the active + screen from the command line. A default is chosen in the absence + of one being specified. A &k.screen; section is considered <quote>active</quote> + if there is a reference to it either from the command line, or from + an active &k.serverlayout; section. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>&k.inputdevice; section</title> + + <para> + The &k.inputdevice; section is a new section that describes + configuration information for input devices. It replaces the old + <emphasis>Keyboard</emphasis>, <emphasis>Pointer</emphasis> and <emphasis>XInput</emphasis> + sections. Like the &k.device; section, it has two mandatory keywords: + &k.identifier; and &k.driver;. For compatibility purposes the old + <emphasis>Keyboard</emphasis> and <emphasis>Pointer</emphasis> sections are + converted by the parser into &k.inputdevice; sections as follows: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry><term><emphasis>Keyboard</emphasis></term> + <listitem><literallayout> + &k.identifier; "Implicit Core Keyboard" + &k.driver; "keyboard" + </literallayout></listitem></varlistentry> + <varlistentry><term><emphasis>Pointer</emphasis></term> + <listitem><literallayout> + &k.identifier; "Implicit Core Pointer" + &k.driver; "mouse" + </literallayout></listitem></varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + An &k.inputdevice; section is considered active if there is a + reference to it in an active &k.serverlayout; section. An + &k.inputdevice; section may also be referenced implicitly if there + is no &k.serverlayout; section, if the <option>-screen</option> command + line options is used, or if the &k.serverlayout; section doesn't + reference any &k.inputdevice; sections. In this case, the first + sections with drivers "keyboard" and "mouse" are used as the core + keyboard and pointer respectively. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>&k.serverlayout; section</title> + + <para> + The &k.serverlayout; section is a new section that is used to identify + which &k.screen; sections are to be used in a multi-headed configuration, + and the relative layout of those screens. It also identifies which + &k.inputdevice; sections are to be used. Each &k.serverlayout; section + has an identifier, a list of &k.screen; section identifiers, and a list of + &k.inputdevice; section identifiers. &k.serverflags; options may also be + included in a &k.serverlayout; section, making it possible to override + the global values in the &k.serverflags; section. + </para> + + <para> + A &k.serverlayout; section can be made active by being referenced on + the command line. In the absence of this, a default will be chosen + (the first one found). The screen names may optionally be followed + by a number specifying the preferred screen number, and optionally + by information specifying the physical positioning of the screen, + either in absolute terms or relative to another screen (or screens). + When no screen number is specified, they are numbered according to + the order in which they are listed. The old (now obsolete) method + of providing the positioning information is to give the names of + the four adjacent screens. The order of these is top, bottom, left, + right. Here is an example of a &k.serverlayout; section for two + screens using the old method, with the second located to the right + of the first: + + <programlisting> + Section "ServerLayout" + Identifier "Main Layout" + Screen 0 "Screen 1" "" "" "" "Screen 2" + Screen 1 "Screen 2" + Screen "Screen 3" + EndSection + </programlisting> + </para> + + <para> + The preferred way of specifying the layout is to explicitly specify + the screen's location in absolute terms or relative to another + screen. + </para> + + <para> + In the absolute case, the upper left corner's coordinates are given + after the <emphasis>Absolute</emphasis> keyword. If the coordinates are + omitted, a value of <code>(0,0)</code> is assumed. An example + of absolute positioning follows: + + <programlisting> + Section "ServerLayout" + Identifier "Main Layout" + Screen 0 "Screen 1" Absolute 0 0 + Screen 1 "Screen 2" Absolute 1024 0 + Screen "Screen 3" Absolute 2048 0 + EndSection + </programlisting> + </para> + + <para> + In the relative case, the position is specified by either using one of + the following keywords followed by the name of the reference screen: + + <simplelist type='vert' columns='1'> + <member><emphasis>RightOf</emphasis></member> + <member><emphasis>LeftOf</emphasis></member> + <member><emphasis>Above</emphasis></member> + <member><emphasis>Below</emphasis></member> + <member><emphasis>Relative</emphasis></member> + </simplelist> + </para> + + <para> + When the <emphasis>Relative</emphasis> keyword is used, the reference screen + name is followed by the coordinates of the new screen's origin + relative to reference screen. The following example shows how to use + some of the relative positioning options. + + <programlisting> + Section "ServerLayout" + Identifier "Main Layout" + Screen 0 "Screen 1" + Screen 1 "Screen 2" RightOf "Screen 1" + Screen "Screen 3" Relative "Screen 1" 2048 0 + EndSection + </programlisting> + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>Options</title> + + <para> + Options are used more extensively. They may appear in most sections + now. Options related to drivers can be present in the &k.screen;, + &k.device; and &k.monitor; sections and the &k.display; subsections. + The order of precedence is &k.display;, &k.screen;, &k.monitor;, + &k.device;. Options have been extended to allow an optional value + to be specified in addition to the option name. For more details + about options, see the <link linkend="options">Options</link> section + for details. + </para> + </sect2> + </sect1> + + <sect1> + <title>Driver Interface</title> + + <para> +The driver interface consists of a minimal set of entry points that are +required based on the external events that the driver must react to. +No non-essential structure is imposed on the way they are used beyond +that. This is a significant difference compared with the old design. + </para> + + <para> +The entry points for drawing operations are already taken care of by +the framebuffer code (including, XAA). Extensions and enhancements to +framebuffer code are outside the scope of this document. + </para> + + <para> +This approach to the driver interface provides good flexibility, but does +increase the complexity of drivers. To help address this, the XFree86 +common layer provides a set of <quote>helper</quote> functions to take care of things +that most drivers need. These helpers help minimise the amount of code +duplication between drivers. The use of helper functions by drivers is +however optional, though encouraged. The basic philosophy behind the +helper functions is that they should be useful to many drivers, that +they should balance this against the complexity of their interface. It +is inevitable that some drivers may find some helpers unsuitable and +need to provide their own code. + </para> + + <para> +Events that a driver needs to react to are: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry><term>ScreenInit</term> + + <listitem><para> + An initialisation function is called from the DIX layer for each + screen at the start of each server generation. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry><term>Enter VT</term> + + <listitem><para> + The server takes control of the console. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry><term>Leave VT</term> + + <listitem><para> + The server releases control of the console. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry><term>Mode Switch</term> + + <listitem><para> + Change video mode. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry><term>ViewPort change</term> + + <listitem><para> + Change the origin of the physical view port. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry><term>ScreenSaver state change</term> + + <listitem><para> + Screen saver activation/deactivation. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry><term>CloseScreen</term> + + <listitem><para> + A close screen function is called from the DIX layer for each screen + at the end of each server generation. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + + <para> +In addition to these events, the following functions are required by +the XFree86 common layer: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry><term>Identify</term> + + <listitem><para> + Print a driver identifying message. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry><term>Probe</term> + + <listitem><para> + This is how a driver identifies if there is any hardware present that + it knows how to drive. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry><term>PreInit</term> + + <listitem><para> + Process information from the xorg.conf file, determine the + full characteristics of the hardware, and determine if a valid + configuration is present. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> +The VidMode extension also requires: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry><term>ValidMode</term> + + <listitem><para> + Identify if a new mode is usable with the current configuration. + The PreInit function (and/or helpers it calls) may also make use + of the ValidMode function or something similar. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + + <para> +Other extensions may require other entry points. The drivers will +inform the common layer of these in such cases. + </para> + </sect1> + + <sect1> + <title>Resource Access Control Introduction</title> + + <para> +Graphics devices are accessed through ranges in I/O or memory space. +While most modern graphics devices allow relocation of such ranges many +of them still require the use of well established interfaces such as +VGA memory and IO ranges or 8514/A IO ranges. With modern buses (like +PCI) it is possible for multiple video devices to share access to these +resources. The RAC (Resource Access Control) subsystem provides a +mechanism for this. + </para> + + <sect2> + <title>Terms and Definitions</title> + + <sect3> + <title>Bus</title> + + <para> + <quote>Bus</quote> is ambiguous as it is used for different things: it may refer + to physical incompatible extension connectors in a computer system. + The RAC system knows two such systems: The ISA bus and the PCI bus. + (On the software level EISA, MCA and VL buses are currently treated + like ISA buses). <quote>Bus</quote> may also refer to logically different + entities on a single bus system which are connected via bridges. A + PCI system may have several distinct PCI buses connecting each other + by PCI-PCI bridges or to the host CPU by HOST-PCI bridges. + </para> + + <para> + Systems that host more than one bus system link these together using + bridges. Bridges are a concern to RAC as they might block or pass + specific resources. PCI-PCI bridges may be set up to pass VGA + resources to the secondary bus. PCI-ISA buses pass any resources not + decoded on the primary PCI bus to the ISA bus. This way VGA resources + (although exclusive on the ISA bus) can be shared by ISA and PCI + cards. Currently HOST-PCI bridges are not yet handled by RAC as they + require specific drivers. + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3> + <title>Entity</title> + + <para> + The smallest independently addressable unit on a system bus is + referred to as an entity. So far we know ISA and PCI entities. PCI + entities can be located on the PCI bus by an unique ID consisting of + the bus, card and function number. + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3> + <title>Resource</title> + + <para> + <quote>Resource</quote> refers to a range of memory or I/O addresses an entity + can decode. + </para> + + <para> + If a device is capable of disabling this decoding the resource is + called sharable. For PCI devices a generic method is provided to + control resource decoding. Other devices will have to provide a + device specific function to control decoding. + </para> + + <para> + If the entity is capable of decoding this range at a different + location this resource is considered relocatable. + </para> + + <para> + Resources which start at a specific address and occupy a single + continuous range are called block resources. + </para> + + <para> + Alternatively resource addresses can be decoded in a way that they + satisfy the conditions: + <programlisting> + address & mask == base + </programlisting> + and + <programlisting> + base & mask == base + </programlisting> + Resources addressed in such a way are called sparse resources. + </para> + + </sect3> + + <sect3> + <title>Server States</title> + + <para> + The resource access control system knows two server states: the + SETUP and the OPERATING state. The SETUP state is entered whenever + a mode change takes place or the server exits or does VT switching. + During this state all entity resources are under resource access + control. During OPERATING state only those entities are controlled + which actually have shared resources that conflict with others. + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> + </sect1> + + <sect1> + <title>Control Flow in the Server and Mandatory Driver Functions</title> + + <para> +At the start of each server generation, <function>main()</function> +(<filename>dix/main.c</filename>) calls the DDX function +<function>InitOutput()</function>. This is the first place that the DDX gets +control. <function>InitOutput()</function> is expected to fill in the global +<structname>screenInfo</structname> struct, and one +<structfield>screenInfo.screen[]</structfield> entry for each screen present. +Here is what <function>InitOutput()</function> does: + </para> + + <sect2> + <title>Parse the xorg.conf file</title> + + <para> + This is done at the start of the first server generation only. + </para> + + <para> + The xorg.conf file is read in full, and the resulting information + stored in data structures. None of the parsed information is + processed at this point. The parser data structures are opaque to + the video drivers and to most of the common layer code. + </para> + + <para> + The entire file is parsed first to remove any section ordering + requirements. + </para> + </sect2> + + + <sect2> + <title>Initial processing of parsed information and command line options + </title> + + <para> + This is done at the start of the first server generation only. + </para> + + <para> + The initial processing is to determine paths like the + <emphasis>ModulePath</emphasis>, etc, and to determine which &k.serverlayout;, + &k.screen; and &k.device; sections are active. + </para> + </sect2> + + + <sect2> + <title>Enable port I/O access</title> + + <para> + Port I/O access is controlled from the XFree86 common layer, and is + <quote>all or nothing</quote>. It is enabled prior to calling driver probes, at + the start of subsequent server generations, and when VT switching + back to the Xserver. It is disabled at the end of server generations, + and when VT switching away from the Xserver. + </para> + + <para> + The implementation details of this may vary on different platforms. + </para> + </sect2> + + + <sect2> + <title>General bus probe</title> + + <para> + This is done at the start of the first server generation only. + </para> + + <para> + In the case of ix86 machines, this will be a general PCI probe. + The full information obtained here will be available to the drivers. + This information persists for the life of the Xserver. In the PCI + case, the PCI information for all video cards found is available by + calling <function>xf86GetPciVideoInfo()</function>. + </para> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + pciVideoPtr *xf86GetPciVideoInfo(void); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + returns a pointer to a list of pointers to + <structname>pciVideoRec</structname> entries, of which there is one for + each detected PCI video card. The list is terminated with a + <constant>NULL</constant> pointer. If no PCI video cards were + detected, the return value is <constant>NULL</constant>. + + </para></blockquote> + </para></blockquote> + + <para> + After the bus probe, the resource broker is initialised. + </para> + </sect2> + + + <sect2> + <title>Load initial set of modules</title> + + <para> + This is done at the start of the first server generation only. + </para> + + <para> + The core server contains a list of mandatory modules. These are loaded + first. Currently the only module on this list is the bitmap font module. + </para> + + <para> + The next set of modules loaded are those specified explicitly in the + &k.module; section of the config file. + </para> + + <para> + The final set of initial modules are the driver modules referenced + by the active &k.device; and &k.inputdevice; sections in the config + file. Each of these modules is loaded exactly once. + </para> + </sect2> + + + <sect2> + <title>Register Video and Input Drivers</title> + + <para> + This is done at the start of the first server generation only. + </para> + + <para> + When a driver module is loaded, the loader calls its + <function>Setup</function> function. For video drivers, this function + calls <function>xf86AddDriver()</function> to register the driver's + <structname>DriverRec</structname>, which contains a small set of essential + details and driver entry points required during the early phase of + <function>InitOutput()</function>. <function>xf86AddDriver()</function> + adds it to the global <varname>xf86DriverList[]</varname> array. + </para> + + <para> + The <structname>DriverRec</structname> contains the driver canonical name, + the <function>Identify()</function>, + <function>Probe()</function> and <function>AvailableOptions()</function> + function entry points as well as a pointer + to the driver's module (as returned from the loader when the driver + was loaded) and a reference count which keeps track of how many + screens are using the driver. The entry driver entry points are + those required prior to the driver allocating and filling in its + <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>. + </para> + + <para> + For a static server, the <varname>xf86DriverList[]</varname> array is + initialised at build time, and the loading of modules is not done. + </para> + + <para> + A similar procedure is used for input drivers. The input driver's + <function>Setup</function> function calls + <function>xf86AddInputDriver()</function> to register the driver's + <structname>InputDriverRec</structname>, which contains a small set of + essential details and driver entry points required during the early + phase of <function>InitInput()</function>. + <function>xf86AddInputDriver()</function> adds it to the global + <varname>xf86InputDriverList[]</varname> array. For a static server, + the <varname>xf86InputDriverList[]</varname> array is initialised at + build time. + </para> + + <para> + Both the <varname>xf86DriverList[]</varname> and + <varname>xf86InputDriverList[]</varname> arrays have been initialised + by the end of this stage. + </para> + + <para> + Once all the drivers are registered, their + <function>ChipIdentify()</function> functions are called. + </para> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void ChipIdentify(int flags); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This is expected to print a message indicating the driver name, + a short summary of what it supports, and a list of the chipset + names that it supports. It may use the xf86PrintChipsets() helper + to do this. + </para></blockquote> + </para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void xf86PrintChipsets(const char *drvname, const char *drvmsg, + SymTabPtr chips); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function provides an easy way for a driver's ChipIdentify + function to format the identification message. + </para></blockquote> + </para></blockquote> + </sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>Initialise Access Control</title> + + <para> + This is done at the start of the first server generation only. + </para> + + <para> + The Resource Access Control (RAC) subsystem is initialised before + calling any driver functions that may access hardware. All generic + bus information is probed and saved (for restoration later). All + (shared resource) video devices are disabled at the generic bus + level, and a probe is done to find the <quote>primary</quote> video device. These + devices remain disabled for the next step. + </para> + </sect2> + + + <sect2 id="probe"> + <title>Video Driver Probe</title> + + <para> + This is done at the start of the first server generation only. The + <function>ChipProbe()</function> function of each registered video driver + is called. + </para> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + Bool ChipProbe(DriverPtr drv, int flags); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + The purpose of this is to identify all instances of hardware + supported by the driver. The flags value is currently either 0, + <constant>PROBE_DEFAULT</constant> or <constant>PROBE_DETECT</constant>. + <constant>PROBE_DETECT</constant> is used if "-configure" or "-probe" + command line arguments are given and indicates to the + <function>Probe()</function> function that it should not configure the + bus entities and that no xorg.conf information is available. + </para> + + <para> + The probe must find the active device sections that match the + driver by calling <function>xf86MatchDevice()</function>. The number + of matches found limits the maximum number of instances for this + driver. If no matches are found, the function should return + <constant>FALSE</constant> immediately. + </para> + + <para> + Devices that cannot be identified by using device-independent + methods should be probed at this stage (keeping in mind that access + to all resources that can be disabled in a device-independent way + are disabled during this phase). The probe must be a minimal + probe. It should just determine if there is a card present that + the driver can drive. It should use the least intrusive probe + methods possible. It must not do anything that is not essential, + like probing for other details such as the amount of memory + installed, etc. It is recommended that the + <function>xf86MatchPciInstances()</function> helper function be used + for identifying matching PCI devices, and similarly the + <function>xf86MatchIsaInstances()</function> for ISA (non-PCI) devices + (see the <link linkend="rac">RAC</link> section). These helpers also + checks and claims the appropriate entity. When not using the + helper, that should be done with <function>xf86CheckPciSlot()</function> + and <function>xf86ClaimPciSlot()</function> for PCI devices and + <function>xf86ClaimIsaSlot()</function> for ISA devices (see the + <link linkend="rac">RAC</link> section). + </para> + + <para> + The probe must register all non-relocatable resources at this + stage. If a resource conflict is found between exclusive resources + the driver will fail immediately. This is usually best done with + the <function>xf86ConfigPciEntity()</function> helper function + for PCI and <function>xf86ConfigIsaEntity()</function> for ISA + (see the <link linkend="rac">RAC</link> section). It is possible to + register some entity specific functions with those helpers. When + not using the helpers, the <function>xf86AddEntityToScreen()</function> + <function>xf86ClaimFixedResources()</function> and + <function>xf86SetEntityFuncs()</function> should be used instead (see + the <link linkend="rac">RAC</link> section). + </para> + + <para> + If a chipset is specified in an active device section which the + driver considers relevant (ie it has no driver specified, or the + driver specified matches the driver doing the probe), the Probe + must return <constant>FALSE</constant> if the chipset doesn't match + one supported by the driver. + </para> + + <para> + If there are no active device sections that the driver considers + relevant, it must return <constant>FALSE</constant>. + </para> + + <para> + Allocate a <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> for each active instance of the + hardware found, and fill in the basic information, including the + other driver entry points. This is best done with the + <function>xf86ConfigIsaEntity()</function> helper function for ISA + instances or <function>xf86ConfigPciEntity()</function> for PCI instances. + These functions allocate a <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> for active + entities. Optionally <function>xf86AllocateScreen()</function> + function may also be used to allocate the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>. + Any of these functions take care of initialising fields to defined + <quote>unused</quote> values. + </para> + + <para> + Claim the entities for each instance of the hardware found. This + prevents other drivers from claiming the same hardware. + </para> + + <para> + Must leave hardware in the same state it found it in, and must not + do any hardware initialisation. + </para> + + <para> + All detection can be overridden via the config file, and that + parsed information is available to the driver at this stage. + </para> + + <para> + Returns <constant>TRUE</constant> if one or more instances are found, + and <constant>FALSE</constant> otherwise. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + int xf86MatchDevice(const char *drivername, + GDevPtr **driversectlist) + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function takes the name of the driver and returns via + <parameter>driversectlist</parameter> a list of device sections that + match the driver name. The function return value is the number + of matches found. If a fatal error is encountered the return + value is <literal>-1</literal>. + </para> + + <para> + The caller should use <function>xfree()</function> to free + <parameter>*driversectlist</parameter> when it is no longer needed. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + ScrnInfoPtr xf86AllocateScreen(DriverPtr drv, int flags) + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function allocates a new <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> in the + <varname>xf86Screens[]</varname> array. This function is normally + called by the video driver <function>ChipProbe()</function> functions. + The return value is a pointer to the newly allocated + <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>. The <structfield>scrnIndex</structfield>, + <structfield>origIndex</structfield>, <structfield>module</structfield> and + <structfield>drv</structfield> fields are initialised. The reference count + in <parameter>drv</parameter> is incremented. The storage for any + currently allocated <quote>privates</quote> pointers is also allocated and + the <structfield>privates</structfield> field initialised (the privates data + is of course not allocated or initialised). This function never + returns on failure. If the allocation fails, the server exits + with a fatal error. The flags value is not currently used, and + should be set to zero. + </para></blockquote> + </para></blockquote> + + <para> + At the completion of this, a list of <structname>ScrnInfoRecs</structname> + have been allocated in the <varname>xf86Screens[]</varname> array, and + the associated entities and fixed resources have been claimed. The + following <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> fields must be initialised at + this point: + + <literallayout> + driverVersion + driverName + scrnIndex(*) + origIndex(*) + drv(*) + module(*) + name + Probe + PreInit + ScreenInit + EnterVT + LeaveVT + numEntities + entityList + access + </literallayout> + + <literal>(*)</literal> These are initialised when the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> + is allocated, and not explicitly by the driver. + </para> + + <para> + The following <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> fields must be initialised + if the driver is going to use them: + + <literallayout> + SwitchMode + AdjustFrame + FreeScreen + ValidMode + </literallayout> + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>Matching Screens</title> + + <para> + This is done at the start of the first server generation only. + </para> + + <para> + After the Probe phase is finished, there will be some number of + <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>s. These are then matched with the active + &k.screen; sections in the xorg.conf, and those not having an active + &k.screen; section are deleted. If the number of remaining screens + is 0, <function>InitOutput()</function> sets + <structfield>screenInfo.numScreens</structfield> to <constant>0</constant> and + returns. + </para> + + <para> + At this point the following fields of the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>s + must be initialised: + + <literallayout> + confScreen + </literallayout> + </para> + + </sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>Allocate non-conflicting resources</title> + + <para> + This is done at the start of the first server generation only. + </para> + + <para> + Before calling the drivers again, the resource information collected + from the Probe phase is processed. This includes checking the extent + of PCI resources for the probed devices, and resolving any conflicts + in the relocatable PCI resources. It also reports conflicts, checks + bus routing issues, and anything else that is needed to enable the + entities for the next phase. + </para> + + <para> + If any drivers registered an <function>EntityInit()</function> function + during the Probe phase, then they are called here. + </para> + + </sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>Sort the Screens and pre-check Monitor Information</title> + + <para> + This is done at the start of the first server generation only. + </para> + + <para> + The list of screens is sorted to match the ordering requested in the + config file. + </para> + + <para> + The list of modes for each active monitor is checked against the + monitor's parameters. Invalid modes are pruned. + </para> + + </sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>PreInit</title> + + <para> + This is done at the start of the first server generation only. + </para> + + <para> + For each <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>, enable access to the screens entities and call + the <function>ChipPreInit()</function> function. + </para> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + Bool ChipPreInit(ScrnInfoRec screen, int flags); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + The purpose of this function is to find out all the information + required to determine if the configuration is usable, and to + initialise those parts of the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> that + can be set once at the beginning of the first server generation. + </para> + + <para> + The number of entities registered for the screen should be checked + against the expected number (most drivers expect only one). The + entity information for each of them should be retrieved (with + <function>xf86GetEntityInfo()</function>) and checked for the correct + bus type and that none of the sharable resources registered during + the Probe phase was rejected. + </para> + + <para> + Access to resources for the entities that can be controlled in a + device-independent way are enabled before this function is called. + If the driver needs to access any resources that it has disabled + in an <function>EntityInit()</function> function that it registered, + then it may enable them here providing that it disables them before + this function returns. + </para> + + <para> + This includes probing for video memory, clocks, ramdac, and all + other HW info that is needed. It includes determining the + depth/bpp/visual and related info. It includes validating and + determining the set of video modes that will be used (and anything + that is required to determine that). + </para> + + <para> + This information should be determined in the least intrusive way + possible. The state of the HW must remain unchanged by this + function. Although video memory (including MMIO) may be mapped + within this function, it must be unmapped before returning. Driver + specific information should be stored in a structure hooked into + the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>'s <structfield>driverPrivate</structfield> + field. Any other modules which require persistent data (ie data + that persists across server generations) should be initialised in + this function, and they should allocate a <quote>privates</quote> index to + hook their data into by calling + <function>xf86AllocateScrnInfoPrivateIndex()</function>. The <quote>privates</quote> + data is persistent. + </para> + + <para> + Helper functions for some of these things are provided at the + XFree86 common level, and the driver can choose to make use of + them. + </para> + + <para> + All additional resources that the screen needs must be registered + here. This should be done with + <function>xf86RegisterResources()</function>. If some of the fixed + resources registered in the Probe phase are not needed or not + decoded by the hardware when in the OPERATING server state, their + status should be updated with + <function>xf86SetOperatingState()</function>. + </para> + + <para> + Modules may be loaded at any point in this function, and all + modules that the driver will need must be loaded before the end + of this function. Either the <function>xf86LoadSubModule()</function> + or the <function>xf86LoadDrvSubModule()</function> function should be + used to load modules depending on whether a + <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> has been set up. A driver may unload + a module within this function if it was only needed temporarily, + and the <function>xf86UnloadSubModule()</function> function should be used + to do that. Otherwise there is no need to explicitly unload modules + because the loader takes care of module dependencies and will + unload submodules automatically if/when the driver module is + unloaded. + </para> + + <para> + The bulk of the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> fields should be filled + out in this function. + </para> + + <para> + <function>ChipPreInit()</function> returns <constant>FALSE</constant> when + the configuration is unusable in some way (unsupported depth, no + valid modes, not enough video memory, etc), and <constant>TRUE</constant> + if it is usable. + </para> + + <para> + It is expected that if the <function>ChipPreInit()</function> function + returns <constant>TRUE</constant>, then the only reasons that subsequent + stages in the driver might fail are lack or resources (like xalloc + failures). All other possible reasons for failure should be + determined by the <function>ChipPreInit()</function> function. + </para></blockquote> + </para></blockquote> + + <para> + The <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>s for screens where the <function>ChipPreInit()</function> fails are removed. + If none remain, <function>InitOutput()</function> sets <structfield>screenInfo.numScreens</structfield> to <constant>0</constant> and returns. + </para> + + <para> + At this point, further fields of the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>s would normally be + filled in. Most are not strictly mandatory, but many are required + by other layers and/or helper functions that the driver may choose + to use. The documentation for those layers and helper functions + indicates which they require. + </para> + + <para> + The following fields of the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>s should be filled in if the + driver is going to use them: + + <literallayout> + monitor + display + depth + pixmapBPP + bitsPerPixel + weight (>8bpp only) + mask (>8bpp only) + offset (>8bpp only) + rgbBits (8bpp only) + gamma + defaultVisual + maxHValue + maxVValue + virtualX + virtualY + displayWidth + frameX0 + frameY0 + frameX1 + frameY1 + zoomLocked + modePool + modes + currentMode + progClock (TRUE if clock is programmable) + chipset + ramdac + clockchip + numClocks (if not programmable) + clock[] (if not programmable) + videoRam + biosBase + memBase + memClk + driverPrivate + chipID + chipRev + </literallayout> + </para> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + pointer xf86LoadSubModule(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, const char *name); + and + pointer xf86LoadDrvSubModule(DriverPtr drv, const char *name); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Load a module that a driver depends on. This function loads the + module <parameter>name</parameter> as a sub module of the driver. The + return value is a handle identifying the new module. If the load + fails, the return value will be <constant>NULL</constant>. If a driver + needs to explicitly unload a module it has loaded in this way, + the return value must be saved and passed to + <function>xf86UnloadSubModule()</function> when unloading. + + </para></blockquote> + </para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void xf86UnloadSubModule(pointer module); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Unloads the module referenced by <parameter>module</parameter>. + <parameter>module</parameter> should be a pointer returned previously + by <function>xf86LoadSubModule()</function> or + <function>xf86LoadDrvSubModule()</function> . + + </para></blockquote> + </para></blockquote> + </sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>Cleaning up Unused Drivers</title> + + <para> + At this point it is known which screens will be in use, and which + drivers are being used. Unreferenced drivers (and modules they + may have loaded) are unloaded here. + </para> + + </sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>Consistency Checks</title> + + <para> + The parameters that must be global to the server, like pixmap formats, + bitmap bit order, bitmap scanline unit and image byte order are + compared for each of the screens. If a mismatch is found, the server + exits with an appropriate message. + </para> + + </sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>Check if Resource Control is Needed</title> + + <para> + Determine if resource access control is needed. This is the case + if more than one screen is used. If necessary the RAC wrapper module + is loaded. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>AddScreen (ScreenInit)</title> + + <para> + At this point, the valid screens are known. + <function>AddScreen()</function> is called for each of them, passing + <function>ChipScreenInit()</function> as the argument. + <function>AddScreen()</function> is a DIX function that allocates a new + <structfield>screenInfo.screen[]</structfield> entry (aka + <varname>pScreen</varname>), and does some basic initialisation of it. + It then calls the <function>ChipScreenInit()</function> function, with + <parameter>pScreen</parameter> as one of its arguments. If + <function>ChipScreenInit()</function> returns <constant>FALSE</constant>, + <function>AddScreen()</function> returns <constant>-1</constant>. Otherwise + it returns the index of the screen. <function>AddScreen()</function> + should only fail because of programming errors or failure to allocate + resources (like memory). All configuration problems should be + detected BEFORE this point. + </para> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + Bool ChipScreenInit(int index, ScreenPtr pScreen, + int argc, char **argv); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This is called at the start of each server generation. + </para> + + <para> + Fill in all of <parameter>pScreen</parameter>, possibly doing some of + this by calling ScreenInit functions from other layers like mi, + framebuffers (cfb, etc), and extensions. + </para> + + <para> + Decide which operations need to be placed under resource access + control. The classes of operations are the frame buffer operations + (<constant>RAC_FB</constant>), the pointer operations + (<constant>RAC_CURSOR</constant>), the viewport change operations + (<constant>RAC_VIEWPORT</constant>) and the colormap operations + (<constant>RAC_COLORMAP</constant>). Any operation that requires + resources which might be disabled during OPERATING state should + be set to use RAC. This can be specified separately for memory + and IO resources (the <structfield>racMemFlags</structfield> and + <structfield>racIoFlags</structfield> fields of the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> + respectively). + </para> + + <para> + Map any video memory or other memory regions. + </para> + + <para> + Save the video card state. Enough state must be saved so that + the original state can later be restored. + </para> + + <para> + Initialise the initial video mode. The <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>'s + <structfield>vtSema</structfield> field should be set to <constant>TRUE</constant> + just prior to changing the video hardware's state. + + </para></blockquote> + </para></blockquote> + + + <para> + The <function>ChipScreenInit()</function> function (or functions from other + layers that it calls) should allocate entries in the + <structname>ScreenRec</structname>'s <structfield>devPrivates</structfield> area by + calling <function>AllocateScreenPrivateIndex()</function> if it needs + per-generation storage. Since the <structname>ScreenRec</structname>'s + <structfield>devPrivates</structfield> information is cleared for each server + generation, this is the correct place to initialise it. + </para> + + <para> + After <function>AddScreen()</function> has successfully returned, the + following <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> fields are initialised: + + <literallayout> + pScreen + racMemFlags + racIoFlags + </literallayout> + </para> + + <para> + The <function>ChipScreenInit()</function> function should initialise the + <structfield>CloseScreen</structfield> and <structfield>SaveScreen</structfield> fields + of <parameter>pScreen</parameter>. The old value of + <structfield>pScreen->CloseScreen</structfield> should be saved as part of + the driver's per-screen private data, allowing it to be called from + <function>ChipCloseScreen()</function>. This means that the existing + <function>CloseScreen()</function> function is wrapped. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>Finalising RAC Initialisation</title> + + <para> + After all the <function>ChipScreenInit()</function> functions have been + called, each screen has registered its RAC requirements. This + information is used to determine which shared resources are requested + by more than one driver and set the access functions accordingly. + This is done following these rules: + + <orderedlist> + <listitem><para> + The sharable resources registered by each entity are compared. + If a resource is registered by more than one entity the entity + will be marked to indicate that it needs to share this resources + type (IO or MEM). + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + A resource marked <quote>disabled</quote> during OPERATING state will be + ignored entirely. + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + A resource marked <quote>unused</quote> will only conflict with an overlapping + resource of an other entity if the second is actually in use + during OPERATING state. + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + If an <quote>unused</quote> resource was found to conflict but the entity + does not use any other resource of this type the entire resource + type will be disabled for that entity. + </para></listitem> + </orderedlist> + </para> + + </sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>Finishing InitOutput()</title> + + <para> + At this point <function>InitOutput()</function> is finished, and all the + screens have been setup in their initial video mode. + </para> + + </sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>Mode Switching</title> + + <para> + When a SwitchMode event is received, <function>ChipSwitchMode()</function> + is called (when it exists): + </para> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + Bool ChipSwitchMode(int index, DisplayModePtr mode, int flags); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Initialises the new mode for the screen identified by + <parameter>index;</parameter>. The viewport may need to be adjusted + also. + + </para></blockquote> + </para></blockquote> + + </sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>Changing Viewport</title> + + <para> + When a Change Viewport event is received, + <function>ChipAdjustFrame()</function> is called (when it exists): + </para> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void ChipAdjustFrame(int index, int x, int y, int flags); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Changes the viewport for the screen identified by + <parameter>index;</parameter>. + </para> + + <para> + It should be noted that many chipsets impose restrictions on where the + viewport may be placed in the virtual resolution, either for alignment + reasons, or to prevent the start of the viewport from being positioned + within a pixel (as can happen in a 24bpp mode). After calculating the + value the chipset's panning registers need to be set to for non-DGA + modes, this function should recalculate the ScrnInfoRec's + <structfield>frameX0</structfield>, <structfield>frameY0</structfield>, <structfield>frameX1</structfield> + and <structfield>frameY1</structfield> fields to correspond to that value. If + this is not done, switching to another mode might cause the position + of a hardware cursor to change. + + </para></blockquote> + </para></blockquote> + + </sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>VT Switching</title> + + <para> + When a VT switch event is received, <function>xf86VTSwitch()</function> + is called. <function>xf86VTSwitch()</function> does the following: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry><term>On ENTER:</term> + <listitem> + <itemizedlist> + <listitem><para> + enable port I/O access + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + save and initialise the bus/resource state + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + enter the SETUP server state + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + calls <function>ChipEnterVT()</function> for each screen + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + enter the OPERATING server state + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + validate GCs + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + Restore fb from saved pixmap for each screen + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + Enable all input devices + </para></listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + <varlistentry> + <term>On LEAVE:</term> + <listitem> + <itemizedlist> + <listitem><para> + Save fb to pixmap for each screen + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + validate GCs + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + enter the SETUP server state + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + calls <function>ChipLeaveVT()</function> for each screen + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + disable all input devices + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + restore bus/resource state + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + disables port I/O access + </para></listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + Bool ChipEnterVT(int index, int flags); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function should initialise the current video mode and + initialise the viewport, turn on the HW cursor if appropriate, + etc. + </para> + + <para> + Should it re-save the video state before initialising the video + mode? + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void ChipLeaveVT(int index, int flags); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function should restore the saved video state. If + appropriate it should also turn off the HW cursor, and invalidate + any pixmap/font caches. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <para> + Optionally, <function>ChipLeaveVT()</function> may also unmap memory + regions. If so, <function>ChipEnterVT()</function> will need to remap + them. Additionally, if an aperture used to access video memory is + unmapped and remapped in this fashion, <function>ChipEnterVT()</function> + will also need to notify the framebuffer layers of the aperture's new + location in virtual memory. This is done with a call to the screen's + <function>ModifyPixmapHeader()</function> function, as follows + </para> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + (*pScreen->ModifyPixmapHeader)(pScrn->ppix, + -1, -1, -1, -1, -1, NewApertureAddress); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + where the <structfield>ppix</structfield> field in a ScrnInfoRec + points to the pixmap used by the screen's + <function>SaveRestoreImage()</function> function to hold the screen's + contents while switched out. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <para> + Other layers may wrap the <function>ChipEnterVT()</function> and + <function>ChipLeaveVT()</function> functions if they need to take some + action when these events are received. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>End of server generation</title> + + <para> + At the end of each server generation, the DIX layer calls + <function>ChipCloseScreen()</function> for each screen: + </para> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + Bool ChipCloseScreen(int index, ScreenPtr pScreen); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function should restore the saved video state and unmap the + memory regions. + </para> + + <para> + It should also free per-screen data structures allocated by the + driver. Note that the persistent data held in the + <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>'s <structfield>driverPrivate</structfield> field + should not be freed here because it is needed by subsequent server + generations. + </para> + + <para> + The <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>'s <structfield>vtSema</structfield> field + should be set to <constant>FALSE</constant> once the video HW state + has been restored. + </para> + + <para> + Before freeing the per-screen driver data the saved + <structfield>CloseScreen</structfield> value should be restored to + <structfield>pScreen->CloseScreen</structfield>, and that function should + be called after freeing the data. + + </para></blockquote> + </para></blockquote> + </sect2> + </sect1> + + <sect1> + <title>Optional Driver Functions</title> + + <para> +The functions outlined here can be called from the XFree86 common layer, +but their presence is optional. + </para> + + <sect2> + <title>Mode Validation</title> + + <para> + When a mode validation helper supplied by the XFree86-common layer is + being used, it can be useful to provide a function to check for hw + specific mode constraints: + </para> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + ModeStatus ChipValidMode(int index, DisplayModePtr mode, + Bool verbose, int flags); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Check the passed mode for hw-specific constraints, and return the + appropriate status value. + + </para></blockquote> + </para></blockquote> + + <para> +This function may also modify the effective timings and clock of the passed +mode. These have been stored in the mode's <structfield>Crtc*</structfield> and +<structfield>SynthClock</structfield> elements, and have already been adjusted for +interlacing, doublescanning, multiscanning and clock multipliers and dividers. +The function should not modify any other mode field, unless it wants to modify +the mode timings reported to the user by <function>xf86PrintModes()</function>. + </para> + + <para> +The function is called once for every mode in the xorg.conf Monitor section +assigned to the screen, with <parameter>flags</parameter> set to +<constant>MODECHECK_INITIAL</constant>. It is subsequently called for every mode +in the xorg.conf Display subsection assigned to the screen, with +<parameter>flags</parameter> set to <constant>MODECHECK_FINAL</constant>. In the second +case, the mode will have successfully passed all other tests. In addition, +the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>'s <structfield>virtualX</structfield>, +<structfield>virtualY</structfield> and <structfield>displayWidth</structfield> fields will have been +set as if the mode to be validated were to be the last mode accepted. + </para> + + <para> +In effect, calls with MODECHECK_INITIAL are intended for checks that do not +depend on any mode other than the one being validated, while calls with +MODECHECK_FINAL are intended for checks that may involve more than one mode. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>Free screen data</title> + + <para> + When a screen is deleted prior to the completion of the ScreenInit + phase the <function>ChipFreeScreen()</function> function is called when defined. + </para> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void ChipFreeScreen(int scrnindex, int flags); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Free any driver-allocated data that may have been allocated up to + and including an unsuccessful <function>ChipScreenInit()</function> + call. This would predominantly be data allocated by + <function>ChipPreInit()</function> that persists across server + generations. It would include the <structfield>driverPrivate</structfield>, + and any <quote>privates</quote> entries that modules may have allocated. + + </para></blockquote> + </para></blockquote> + + </sect2> +</sect1> + + <sect1> + <title>Recommended driver functions</title> + + <para> +The functions outlined here are for internal use by the driver only. +They are entirely optional, and are never accessed directly from higher +layers. The sample function declarations shown here are just examples. +The interface (if any) used is up to the driver. + </para> + + <sect2> + <title>Save</title> + + <para> + Save the video state. This could be called from <function>ChipScreenInit()</function> and + (possibly) <function>ChipEnterVT()</function>. + </para> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void ChipSave(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Saves the current state. This will only be saving pre-server + states or states before returning to the server. There is only + one current saved state per screen and it is stored in private + storage in the screen. + + </para></blockquote> + </para></blockquote> + </sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>Restore</title> + + <para> + Restore the original video state. This could be called from the + <function>ChipLeaveVT()</function> and <function>ChipCloseScreen()</function> + functions. + </para> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void ChipRestore(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Restores the saved state from the private storage. Usually only + used for restoring text modes. + + </para></blockquote> + </para></blockquote> + + </sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>Initialise Mode</title> + + <para> + Initialise a video mode. This could be called from the + <function>ChipScreenInit()</function>, <function>ChipSwitchMode()</function> + and <function>ChipEnterVT()</function> functions. + </para> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + Bool ChipModeInit(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, DisplayModePtr mode); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Programs the hardware for the given video mode. + + </para></blockquote> + </para></blockquote> + + </sect2> + </sect1> + + <sect1> + <title>Data and Data Structures</title> + + <sect2> + <title>Command line data</title> + + <para> +Command line options are typically global, and are stored in global +variables. These variables are read-only and are available to drivers +via a function call interface. Most of these command line values are +processed via helper functions to ensure that they are treated consistently +by all drivers. The other means of access is provided for cases where +the supplied helper functions might not be appropriate. + </para> + + <para> +Some of them are: + + <literallayout> + xf86Verbose verbosity level + xf86Bpp -bpp from the command line + xf86Depth -depth from the command line + xf86Weight -weight from the command line + xf86Gamma -{r,g,b,}gamma from the command line + xf86FlipPixels -flippixels from the command line + xf86ProbeOnly -probeonly from the command line + defaultColorVisualClass -cc from the command line + </literallayout> + </para> + + <para> +If we ever do allow for screen-specific command line options, we may +need to rethink this. + </para> + + <para> +These can be accessed in a read-only manner by drivers with the following +functions: + </para> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + int xf86GetVerbosity(); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Returns the value of <varname>xf86Verbose</varname>. + </para></blockquote> + + </para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + int xf86GetDepth(); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Returns the <option>-depth</option> command line setting. If not + set on the command line, <constant>-1</constant> is returned. + </para></blockquote> + + </para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + rgb xf86GetWeight(); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Returns the <option>-weight</option> command line setting. If not + set on the command line, <literal remap="tt">{0, 0, 0}</literal> is returned. + </para></blockquote> + + </para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + Gamma xf86GetGamma(); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Returns the <option>-gamma</option> or <option>-rgamma</option>, + <option>-ggamma</option>, <option>-bgamma</option> command line settings. + If not set on the command line, <literal remap="tt">{0.0, 0.0, 0.0}</literal> + is returned. + </para></blockquote> + + </para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + Bool xf86GetFlipPixels(); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Returns <constant>TRUE</constant> if <option>-flippixels</option> is + present on the command line, and <constant>FALSE</constant> otherwise. + </para></blockquote> + + </para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + const char *xf86GetServerName(); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Returns the name of the X server from the command line. + </para></blockquote> + + </para></blockquote> + </sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>Data handling</title> + + <para> +Config file data contains parts that are global, and parts that are +Screen specific. All of it is parsed into data structures that neither +the drivers or most other parts of the server need to know about. + </para> + + <para> +The global data is typically not required by drivers, and as such, most +of it is stored in the private <structname>xf86InfoRec</structname>. + </para> + + <para> +The screen-specific data collected from the config file is stored in +screen, device, display, monitor-specific data structures that are separate +from the <varname>ScrnInfoRecs</varname>, with the appropriate elements/fields +hooked into the <varname>ScrnInfoRecs</varname> as required. The screen +config data is held in <structname>confScreenRec</structname>, device data in +the <structname>GDevRec</structname>, monitor data in the <structname>MonRec</structname>, +and display data in the <structname>DispRec</structname>. + </para> + + <para> +The XFree86 common layer's screen specific data (the actual data in use +for each screen) is held in the <varname>ScrnInfoRecs</varname>. As has +been outlined above, the <varname>ScrnInfoRecs</varname> are allocated at probe +time, and it is the responsibility of the Drivers' <function>Probe()</function> +and <function>PreInit()</function> functions to finish filling them in based +on both data provided on the command line and data provided from the +Config file. The precedence for this is: + + <blockquote><para> + command line -> config file -> probed/default data + </para></blockquote> + </para> + + <para> +For most things in this category there are helper functions that the +drivers can use to ensure that the above precedence is consistently +used. + </para> + + <para> +As well as containing screen-specific data that the XFree86 common layer +(including essential parts of the server infrastructure as well as helper +functions) needs to access, it also contains some data that drivers use +internally. When considering whether to add a new field to the +<structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>, consider the balance between the convenience +of things that lots of drivers need and the size/obscurity of the +<structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>. + </para> + + <para> +Per-screen driver specific data that cannot be accommodated with the +static <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> fields is held in a driver-defined +data structure, a pointer to which is assigned to the +<structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>'s <structfield>driverPrivate</structfield> field. This +is per-screen data that persists across server generations (as does the +bulk of the static <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> data). It would typically +also include the video card's saved state. + </para> + + <para> +Per-screen data for other modules that the driver uses (for example, +the XAA module) that is reset for each server generation is hooked into +the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> through it's <structfield>privates</structfield> +field. + </para> + + <para> +Once it has stabilised, the data structures and variables accessible to +video drivers will be documented here. In the meantime, those things +defined in the <filename>xf86.h</filename> and <filename>xf86str.h</filename> +files are visible to video drivers. Things defined in +<filename>xf86Priv.h</filename> and <filename>xf86Privstr.h</filename> are NOT +intended to be visible to video drivers, and it is an error for a driver +to include those files. + </para> + + </sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>Accessing global data</title> + + <para> +Some other global state information that the drivers may access via +functions is as follows: + </para> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + Bool xf86ServerIsExiting(); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Returns <constant>TRUE</constant> if the server is at the end of a + generation and is in the process of exiting, and + <constant>FALSE</constant> otherwise. + </para></blockquote> + + </para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + Bool xf86ServerIsResetting(); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Returns <constant>TRUE</constant> if the server is at the end of a + generation and is in the process of resetting, and + <constant>FALSE</constant> otherwise. + </para></blockquote> + + </para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + Bool xf86ServerIsInitialising(); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Returns <constant>TRUE</constant> if the server is at the beginning of + a generation and is in the process of initialising, and + <constant>FALSE</constant> otherwise. + </para></blockquote> + + </para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + Bool xf86ServerIsOnlyProbing(); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Returns <constant>TRUE</constant> if the -probeonly command line flag + was specified, and <constant>FALSE</constant> otherwise. + </para></blockquote> + + </para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + Bool xf86CaughtSignal(); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Returns <constant>TRUE</constant> if the server has caught a signal, + and <constant>FALSE</constant> otherwise. + </para></blockquote> + + </para></blockquote> + </sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>Allocating private data</title> + + <para> +A driver and any module it uses may allocate per-screen private storage +in either the <structname>ScreenRec</structname> (DIX level) or +<structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> (XFree86 common layer level). +<structname>ScreenRec</structname> storage persists only for a single server +generation, and <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> storage persists across +generations for the lifetime of the server. + </para> + + <para> +The <structname>ScreenRec</structname> <structfield>devPrivates</structfield> data must be +reallocated/initialised at the start of each new generation. This is +normally done from the <function>ChipScreenInit()</function> function, and +Init functions for other modules that it calls. Data allocated in this +way should be freed by the driver's <function>ChipCloseScreen()</function> +functions, and Close functions for other modules that it calls. A new +<structfield>devPrivates</structfield> entry is allocated by calling the +<function>AllocateScreenPrivateIndex()</function> function. + </para> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + int AllocateScreenPrivateIndex(); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function allocates a new element in the + <structfield>devPrivates</structfield> field of all currently existing + <literal remap="tt">ScreenRecs</literal>. The return value is the index of this + new element in the <structfield>devPrivates</structfield> array. The + <structfield>devPrivates</structfield> field is of type + <structname>DevUnion</structname>: + + <programlisting> + typedef union _DevUnion { + pointer ptr; + long val; + unsigned long uval; + pointer (*fptr)(void); + } DevUnion; + </programlisting> + + which allows the element to be used for any of the above types. + It is commonly used as a pointer to data that the caller allocates + after the new index has been allocated. + </para> + + <para> + This function will return <constant>-1</constant> when there is an + error allocating the new index. + </para> + + </blockquote> + </para></blockquote> + + <para> +The <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> <structfield>privates</structfield> data persists +for the life of the server, so only needs to be allocated once. This +should be done from the <function>ChipPreInit()</function> function, and Init +functions for other modules that it calls. Data allocated in this way +should be freed by the driver's <function>ChipFreeScreen()</function> functions, +and Free functions for other modules that it calls. A new +<structfield>privates</structfield> entry is allocated by calling the +<function>xf86AllocateScrnInfoPrivateIndex()</function> function. + </para> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + int xf86AllocateScrnInfoPrivateIndex(); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function allocates a new element in the <structfield>privates</structfield> + field of all currently existing <varname>ScrnInfoRecs</varname>. + The return value is the index of this new element in the + <structfield>privates</structfield> array. The <structfield>privates</structfield> + field is of type <structfield>DevUnion</structfield>: + + <programlisting> + typedef union _DevUnion { + pointer ptr; + long val; + unsigned long uval; + pointer (*fptr)(void); + } DevUnion; + </programlisting> + + which allows the element to be used for any of the above types. + It is commonly used as a pointer to data that the caller allocates + after the new index has been allocated. + </para> + + <para> + This function will not return when there is an error allocating + the new index. When there is an error it will cause the server + to exit with a fatal error. The similar function for allocation + privates in the <structname>ScreenRec</structname> + (<function>AllocateScreenPrivateIndex()</function>) differs in this + respect by returning <constant>-1</constant> when the allocation fails. + </para> + + </blockquote> + </para></blockquote> + </sect2> + </sect1> + + <sect1 id="rac"> + <title>Keeping Track of Bus Resources</title> + + <sect2> + <title>Theory of Operation</title> + + <para> +The XFree86 common layer has knowledge of generic access control mechanisms +for devices on certain bus systems (currently the PCI bus) as well as +of methods to enable or disable access to the buses itself. Furthermore +it can access information on resources decoded by these devices and if +necessary modify it. + </para> + + <para> +When first starting the Xserver collects all this information, saves it +for restoration, checks it for consistency, and if necessary, corrects +it. Finally it disables all resources on a generic level prior to +calling any driver function. + </para> + + <para> +When the <function>Probe()</function> function of each driver is called the +device sections are matched against the devices found in the system. +The driver may probe devices at this stage that cannot be identified by +using device independent methods. Access to all resources that can be +controlled in a device independent way is disabled. The +<function>Probe()</function> function should register all non-relocatable +resources at this stage. If a resource conflict is found between +exclusive resources the driver will fail immediately. Optionally the +driver might specify an <function>EntityInit()</function>, +<function>EntityLeave()</function> and <function>EntityEnter()</function> function. + </para> + + <para> +<function>EntityInit()</function> can be used to disable any shared resources +that are not controlled by the generic access control functions. It is +called prior to the PreInit phase regardless if an entity is active or +not. When calling the <function>EntityInit()</function>, +<function>EntityEnter()</function> and <function>EntityLeave()</function> functions +the common level will disable access to all other entities on a generic +level. Since the common level has no knowledge of device specific +methods to disable access to resources it cannot be guaranteed that +certain resources are not decoded by any other entity until the +<function>EntityInit()</function> or <function>EntityEnter()</function> phase is +finished. Device drivers should therefore register all those resources +which they are going to disable. If these resources are never to be +used by any driver function they may be flagged <constant>ResInit</constant> +so that they can be removed from the resource list after processing all +<function>EntityInit()</function> functions. <function>EntityEnter()</function> +should disable decoding of all resources which are not registered as +exclusive and which are not handled by the generic access control in +the common level. The difference to <function>EntityInit()</function> is +that the latter one is only called once during lifetime of the server. +It can therefore be used to set up variables prior to disabling resources. +<function>EntityLeave()</function> should restore the original state when +exiting the server or switching to a different VT. It also needs to +disable device specific access functions if they need to be disabled on +server exit or VT switch. The default state is to enable them before +giving up the VT. + </para> + + <para> +In <function>PreInit()</function> phase each driver should check if any +sharable resources it has registered during <function>Probe()</function> has +been denied and take appropriate action which could simply be to fail. +If it needs to access resources it has disabled during +<function>EntitySetup()</function> it can do so provided it has registered +these and will disable them before returning from +<function>PreInit()</function>. This also applies to all other driver +functions. Several functions are provided to request resource ranges, +register these, correct PCI config space and add replacements for the +generic access functions. Resources may be marked <quote>disabled</quote> or +<quote>unused</quote> during OPERATING stage. Although these steps could also be +performed in <function>ScreenInit()</function>, this is not desirable. + </para> + + <para> +Following <function>PreInit()</function> phase the common level determines +if resource access control is needed. This is the case if more than +one screen is used. If necessary the RAC wrapper module is loaded. In +<function>ScreenInit()</function> the drivers can decide which operations +need to be placed under RAC. Available are the frame buffer operations, +the pointer operations and the colormap operations. Any operation that +requires resources which might be disabled during OPERATING state should +be set to use RAC. This can be specified separately for memory and IO +resources. + </para> + + <para> +When <function>ScreenInit()</function> phase is done the common level will +determine which shared resources are requested by more than one driver +and set the access functions accordingly. This is done following these +rules: + + <orderedlist> + <listitem><para> + The sharable resources registered by each entity are compared. If + a resource is registered by more than one entity the entity will be + marked to need to share this resources type (<constant>IO</constant> or + <constant>MEM</constant>). + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + A resource marked <quote>disabled</quote> during OPERATING state will be ignored + entirely. + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + A resource marked <quote>unused</quote> will only conflicts with an overlapping + resource of an other entity if the second is actually in use during + OPERATING state. + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + If an <quote>unused</quote> resource was found to conflict however the entity + does not use any other resource of this type the entire resource type + will be disabled for that entity. + </para></listitem> + </orderedlist> + </para> + + <para> +The driver has the choice among different ways to control access to +certain resources: + + <orderedlist> + <listitem><para> + It can rely on the generic access functions. This is probably the + most common case. Here the driver only needs to register any resource + it is going to use. + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + It can replace the generic access functions by driver specific + ones. This will mostly be used in cases where no generic access + functions are available. In this case the driver has to make sure + these resources are disabled when entering the <function>PreInit()</function> + stage. Since the replacement functions are registered in + <function>PreInit()</function> the driver will have to enable these + resources itself if it needs to access them during this state. The + driver can specify if the replacement functions can control memory + and/or I/O resources separately. + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + The driver can enable resources itself when it needs them. Each + driver function enabling them needs to disable them before it will + return. This should be used if a resource which can be controlled + in a device dependent way is only required during SETUP state. This + way it can be marked <quote>unused</quote> during OPERATING state. + </para></listitem> + </orderedlist> + </para> + + <para> +A resource which is decoded during OPERATING state however never accessed +by the driver should be marked unused. + </para> + + <para> +Since access switching latencies are an issue during Xserver operation, +the common level attempts to minimize the number of entities that need +to be placed under RAC control. When a wrapped operation is called, +the <function>EnableAccess()</function> function is called before control is +passed on. <function>EnableAccess()</function> checks if a screen is under +access control. If not it just establishes bus routing and returns. +If the screen needs to be under access control, +<function>EnableAccess()</function> determines which resource types +(<literal remap="tt">MEM</literal>, <literal remap="tt">IO</literal>) are required. Then it tests +if this access is already established. If so it simply returns. If +not it disables the currently established access, fixes bus routing and +enables access to all entities registered for this screen. + </para> + + <para> +Whenever a mode switch or a VT-switch is performed the common level will +return to SETUP state. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>Resource Types</title> + + <para> +Resource have certain properties. When registering resources each range +is accompanied by a flag consisting of the ORed flags of the different +properties the resource has. Each resource range may be classified +according to + + <itemizedlist> + <listitem><para> + its physical properties i.e., if it addresses + memory (<constant>ResMem</constant>) or + I/O space (<constant>ResIo</constant>), + </para></listitem> + <listitem><para> + if it addresses a + block (<constant>ResBlock</constant>) or + sparse (<constant>ResSparse</constant>) + range, + </para></listitem> + <listitem><para> + its access properties. + </para></listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + + <para> +There are two known access properties: + + <itemizedlist> + <listitem><para> + <constant>ResExclusive</constant> + for resources which may not be shared with any other device and + </para></listitem> + <listitem><para> + <constant>ResShared</constant> + for resources which can be disabled and therefore can be shared. + </para></listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + + <para> +If it is necessary to test a resource against any type a generic access +type <constant>ResAny</constant> is provided. If this is set the resource +will conflict with any resource of a different entity intersecting its +range. Further it can be specified that a resource is decoded however +never used during any stage (<constant>ResUnused</constant>) or during +OPERATING state (<constant>ResUnusedOpr</constant>). A resource only visible +during the init functions (ie. <function>EntityInit()</function>, +<function>EntityEnter()</function> and <function>EntityLeave()</function> should +be registered with the flag <constant>ResInit</constant>. A resource that +might conflict with background resource ranges may be flagged with +<constant>ResBios</constant>. This might be useful when registering resources +ranges that were assigned by the system Bios. + </para> + + <para> +Several predefined resource lists are available for VGA and 8514/A +resources in <filename>common/xf86Resources.h</filename>. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="avail"> + <title>Available Functions</title> + + <para> +The functions provided for resource management are listed in their order +of use in the driver. + </para> + + <sect3> + <title>Probe Phase</title> + + <para> +In this phase each driver detects those resources it is able to drive, +creates an entity record for each of them, registers non-relocatable +resources and allocates screens and adds the resources to screens. + </para> + + <para> +Two helper functions are provided for matching device sections in the +xorg.conf file to the devices: + </para> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + int xf86MatchPciInstances(const char *driverName, int vendorID, + SymTabPtr chipsets, PciChipsets *PCIchipsets, + GDevPtr *devList, int numDevs, DriverPtr drvp, + int **foundEntities); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function finds matches between PCI cards that a driver supports + and config file device sections. It is intended for use in the + <function>ChipProbe()</function> function of drivers for PCI cards. + Only probed PCI devices with a vendor ID matching + <parameter>vendorID</parameter> are considered. <parameter>devList</parameter> + and <parameter>numDevs</parameter> are typically those found from + calling <function>xf86MatchDevice()</function>, and represent the active + config file device sections relevant to the driver. + <parameter>PCIchipsets</parameter> is a table that provides a mapping + between the PCI device IDs, the driver's internal chipset tokens + and a list of fixed resources. + </para> + + <para> + When a device section doesn't have a <emphasis>BusID</emphasis> entry it + can only match the primary video device. Secondary devices are + only matched with device sections that have a matching + <emphasis>BusID</emphasis> entry. + </para> + + <para> + Once the preliminary matches have been found, a final match is + confirmed by checking if the chipset override, ChipID override or + probed PCI chipset type match one of those given in the + <parameter>chipsets</parameter> and <parameter>PCIchipsets</parameter> lists. + The <parameter>PCIchipsets</parameter> list includes a list of the PCI + device IDs supported by the driver. The list should be terminated + with an entry with PCI ID <constant>-1</constant>". The + <parameter>chipsets</parameter> list is a table mapping the driver's + internal chipset tokens to names, and should be terminated with + a <constant>NULL</constant> entry. Only those entries with a + corresponding entry in the <parameter>PCIchipsets</parameter> list are + considered. The order of precedence is: config file chipset, + config file ChipID, probed PCI device ID. + </para> + + <para> + In cases where a driver handles PCI chipsets with more than one + vendor ID, it may set <parameter>vendorID</parameter> to + <constant>0</constant>, and OR each devID in the list with (the + vendor ID << 16). + </para> + + <para> + Entity index numbers for confirmed matches are returned as an + array via <parameter>foundEntities</parameter>. The PCI information, + chipset token and device section for each match are found in the + <structname>EntityInfoRec</structname> referenced by the indices. + </para> + + <para> + The function return value is the number of confirmed matches. A + return value of <constant>-1</constant> indicates an internal error. + The returned <parameter>foundEntities</parameter> array should be freed + by the driver with <function>xfree()</function> when it is no longer + needed in cases where the return value is greater than zero. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + int xf86MatchIsaInstances(const char *driverName, + SymTabPtr chipsets, IsaChipsets *ISAchipsets, + DriverPtr drvp, FindIsaDevProc FindIsaDevice, + GDevPtr *devList, int numDevs, + int **foundEntities); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function finds matches between ISA cards that a driver supports + and config file device sections. It is intended for use in the + <function>ChipProbe()</function> function of drivers for ISA cards. + <parameter>devList</parameter> and <parameter>numDevs</parameter> are + typically those found from calling <function>xf86MatchDevice()</function>, + and represent the active config file device sections relevant to + the driver. <parameter>ISAchipsets</parameter> is a table that provides + a mapping between the driver's internal chipset tokens and the + resource classes. <parameter>FindIsaDevice</parameter> is a + driver-provided function that probes the hardware and returns the + chipset token corresponding to what was detected, and + <constant>-1</constant> if nothing was detected. + </para> + + <para> + If the config file device section contains a chipset entry, then + it is checked against the <parameter>chipsets</parameter> list. When + no chipset entry is present, the <parameter>FindIsaDevice</parameter> + function is called instead. + </para> + + <para> + Entity index numbers for confirmed matches are returned as an + array via <parameter>foundEntities</parameter>. The chipset token and + device section for each match are found in the + <structname>EntityInfoRec</structname> referenced by the indices. + </para> + + <para> + The function return value is the number of confirmed matches. A + return value of <constant>-1</constant> indicates an internal error. + The returned <parameter>foundEntities</parameter> array should be freed + by the driver with <function>xfree()</function> when it is no longer + needed in cases where the return value is greater than zero. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <para> +These two helper functions make use of several core functions that are +available at the driver level: + </para> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + Bool xf86ParsePciBusString(const char *busID, int *bus, + int *device, int *func); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Takes a <parameter>BusID</parameter> string, and if it is in the correct + format, returns the PCI <parameter>bus</parameter>, <parameter>device</parameter>, + <parameter>func</parameter> values that it indicates. The format of the + string is expected to be "PCI:bus:device:func" where each of <quote>bus</quote>, + <quote>device</quote> and <quote>func</quote> are decimal integers. The ":func" part may + be omitted, and the func value assumed to be zero, but this isn't + encouraged. The "PCI" prefix may also be omitted. The prefix + "AGP" is currently equivalent to the "PCI" prefix. If the string + isn't a valid PCI BusID, the return value is <constant>FALSE</constant>. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + Bool xf86ComparePciBusString(const char *busID, int bus, + int device, int func); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Compares a <parameter>BusID</parameter> string with PCI <parameter>bus</parameter>, + <parameter>device</parameter>, <parameter>func</parameter> values. If they + match <constant>TRUE</constant> is returned, and <constant>FALSE</constant> + if they don't. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + Bool xf86ParseIsaBusString(const char *busID); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Compares a <parameter>BusID</parameter> string with the ISA bus ID string + ("ISA" or "ISA:"). If they match <constant>TRUE</constant> is returned, + and <constant>FALSE</constant> if they don't. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + Bool xf86CheckPciSlot(int bus, int device, int func); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Checks if the PCI slot <literal remap="tt">bus:device:func</literal> has been + claimed. If so, it returns <constant>FALSE</constant>, and otherwise + <constant>TRUE</constant>. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + int xf86ClaimPciSlot(int bus, int device, int func, DriverPtr drvp, + int chipset, GDevPtr dev, Bool active); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function is used to claim a PCI slot, allocate the associated + entity record and initialise their data structures. The return + value is the index of the newly allocated entity record, or + <constant>-1</constant> if the claim fails. This function should always + succeed if <function>xf86CheckPciSlot()</function> returned + <constant>TRUE</constant> for the same PCI slot. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + Bool xf86IsPrimaryPci(void); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function returns <constant>TRUE</constant> if the primary card is + a PCI device, and <constant>FALSE</constant> otherwise. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + int xf86ClaimIsaSlot(DriverPtr drvp, int chipset, + GDevPtr dev, Bool active); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This allocates an entity record entity and initialise the data + structures. The return value is the index of the newly allocated + entity record. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + Bool xf86IsPrimaryIsa(void); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function returns <constant>TRUE</constant> if the primary card is + an ISA (non-PCI) device, and <constant>FALSE</constant> otherwise. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <para> +Two helper functions are provided to aid configuring entities: + </para> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + ScrnInfoPtr xf86ConfigPciEntity(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, + int scrnFlag, int entityIndex, + PciChipsets *p_chip, + resList res, EntityProc init, + EntityProc enter, EntityProc leave, + pointer private); + + ScrnInfoPtr xf86ConfigIsaEntity(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, + int scrnFlag, int entityIndex, + IsaChipsets *i_chip, + resList res, EntityProc init, + EntityProc enter, EntityProc leave, + pointer private); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + These functions are used to register the non-relocatable resources + for an entity, and the optional entity-specific <parameter>Init</parameter>, <parameter>Enter</parameter> and + <parameter>Leave</parameter> functions. Usually the list of fixed resources is obtained + from the Isa/PciChipsets lists. However an additional list of + resources may be passed. Generally this is not required. + For active entities a <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> is allocated + if the <parameter>pScrn</parameter> argument is <constant>NULL</constant>. +The + return value is <constant>TRUE</constant> when successful. The init, enter, leave + functions are defined as follows: + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + typedef void (*EntityProc)(int entityIndex, + pointer private); + </programlisting> + </para></blockquote> + + They are passed the entity index and a pointer to a private scratch + area. This can be set up during <function>Probe()</function> and + its address can be passed to + <function>xf86ConfigIsaEntity()</function> and + <function>xf86ConfigPciEntity()</function> as the last argument. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <para> +These two helper functions make use of several core functions that are +available at the driver level: + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void xf86ClaimFixedResources(resList list, int entityIndex); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function registers the non-relocatable resources which cannot + be disabled and which therefore would cause the server to fail + immediately if they were found to conflict. It also records + non-relocatable but sharable resources for processing after the + <function>Probe()</function> phase. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + Bool xf86SetEntityFuncs(int entityIndex, EntityProc init, + EntityProc enter, EntityProc leave, pointer); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function registers with an entity the <parameter>init</parameter>, + <parameter>enter</parameter>, <parameter>leave</parameter> functions along + with the pointer to their private area. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void xf86AddEntityToScreen(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, int entityIndex); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function associates the entity referenced by + <parameter>entityIndex</parameter> with the screen. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3> + <title>PreInit Phase</title> + + <para> +During this phase the remaining resources should be registered. +<function>PreInit()</function> should call <function>xf86GetEntityInfo()</function> +to obtain a pointer to an <structname>EntityInfoRec</structname> for each entity +it is able to drive and check if any resource are listed in its +<structfield>resources</structfield> field. If resources registered in the Probe +phase have been rejected in the post-Probe phase +(<structfield>resources</structfield> is non-<constant>NULL</constant>), then the driver should +decide if it can continue without using these or if it should fail. + </para> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + EntityInfoPtr xf86GetEntityInfo(int entityIndex); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function returns a pointer to the <structname>EntityInfoRec</structname> + referenced by <parameter>entityIndex</parameter>. The returned + <structname>EntityInfoRec</structname> should be freed with + <function>xfree()</function> when no longer needed. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <para> +Several functions are provided to simplify resource registration: + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + Bool xf86IsEntityPrimary(int entityIndex); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function returns <constant>TRUE</constant> if the entity referenced + by <parameter>entityIndex</parameter> is the primary display device (i.e., + the one initialised at boot time and used in text mode). + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + Bool xf86IsScreenPrimary(int scrnIndex); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function returns <constant>TRUE</constant> if the primary entity + is registered with the screen referenced by + <parameter>scrnIndex</parameter>. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + pciVideoPtr xf86GetPciInfoForEntity(int entityIndex); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function returns a pointer to the <structname>pciVideoRec</structname> + for the specified entity. If the entity is not a PCI device, + <constant>NULL</constant> is returned. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + </para> + + <para> +The primary function for registration of resources is: + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + resPtr xf86RegisterResources(int entityIndex, resList list, + int access); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function tries to register the resources in + <parameter>list</parameter>. If list is <constant>NULL</constant> it tries + to determine the resources automatically. This only works for + entities that provide a generic way to read out the resource ranges + they decode. So far this is only the case for PCI devices. By + default the PCI resources are registered as shared + (<constant>ResShared</constant>) if the driver wants to set a different + access type it can do so by specifying the access flags in the + third argument. A value of <constant>0</constant> means to use the + default settings. If for any reason the resource broker is not + able to register some of the requested resources the function will + return a pointer to a list of the failed ones. In this case the + driver may be able to move the resource to different locations. + In case of PCI bus entities this is done by passing the list of + failed resources to <function>xf86ReallocatePciResources()</function>. + When the registration succeeds, the return value is + <constant>NULL</constant>. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + </para> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + resPtr xf86ReallocatePciResources(int entityIndex, resPtr pRes); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function takes a list of PCI resources that need to be + reallocated and returns <constant>NULL</constant> when all relocations are + successful. + <function>xf86RegisterResources()</function> should be called again to + register the relocated resources with the broker. + If the reallocation fails, a list of the resources that could not be + relocated is returned. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + +<para> +Two functions are provided to obtain a resource range of a given type: + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + resRange xf86GetBlock(long type, memType size, + memType window_start, memType window_end, + memType align_mask, resPtr avoid); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function tries to find a block range of size + <parameter>size</parameter> and type <parameter>type</parameter> in a window + bound by <parameter>window_start</parameter> and <parameter>window_end</parameter> + with the alignment specified in <parameter>align_mask</parameter>. + Optionally a list of resource ranges which should be avoided within + the window can be supplied. On failure a zero-length range of + type <constant>ResEnd</constant> will be returned. + </para> + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + resRange xf86GetSparse(long type, memType fixed_bits, + memType decode_mask, memType address_mask, + resPtr avoid); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function is like the previous one, but attempts to find a + sparse range instead of a block range. Here three values have to + be specified: the <parameter>address_mask</parameter> which marks all + bits of the mask part of the address, the <parameter>decode_mask</parameter> + which masks out the bits which are hardcoded and are therefore + not available for relocation and the values of the fixed bits. + The function tries to find a base that satisfies the given condition. + If the function fails it will return a zero range of type + <constant>ResEnd</constant>. Optionally it might be passed a list of + resource ranges to avoid. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + </para> + + <para> +Some PCI devices are broken in the sense that they return invalid size +information for a certain resource. In this case the driver can supply +the correct size and make sure that the resource range allocated for +the card is large enough to hold the address range decoded by the card. +The function <function>xf86FixPciResource()</function> can be used to do this: + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + Bool xf86FixPciResource(int entityIndex, unsigned int prt, + CARD32 alignment, long type); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function fixes a PCI resource allocation. The + <parameter>prt</parameter> parameter contains the number of the PCI base + register that needs to be fixed (<constant>0-5</constant>, and + <constant>6</constant> for the BIOS base register). The size is + specified by the alignment. Since PCI resources need to span an + integral range of size <literal remap="tt">2ˆn</literal>, the alignm ent also + specifies the number of addresses that will be decoded. If the + driver specifies a type mask it can override the default type for + PCI resources which is <constant>ResShared</constant>. The resource + broker needs to know that to find a matching resource range. This + function should be called before calling + <function>xf86RegisterResources()</function>. The return value is + <constant>TRUE</constant> when the function succeeds. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + Bool xf86CheckPciMemBase(pciVideoPtr pPci, memType base); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function checks that the memory base address specified matches + one of the PCI base address register values for the given PCI + device. This is mostly used to check that an externally provided + base address (e.g., from a config file) matches an actual value + allocated to a device. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + </para> + + <para> +The driver may replace the generic access control functions for an entity. +This is done with the <function>xf86SetAccessFuncs()</function>: + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void xf86SetAccessFuncs(EntityInfoPtr pEnt, + xf86SetAccessFuncPtr funcs, + xf86SetAccessFuncPtr oldFuncs); + </programlisting> + with: + <programlisting> + typedef struct { + xf86AccessPtr mem; + xf86AccessPtr io; + xf86AccessPtr io_mem; + } xf86SetAccessFuncRec, *xf86SetAccessFuncPtr; + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + The driver can pass three functions: one for I/O access, one for + memory access and one for combined memory and I/O access. If the + memory access and combined access functions are identical the + common level assumes that the memory access cannot be controlled + independently of I/O access, if the I/O access function and the + combined access functions are the same it is assumed that I/O can + not be controlled independently. If memory and I/O have to be + controlled together all three values should be the same. If a + non <constant>NULL</constant> value is passed as third argument it is + interpreted as an address where to store the old access record. + If the third argument is <constant>NULL</constant> it will be assumed + that the generic access should be enabled before replacing the + access functions. Otherwise it will be disabled. The driver may + enable them itself using the returned values. It should do this + from its replacement access functions as the generic access may + be disabled by the common level on certain occasions. If replacement + functions are specified they must control all resources of the + specific type registered for the entity. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + </para> + + <para> +To find out if a specific resource range conflicts with another +resource the <function>xf86ChkConflict()</function> function may be used: + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + memType xf86ChkConflict(resRange *rgp, int entityIndex); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function checks if the resource range <parameter>rgp</parameter> of + for the specified entity conflicts with with another resource. + If a conflict is found, the address of the start of the conflict + is returned. The return value is zero when there is no conflict. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + </para> + + <para> +The OPERATING state properties of previously registered fixed resources +can be set with the <function>xf86SetOperatingState()</function> function: + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + resPtr xf86SetOperatingState(resList list, int entityIndex, + int mask); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function is used to set the status of a resource during + OPERATING state. <parameter>list</parameter> holds a list to which + <parameter>mask</parameter> is to be applied. The parameter + <parameter>mask</parameter> may have the value <constant>ResUnusedOpr</constant> + and <constant>ResDisableOpr</constant>. The first one should be used + if a resource isn't used by the driver during OPERATING state + although it is decoded by the device, while the latter one indicates + that the resource is not decoded during OPERATING state. Note + that the resource ranges have to match those specified during + registration. If a range has been specified starting at + <literal remap="tt">A</literal> and ending at <literal remap="tt">B</literal> and suppose + <literal remap="tt">C</literal> us a value satisfying + <literal remap="tt">A < C < B</literal> one may not + specify the resource range <literal remap="tt">(A,B)</literal> by splitting it + into two ranges <literal remap="tt">(A,C)</literal> and <literal remap="tt">(C,B)</literal>. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + </para> + + <para> +The following two functions are provided for special cases: + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void xf86RemoveEntityFromScreen(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, int entityIndex); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function may be used to remove an entity from a screen. This + only makes sense if a screen has more than one entity assigned or + the screen is to be deleted. No test is made if the screen has + any entities left. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void xf86DeallocateResourcesForEntity(int entityIndex, long type); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function deallocates all resources of a given type registered + for a certain entity from the resource broker list. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + </para> + + </sect3> + + <sect3> + <title>ScreenInit Phase</title> + + <para> +All that is required in this phase is to setup the RAC flags. Note that +it is also permissible to set these flags up in the PreInit phase. The +RAC flags are held in the <structfield>racIoFlags</structfield> and <structfield>racMemFlags</structfield> fields of the +<structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> for each screen. They specify which graphics operations +might require the use of shared resources. This can be specified +separately for memory and I/O resources. The available flags are defined +in <filename>rac/xf86RAC.h</filename>. They are: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry><term><constant>RAC_FB</constant></term> + <listitem><para> + for framebuffer operations (including hw acceleration) + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + <varlistentry><term><constant>RAC_CURSOR</constant></term> + <listitem><para> + for Cursor operations + (??? I'm not sure if we need this for SW cursor it depends + on which level the sw cursor is drawn) + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + <varlistentry><term><constant>RAC_COLORMAP</constant></term> + <listitem><para> + for colormap operations + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + <varlistentry><term><constant>RAC_VIEWPORT</constant></term> + <listitem><para> + for the call to <function>ChipAdjustFrame()</function> + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + </variablelist> + + +The flags are ORed together. + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> + </sect1> + + <sect1 id="options"> + <title>Config file <quote>Option</quote> entries</title> + + <para> +Option entries are permitted in most sections and subsections of the +config file. There are two forms of option entries: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry><term>Option "option-name"</term> + <listitem><para> + A boolean option. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + <varlistentry><term>Option "option-name" "option-value"</term> + <listitem><para> + An option with an arbitrary value. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> +The option entries are handled by the parser, and a list of the parsed +options is included with each of the appropriate data structures that +the drivers have access to. The data structures used to hold the option +information are opaque to the driver, and a driver must not access the +option data directly. Instead, the common layer provides a set of +functions that may be used to access, check and manipulate the option +data. + </para> + + <para> +First, the low level option handling functions. In most cases drivers +would not need to use these directly. + </para> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + pointer xf86FindOption(pointer options, const char *name); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Takes a list of options and an option name, and returns a handle + for the first option entry in the list matching the name. Returns + <constant>NULL</constant> if no match is found. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + char *xf86FindOptionValue(pointer options, const char *name); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Takes a list of options and an option name, and returns the value + associated with the first option entry in the list matching the + name. If the matching option has no value, an empty string + (<constant>""</constant>) is returned. Returns <constant>NULL</constant> + if no match is found. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void xf86MarkOptionUsed(pointer option); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Takes a handle for an option, and marks that option as used. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void xf86MarkOptionUsedByName(pointer options, const char *name); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Takes a list of options and an option name and marks the first + option entry in the list matching the name as used. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <para> +Next, the higher level functions that most drivers would use. + </para> + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void xf86CollectOptions(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, pointer extraOpts); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Collect the options from each of the config file sections used by + the screen (<parameter>pScrn</parameter>) and return the merged list as + <structfield>pScrn->options</structfield>. This function requires that + <structfield>pScrn->confScreen</structfield>, <structfield>pScrn->display</structfield>, + <structfield>pScrn->monitor</structfield>, + <structfield>pScrn->numEntities</structfield>, and + <structfield>pScrn->entityList</structfield> are initialised. + <parameter>extraOpts</parameter> may optionally be set to an additional + list of options to be combined with the others. The order of + precedence for options is <parameter>extraOpts</parameter>, display, + confScreen, monitor, device. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void xf86ProcessOptions(int scrnIndex, pointer options, + OptionInfoPtr optinfo); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Processes a list of options according to the information in the + array of <structname>OptionInfoRecs</structname> (<parameter>optinfo</parameter>). + The resulting information is stored in the <structfield>value</structfield> + fields of the appropriate <parameter>optinfo</parameter> entries. The + <structfield>found</structfield> fields are set to <constant>TRUE</constant> + when an option with a value of the correct type if found, and + <constant>FALSE</constant> otherwise. The <structfield>type</structfield> field + is used to determine the expected value type for each option. + Each option in the list of options for which there is a name match + (but not necessarily a value type match) is marked as used. + Warning messages are printed when option values don't match the + types specified in the optinfo data. + </para> + + <para> + NOTE: If this function is called before a driver's screen number + is known (e.g., from the <function>ChipProbe()</function> function) a + <parameter>scrnIndex</parameter> value of <constant>-1</constant> should be + used. + </para> + + <para> + NOTE 2: Given that this function stores into the + <literal remap="tt">OptionInfoRecs</literal> pointed to by <parameter>optinfo</parameter>, + the caller should ensure the <literal remap="tt">OptionInfoRecs</literal> are + (re-)initialised before the call, especially if the caller expects + to use the predefined option values as defaults. + </para> + + <para> + The <structname>OptionInfoRec</structname> is defined as follows: + + <programlisting> + typedef struct { + double freq; + int units; + } OptFrequency; + + typedef union { + unsigned long num; + char * str; + double realnum; + Bool bool; + OptFrequency freq; + } ValueUnion; + + typedef enum { + OPTV_NONE = 0, + OPTV_INTEGER, + OPTV_STRING, /* a non-empty string */ + OPTV_ANYSTR, /* Any string, including an empty one */ + OPTV_REAL, + OPTV_BOOLEAN, + OPTV_PERCENT, + OPTV_FREQ + } OptionValueType; + + typedef enum { + OPTUNITS_HZ = 1, + OPTUNITS_KHZ, + OPTUNITS_MHZ + } OptFreqUnits; + + typedef struct { + int token; + const char* name; + OptionValueType type; + ValueUnion value; + Bool found; + } OptionInfoRec, *OptionInfoPtr; + </programlisting> + </para> + <para> + <constant>OPTV_FREQ</constant> can be used for options values that are + frequencies. These values are a floating point number with an + optional unit name appended. The unit name can be one of "Hz", + "kHz", "k", "MHz", "M". The multiplier associated with the unit + is stored in <structfield>freq.units</structfield>, and the scaled frequency + is stored in <structfield>freq.freq</structfield>. When no unit is specified, + <structfield>freq.units</structfield> is set to <constant>0</constant>, and + <structfield>freq.freq</structfield> is unscaled. + </para> + + <para> + <constant>OPTV_PERCENT</constant> can be used for option values that are + specified in percent (e.g. "20%"). These values are a floating point + number with a percent sign appended. If the percent sign is missing, + the parser will fail to match the value. + </para> + + <para> + Typical usage is to setup an array of + <structname>OptionInfoRec</structname>s with all fields initialised. + The <structfield>value</structfield> and <structfield>found</structfield> fields get + set by <function>xf86ProcessOptions()</function>. For cases where the + value parsing is more complex, the driver should specify + <constant>OPTV_STRING</constant>, and parse the string itself. An + example of using this option handling is included in the + <link linkend="sample">Sample Driver</link> section. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void xf86ShowUnusedOptions(int scrnIndex, pointer options); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Prints out warning messages for each option in the list of options + that isn't marked as used. This is intended to show options that + the driver hasn't recognised. It would normally be called near + the end of the <function>ChipScreenInit()</function> function, but only + when <code>serverGeneration == 1</code> + </para> + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + OptionInfoPtr xf86TokenToOptinfo(const OptionInfoRec *table, + int token); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Returns a pointer to the <structname>OptionInfoRec</structname> in + <parameter>table</parameter> with a token field matching + <parameter>token</parameter>. Returns <constant>NULL</constant> if no match + is found. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + Bool xf86IsOptionSet(const OptionInfoRec *table, int token); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Returns the <literal remap="tt">found</literal> field of the + <structname>OptionInfoRec</structname> in <parameter>table</parameter> with a + <structfield>token</structfield> field matching <parameter>token</parameter>. This + can be used for options of all types. Note that for options of + type <constant>OPTV_BOOLEAN</constant>, it isn't sufficient to check + this to determine the value of the option. Returns + <constant>FALSE</constant> if no match is found. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + char *xf86GetOptValString(const OptionInfoRec *table, int token); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Returns the <structfield>value.str</structfield> field of the + <structname>OptionInfoRec</structname> in <parameter>table</parameter> with a + token field matching <parameter>token</parameter>. Returns + <constant>NULL</constant> if no match is found. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + Bool xf86GetOptValInteger(const OptionInfoRec *table, int token, + + int *value); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Returns via <parameter>*value</parameter> the <structfield>value.num</structfield> + field of the <structname>OptionInfoRec</structname> in <parameter>table</parameter> + with a <structfield>token</structfield> field matching <parameter>token</parameter>. + <parameter>*value</parameter> is only changed when a match is found so + it can be safely initialised with a default prior to calling this + function. The function return value is as for + <function>xf86IsOptionSet()</function>. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + Bool xf86GetOptValULong(const OptionInfoRec *table, int token, + unsigned long *value); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Like <function>xf86GetOptValInteger()</function>, except the value is + treated as an <type>unsigned long</type>. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + Bool xf86GetOptValReal(const OptionInfoRec *table, int token, + double *value); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Like <function>xf86GetOptValInteger()</function>, except that + <structfield>value.realnum</structfield> is used. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + Bool xf86GetOptValFreq(const OptionInfoRec *table, int token, + OptFreqUnits expectedUnits, double *value); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Like <function>xf86GetOptValInteger()</function>, except that the + <structfield>value.freq</structfield> data is returned. The frequency value + is scaled to the units indicated by <parameter>expectedUnits</parameter>. + The scaling is exact when the units were specified explicitly in + the option's value. Otherwise, the <parameter>expectedUnits</parameter> + field is used as a hint when doing the scaling. In this case, + values larger than <constant>1000</constant> are assumed to have be + specified in the next smallest units. For example, if the Option + value is "10000" and expectedUnits is <constant>OPTUNITS_MHZ</constant>, + the value returned is <constant>10</constant>. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + Bool xf86GetOptValBool(const OptionInfoRec *table, int token, Bool *value); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function is used to check boolean options + (<constant>OPTV_BOOLEAN</constant>). If the function return value is + <constant>FALSE</constant>, it means the option wasn't set. Otherwise + <parameter>*value</parameter> is set to the boolean value indicated by + the option's value. No option <parameter>value</parameter> is interpreted + as <constant>TRUE</constant>. Option values meaning <constant>TRUE</constant> + are "1", "yes", "on", "true", and option values meaning + <constant>FALSE</constant> are "0", "no", "off", "false". Option names + both with the "no" prefix in their names, and with that prefix + removed are also checked and handled in the obvious way. + <parameter>*value</parameter> is not changed when the option isn't present. + It should normally be set to a default value before calling this + function. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + Bool xf86ReturnOptValBool(const OptionInfoRec *table, int token, Bool def); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function is used to check boolean options + (<constant>OPTV_BOOLEAN</constant>). If the option is set, its value + is returned. If the options is not set, the default value specified + by <parameter>def</parameter> is returned. The option interpretation is + the same as for <function>xf86GetOptValBool()</function>. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + int xf86NameCmp(const char *s1, const char *s2); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function should be used when comparing strings from the config + file with expected values. It works like <function>strcmp()</function>, + but is not case sensitive and space, tab, and <quote><literal>_</literal></quote> characters + are ignored in the comparison. The use of this function isn't + restricted to parsing option values. It may be used anywhere + where this functionality required. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + </sect1> + + <sect1> + <title>Modules, Drivers, Include Files and Interface Issues</title> + + <para> +NOTE: this section is incomplete. + </para> + + + <sect2> + <title>Include files</title> + + <para> +The following include files are typically required by video drivers: + + <blockquote><para> + All drivers should include these: + <literallayout><filename> + "xf86.h" + "xf86_OSproc.h" + "xf86_ansic.h" + "xf86Resources.h" + </filename></literallayout> + Wherever inb/outb (and related things) are used the following should be + included: + <literallayout><filename> + "compiler.h" + </filename></literallayout> + Note: in drivers, this must be included after <filename>"xf86_ansic.h"</filename>. + </para> + + <para> + Drivers that need to access PCI vendor/device definitions need this: + <literallayout><filename> + "xf86PciInfo.h" + </filename></literallayout> + </para> + + <para> + Drivers that need to access the PCI config space need this: + <literallayout><filename> + "xf86Pci.h" + </filename></literallayout> + </para> + + <para> + Drivers that initialise a SW cursor need this: + <literallayout><filename> + "mipointer.h" + </filename></literallayout> + </para> + + <para> + All drivers implementing backing store need this: + <literallayout><filename> + "mibstore.h" + </filename></literallayout> + </para> + + <para> + All drivers using the mi colourmap code need this: + <literallayout><filename> + "micmap.h" + </filename></literallayout> + </para> + + <para> + If a driver uses the vgahw module, it needs this: + <literallayout><filename> + "vgaHW.h" + </filename></literallayout> + </para> + + <para> + Drivers supporting VGA or Hercules monochrome screens need: + <literallayout><filename> + "xf1bpp.h" + </filename></literallayout> + </para> + + <para> + Drivers supporting VGA or EGC 16-colour screens need: + <literallayout><filename> + "xf4bpp.h" + </filename></literallayout> + </para> + + <para> + Drivers using cfb need: + <programlisting> + #define PSZ 8 + #include "cfb.h" + #undef PSZ + </programlisting> + </para> + + <para> + Drivers supporting bpp 16, 24 or 32 with cfb need one or more of: + <literallayout><filename> + "cfb16.h" + "cfb24.h" + "cfb32.h" + </filename></literallayout> + </para> + + <para> + If a driver uses XAA, it needs these: + <literallayout><filename> + "xaa.h" + "xaalocal.h" + </filename></literallayout> + </para> + + <para> + If a driver uses the fb manager, it needs this: + <literallayout><filename> + "xf86fbman.h" + </filename></literallayout> + </para> + </blockquote> + </para> + + <para> +Non-driver modules should include <filename>"xf86_ansic.h"</filename> to get the correct +wrapping of ANSI C/libc functions. + </para> + + <para> +All modules must NOT include any system include files, or the following: + + <literallayout><filename> + "xf86Priv.h" + "xf86Privstr.h" + "xf86_OSlib.h" + "Xos.h" + </filename></literallayout> + </para> + + <para> +In addition, "xf86_libc.h" must not be included explicitly. It is +included implicitly by "xf86_ansic.h". + </para> + + </sect2> + </sect1> + + <sect1> + <title>Offscreen Memory Manager</title> + + <para> +Management of offscreen video memory may be handled by the XFree86 +framebuffer manager. Once the offscreen memory manager is running, +drivers or extensions may allocate, free or resize areas of offscreen +video memory using the following functions (definitions taken from +<filename>xf86fbman.h</filename>): + + <programlisting> + typedef struct _FBArea { + ScreenPtr pScreen; + BoxRec box; + int granularity; + void (*MoveAreaCallback)(struct _FBArea*, struct _FBArea*) + void (*RemoveAreaCallback)(struct _FBArea*) + DevUnion devPrivate; + } FBArea, *FBAreaPtr; + + typedef void (*MoveAreaCallbackProcPtr)(FBAreaPtr from, FBAreaPtr to) + typedef void (*RemoveAreaCallbackProcPtr)(FBAreaPtr) + + FBAreaPtr xf86AllocateOffscreenArea ( + ScreenPtr pScreen, + int width, int height, + int granularity, + MoveAreaCallbackProcPtr MoveAreaCallback, + RemoveAreaCallbackProcPtr RemoveAreaCallback, + pointer privData + ) + + void xf86FreeOffscreenArea (FBAreaPtr area) + + Bool xf86ResizeOffscreenArea ( + FBAreaPtr area + int w, int h + ) + </programlisting> + </para> + + <para> +The function: + <programlisting> + Bool xf86FBManagerRunning(ScreenPtr pScreen); + </programlisting> + +can be used by an extension to check if the driver has initialized +the memory manager. The manager is not available if this returns +<constant>FALSE</constant> and the functions above will all fail. + </para> + + + <para> +<function>xf86AllocateOffscreenArea()</function> can be used to request a +rectangle of dimensions <parameter>width</parameter> × <parameter>height</parameter> +(in pixels) from unused offscreen memory. <parameter>granularity</parameter> +specifies that the leftmost edge of the rectangle must lie on some +multiple of <parameter>granularity</parameter> pixels. A granularity of zero +means the same thing as a granularity of one - no alignment preference. +A <parameter>MoveAreaCallback</parameter> can be provided to notify the requester +when the offscreen area is moved. If no <parameter>MoveAreaCallback</parameter> +is supplied then the area is considered to be immovable. The +<parameter>privData</parameter> field will be stored in the manager's internal +structure for that allocated area and will be returned to the requester +in the <parameter>FBArea</parameter> passed via the +<parameter>MoveAreaCallback</parameter>. An optional +<parameter>RemoveAreaCallback</parameter> is provided. If the driver provides +this it indicates that the area should be allocated with a lower priority. +Such an area may be removed when a higher priority request (one that +doesn't have a <parameter>RemoveAreaCallback</parameter>) is made. When this +function is called, the driver will have an opportunity to do whatever +cleanup it needs to do to deal with the loss of the area, but it must +finish its cleanup before the function exits since the offscreen memory +manager will free the area immediately after. + </para> + + <para> +<function>xf86AllocateOffscreenArea()</function> returns <constant>NULL</constant> +if it was unable to allocate the requested area. When no longer needed, +areas should be freed with <function>xf86FreeOffscreenArea()</function>. + </para> + + <para> +<function>xf86ResizeOffscreenArea()</function> resizes an existing +<literal remap="tt">FBArea</literal>. <function>xf86ResizeOffscreenArea()</function> +returns <constant>TRUE</constant> if the resize was successful. If +<function>xf86ResizeOffscreenArea()</function> returns <constant>FALSE</constant>, +the original <literal remap="tt">FBArea</literal> is left unmodified. Resizing an +area maintains the area's original <literal remap="tt">granularity</literal>, +<literal remap="tt">devPrivate</literal>, and <literal remap="tt">MoveAreaCallback</literal>. +<function>xf86ResizeOffscreenArea()</function> has considerably less overhead +than freeing the old area then reallocating the new size, so it should +be used whenever possible. + </para> + + <para> +The function: + <programlisting> + Bool xf86QueryLargestOffscreenArea( + ScreenPtr pScreen, + int *width, int *height, + int granularity, + int preferences, + int priority + ); + </programlisting> + +is provided to query the width and height of the largest single +<structname>FBArea</structname> allocatable given a particular priority. +<parameter>preferences</parameter> can be one of the following to indicate +whether width, height or area should be considered when determining +which is the largest single <structname>FBArea</structname> available. + + <programlisting> + FAVOR_AREA_THEN_WIDTH + FAVOR_AREA_THEN_HEIGHT + FAVOR_WIDTH_THEN_AREA + FAVOR_HEIGHT_THEN_AREA + </programlisting> + </para> + + <para> +<parameter>priority</parameter> is one of the following: + + <blockquote> + <para> + <constant>PRIORITY_LOW</constant> + <blockquote><para> + Return the largest block available without stealing anyone else's + space. This corresponds to the priority of allocating a + <structname>FBArea</structname> when a <function>RemoveAreaCallback</function> + is provided. + </para></blockquote> + </para> + + <para> + <constant>PRIORITY_NORMAL</constant> + <blockquote><para> + Return the largest block available if it is acceptable to steal a + lower priority area from someone. This corresponds to the priority + of allocating a <structname>FBArea</structname> without providing a + <function>RemoveAreaCallback</function>. + </para></blockquote> + </para> + + <para> + <constant>PRIORITY_EXTREME</constant> + <blockquote><para> + Return the largest block available if all <structname>FBArea</structname>s + that aren't locked down were expunged from memory first. This + corresponds to any allocation made directly after a call to + <function>xf86PurgeUnlockedOffscreenAreas()</function>. + </para></blockquote> + </para> + + </blockquote> + </para> + + + <para> +The function: + + <programlisting> + Bool xf86PurgeUnlockedOffscreenAreas(ScreenPtr pScreen); + </programlisting> + +is provided as an extreme method to free up offscreen memory. This +will remove all removable <structname>FBArea</structname> allocations. + </para> + + + <para> +Initialization of the XFree86 framebuffer manager is done via + + <programlisting> + Bool xf86InitFBManager(ScreenPtr pScreen, BoxPtr FullBox); + </programlisting> + +<parameter>FullBox</parameter> represents the area of the framebuffer that the +manager is allowed to manage. This is typically a box with a width of +<structfield>pScrn->displayWidth</structfield> and a height of as many lines as +can be fit within the total video memory, however, the driver can reserve +areas at the extremities by passing a smaller area to the manager. + </para> + + <para> +<function>xf86InitFBManager()</function> must be called before XAA is +initialized since XAA uses the manager for it's pixmap cache. + </para> + + <para> +An alternative function is provided to allow the driver to initialize +the framebuffer manager with a Region rather than a box. + + <programlisting> + Bool xf86InitFBManagerRegion(ScreenPtr pScreen, + RegionPtr FullRegion); + </programlisting> + +<function>xf86InitFBManagerRegion()</function>, unlike +<function>xf86InitFBManager()</function>, does not remove the area used for +the visible screen so that area should not be included in the region +passed to the function. <function>xf86InitFBManagerRegion()</function> is +useful when non-contiguous areas are available to be managed, and is +required when multiple framebuffers are stored in video memory (as in +the case where an overlay of a different depth is stored as a second +framebuffer in offscreen memory). + </para> + + </sect1> + + <sect1 id="cmap"> + <title>Colormap Handling</title> + + <para> +A generic colormap handling layer is provided within the XFree86 common +layer. This layer takes care of most of the details, and only requires +a function from the driver that loads the hardware palette when required. +To use the colormap layer, a driver calls the +<function>xf86HandleColormaps()</function> function. + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + Bool xf86HandleColormaps(ScreenPtr pScreen, int maxColors, + int sigRGBbits, LoadPaletteFuncPtr loadPalette, + SetOverscanFuncPtr setOverscan, + unsigned int flags); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function must be called after the default colormap has been + initialised. The <structfield>pScrn->gamma</structfield> field must also + be initialised, preferably by calling <function>xf86SetGamma()</function>. + <parameter>maxColors</parameter> is the number of entries in the palette. + <parameter>sigRGBbits</parameter> is the size in bits of each color + component in the DAC's palette. <parameter>loadPalette</parameter> + is a driver-provided function for loading a colormap into the + hardware, and is described below. <parameter>setOverscan</parameter> is + an optional function that may be provided when the overscan color + is an index from the standard LUT and when it needs to be adjusted + to keep it as close to black as possible. The + <parameter>setOverscan</parameter> function programs the overscan index. + It shouldn't normally be used for depths other than 8. + <parameter>setOverscan</parameter> should be set to <constant>NULL</constant> + when it isn't needed. <parameter>flags</parameter> may be set to the + following (which may be ORed together): + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>CMAP_PALETTED_TRUECOLOR</constant></term> + <listitem><para> + the TrueColor visual is paletted and is + just a special case of DirectColor. + This flag is only valid for + <code>bpp > 8</code>. + + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>CMAP_RELOAD_ON_MODE_SWITCH</constant></term> + <listitem><para> + reload the colormap automatically + after mode switches. This is useful + for when the driver is resetting the + hardware during mode switches and + corrupting or erasing the hardware + palette. + + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>CMAP_LOAD_EVEN_IF_OFFSCREEN</constant></term> + <listitem><para> + reload the colormap even if the screen + is switched out of the server's VC. + The palette is <emphasis>not</emphasis> reloaded when + the screen is switched back in, nor after + mode switches. This is useful when the + driver needs to keep track of palette + changes. + + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + The colormap layer normally reloads the palette after VT enters so it + is not necessary for the driver to save and restore the palette + when switching VTs. The driver must, however, still save the + initial palette during server start up and restore it during + server exit. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void LoadPalette(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, int numColors, int *indices, + LOCO *colors, VisualPtr pVisual); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + <function>LoadPalette()</function> is a driver-provided function for + loading a colormap into hardware. <parameter>colors</parameter> is the + array of RGB values that represent the full colormap. + <parameter>indices</parameter> is a list of index values into the colors + array. These indices indicate the entries that need to be updated. + <parameter>numColors</parameter> is the number of the indices to be + updated. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void SetOverscan(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, int overscan); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + <function>SetOverscan()</function> is a driver-provided function for + programming the <parameter>overscan</parameter> index. As described + above, it is normally only appropriate for LUT modes where all + colormap entries are available for the display, but where one of + them is also used for the overscan (typically 8bpp for VGA compatible + LUTs). It isn't required in cases where the overscan area is + never visible. + </para> + + </blockquote></para> + </blockquote></para> + + </sect1> + + <sect1> + <title>DPMS Extension</title> + + <para> +Support code for the DPMS extension is included in the XFree86 common layer. +This code provides an interface between the main extension code, and a means +for drivers to initialise DPMS when they support it. One function is +available to drivers to do this initialisation, and it is always available, +even when the DPMS extension is not supported by the core server (in +which case it returns a failure result). + </para> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + Bool xf86DPMSInit(ScreenPtr pScreen, DPMSSetProcPtr set, int flags); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function registers a driver's DPMS level programming function + <parameter>set</parameter>. It also checks + <structfield>pScrn->options</structfield> for the "dpms" option, and when + present marks DPMS as being enabled for that screen. The + <parameter>set</parameter> function is called whenever the DPMS level + changes, and is used to program the requested level. + <parameter>flags</parameter> is currently not used, and should be + <constant>0</constant>. If the initialisation fails for any reason, + including when there is no DPMS support in the core server, the + function returns <constant>FALSE</constant>. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + + <para> +Drivers that implement DPMS support must provide the following function, +that gets called when the DPMS level is changed: + + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void ChipDPMSSet(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, int level, int flags); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Program the DPMS level specified by <parameter>level</parameter>. Valid + values of <parameter>level</parameter> are <constant>DPMSModeOn</constant>, + <constant>DPMSModeStandby</constant>, <constant>DPMSModeSuspend</constant>, + <constant>DPMSModeOff</constant>. These values are defined in + <filename>"extensions/dpms.h"</filename>. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + </para> + + </sect1> + + <sect1> + <title>DGA Extension</title> + + <para> +Drivers can support the XFree86 Direct Graphics Architecture (DGA) by +filling out a structure of function pointers and a list of modes and +passing them to DGAInit. + </para> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + Bool DGAInit(ScreenPtr pScreen, DGAFunctionPtr funcs, + DGAModePtr modes, int num); + +/** The DGAModeRec **/ + +typedef struct { + int num; + DisplayModePtr mode; + int flags; + int imageWidth; + int imageHeight; + int pixmapWidth; + int pixmapHeight; + int bytesPerScanline; + int byteOrder; + int depth; + int bitsPerPixel; + unsigned long red_mask; + unsigned long green_mask; + unsigned long blue_mask; + int viewportWidth; + int viewportHeight; + int xViewportStep; + int yViewportStep; + int maxViewportX; + int maxViewportY; + int viewportFlags; + int offset; + unsigned char *address; + int reserved1; + int reserved2; +} DGAModeRec, *DGAModePtr; + </programlisting> + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>num</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + Can be ignored. The DGA DDX will assign these numbers. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>mode</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + A pointer to the <structname>DisplayModeRec</structname> for this mode. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>flags</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + The following flags are defined and may be OR'd together: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>DGA_CONCURRENT_ACCESS</constant></term> + <listitem><para> + Indicates that the driver supports concurrent graphics + accelerator and linear framebuffer access. + + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>DGA_FILL_RECT + DGA_BLIT_RECT + DGA_BLIT_RECT_TRANS</constant></term> + <listitem><para> + Indicates that the driver supports the FillRect, BlitRect + or BlitTransRect functions in this mode. + + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>DGA_PIXMAP_AVAILABLE</constant></term> + <listitem><para> + Indicates that Xlib may be used on the framebuffer. + This flag will usually be set unless the driver wishes + to prohibit this for some reason. + + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>DGA_INTERLACED + DGA_DOUBLESCAN</constant></term> + <listitem><para> + Indicates that these are interlaced or double scan modes. + + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>imageWidth + imageHeight</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + These are the dimensions of the linear framebuffer + accessible by the client. + + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>pixmapWidth + pixmapHeight</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + These are the dimensions of the area of the + framebuffer accessible by the graphics accelerator. + + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>bytesPerScanline</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + Pitch of the framebuffer in bytes. + + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>byteOrder</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + Usually the same as + <structfield>pScrn->imageByteOrder</structfield>. + + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>depth</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + The depth of the framebuffer in this mode. + + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>bitsPerPixel</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + The number of bits per pixel in this mode. + + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>red_mask</structfield></term> + <term><structfield>green_mask</structfield></term> + <term><structfield>blue_mask</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + The RGB masks for this mode, if applicable. + + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>viewportWidth</structfield></term> + <term><structfield>viewportHeight</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + Dimensions of the visible part of the framebuffer. + Usually <structfield>mode->HDisplay</structfield> and + <structfield>mode->VDisplay</structfield>. + + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>xViewportStep + yViewportStep</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + The granularity of x and y viewport positions that + the driver supports in this mode. + + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>maxViewportX + maxViewportY</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + The maximum viewport position supported by the + driver in this mode. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>viewportFlags</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + The following may be OR'd together: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>DGA_FLIP_IMMEDIATE</constant></term> + <listitem><para> + The driver supports immediate viewport changes. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>DGA_FLIP_RETRACE</constant></term> + + <listitem><para> + The driver supports viewport changes at retrace. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>offset</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + The offset into the linear framebuffer that corresponds to + pixel (0,0) for this mode. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>address</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + The virtual address of the framebuffer as mapped by the driver. + This is needed when DGA_PIXMAP_AVAILABLE is set. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + </variablelist> + + <programlisting> +/** The DGAFunctionRec **/ + +typedef struct { + Bool (*OpenFramebuffer)( + ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, + char **name, + unsigned char **mem, + int *size, + int *offset, + int *extra + ); + void (*CloseFramebuffer)(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn); + Bool (*SetMode)(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, DGAModePtr pMode); + void (*SetViewport)(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, int x, int y, int flags); + int (*GetViewport)(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn); + void (*Sync)(ScrnInfoPtr); + void (*FillRect)( + ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, + int x, int y, int w, int h, + unsigned long color + ); + void (*BlitRect)( + ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, + int srcx, int srcy, + int w, int h, + int dstx, int dsty + ); + void (*BlitTransRect)( + ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, + int srcx, int srcy, + int w, int h, + int dstx, int dsty, + unsigned long color + ); +} DGAFunctionRec, *DGAFunctionPtr; + </programlisting> + + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + Bool OpenFramebuffer (pScrn, name, mem, size, offset, extra); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + <function>OpenFramebuffer()</function> should pass the client everything + it needs to know to be able to open the framebuffer. These + parameters are OS specific and their meanings are to be interpreted + by an OS specific client library. + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term><parameter>name</parameter></term> + <listitem><para> + The name of the device to open or <constant>NULL</constant> if + there is no special device to open. A <constant>NULL</constant> + name tells the client that it should open whatever device + one would usually open to access physical memory. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><parameter>mem</parameter></term> + <listitem><para> + The physical address of the start of the framebuffer. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><parameter>size</parameter></term> + <listitem><para> + The size of the framebuffer in bytes. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><parameter>offset</parameter></term> + <listitem><para> + Any offset into the device, if applicable. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><parameter>flags</parameter></term> + <listitem><para> + Any additional information that the client may need. + Currently, only the <constant>DGA_NEED_ROOT</constant> flag is + defined. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + </variablelist> + </para></blockquote> + </para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void CloseFramebuffer (pScrn); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + <function>CloseFramebuffer()</function> merely informs the driver (if it + even cares) that client no longer needs to access the framebuffer + directly. This function is optional. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + Bool SetMode (pScrn, pMode); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + <function>SetMode()</function> tells the driver to initialize the mode + passed to it. If <parameter>pMode</parameter> is <constant>NULL</constant>, + then the driver should restore the original pre-DGA mode. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void SetViewport (pScrn, x, y, flags); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + <function>SetViewport()</function> tells the driver to make the upper + left-hand corner of the visible screen correspond to coordinate + <literal remap="tt">(x,y)</literal> on the framebuffer. <parameter>flags</parameter> + currently defined are: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>DGA_FLIP_IMMEDIATE</constant></term> + <listitem><para> + The viewport change should occur immediately. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>DGA_FLIP_RETRACE</constant></term> + <listitem><para> + The viewport change should occur at the + vertical retrace, but this function should + return sooner if possible. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + The <literal remap="tt">(x,y)</literal> locations will be passed as the client + specified them, however, the driver is expected to round these + locations down to the next supported location as specified by the + <structfield>xViewportStep</structfield> and <structfield>yViewportStep</structfield> + for the current mode. + </para> + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + int GetViewport (pScrn); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + <function>GetViewport()</function> gets the current page flip status. + Set bits in the returned int correspond to viewport change requests + still pending. For instance, set bit zero if the last SetViewport + request is still pending, bit one if the one before that is still + pending, etc. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void Sync (pScrn); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function should ensure that any graphics accelerator operations + have finished. This function should not return until the graphics + accelerator is idle. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void FillRect (pScrn, x, y, w, h, color); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This optional function should fill a rectangle + <parameter>w × h</parameter> located at + <parameter>(x,y)</parameter> in the given color. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void BlitRect (pScrn, srcx, srcy, w, h, dstx, dsty); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This optional function should copy an area + <parameter>w × h</parameter> located at + <parameter>(srcx,srcy)</parameter> to location <parameter>(dstx,dsty)</parameter>. + This function will need to handle copy directions as appropriate. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void BlitTransRect (pScrn, srcx, srcy, w, h, dstx, dsty, color); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This optional function is the same as BlitRect except that pixels + in the source corresponding to the color key <parameter>color</parameter> + should be skipped. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + </para></blockquote> + + </sect1> + + <sect1> + <title>The XFree86 X Video Extension (Xv) Device Dependent Layer</title> + + <para> +XFree86 offers the X Video Extension which allows clients to treat video +as any another primitive and <quote>Put</quote> video into drawables. By default, +the extension reports no video adaptors as being available since the +DDX layer has not been initialized. The driver can initialize the DDX +layer by filling out one or more <literal remap="tt">XF86VideoAdaptorRecs</literal> +as described later in this document and passing a list of +<literal remap="tt">XF86VideoAdaptorPtr</literal> pointers to the following function: + + <programlisting> + Bool xf86XVScreenInit(ScreenPtr pScreen, + XF86VideoAdaptorPtr *adaptPtrs, + int num); + </programlisting> + </para> + + <para> +After doing this, the extension will report video adaptors as being +available, providing the data in their respective +<literal remap="tt">XF86VideoAdaptorRecs</literal> was valid. +<function>xf86XVScreenInit()</function> <emphasis>copies</emphasis> data from the structure +passed to it so the driver may free it after the initialization. At +the moment, the DDX only supports rendering into Window drawables. +Pixmap rendering will be supported after a sufficient survey of suitable +hardware is completed. + </para> + + <para> +The <structname>XF86VideoAdaptorRec</structname>: + + <programlisting> +typedef struct { + unsigned int type; + int flags; + char *name; + int nEncodings; + XF86VideoEncodingPtr pEncodings; + int nFormats; + XF86VideoFormatPtr pFormats; + int nPorts; + DevUnion *pPortPrivates; + int nAttributes; + XF86AttributePtr pAttributes; + int nImages; + XF86ImagePtr pImages; + PutVideoFuncPtr PutVideo; + PutStillFuncPtr PutStill; + GetVideoFuncPtr GetVideo; + GetStillFuncPtr GetStill; + StopVideoFuncPtr StopVideo; + SetPortAttributeFuncPtr SetPortAttribute; + GetPortAttributeFuncPtr GetPortAttribute; + QueryBestSizeFuncPtr QueryBestSize; + PutImageFuncPtr PutImage; + QueryImageAttributesFuncPtr QueryImageAttributes; +} XF86VideoAdaptorRec, *XF86VideoAdaptorPtr; + </programlisting></para> + + <para> +Each adaptor will have its own XF86VideoAdaptorRec. The fields are +as follows: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>type</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + This can be any of the following flags OR'd together. + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>XvInputMask</constant> + <constant>XvOutputMask</constant></term> + <listitem><para> + These refer to the target drawable and are similar to a Window's + class. <literal remap="tt">XvInputMask</literal> indicates that the adaptor + can put video into a drawable. <literal remap="tt">XvOutputMask</literal> + indicates that the adaptor can get video from a drawable. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>XvVideoMask</constant> + <constant>XvStillMask</constant> + <constant>XvImageMask</constant></term> + <listitem><para> + These indicate that the adaptor supports video, still or + image primitives respectively. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>XvWindowMask</constant> + <constant>XvPixmapMask</constant></term> + <listitem><para> + These indicate the types of drawables the adaptor is capable + of rendering into. At the moment, Pixmap rendering is not + supported and the <constant>XvPixmapMask</constant> flag is ignored. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + </variablelist> + + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>flags</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + Currently, the following flags are defined: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>VIDEO_NO_CLIPPING</constant></term> + <listitem><para> + This indicates that the video adaptor does not support + clipping. The driver will never receive <quote>Put</quote> requests + where less than the entire area determined by + <parameter>drw_x</parameter>, <parameter>drw_y</parameter>, + <parameter>drw_w</parameter> and <parameter>drw_h</parameter> is visible. + This flag does not apply to <quote>Get</quote> requests. Hardware + that is incapable of clipping <quote>Gets</quote> may punt or get + the extents of the clipping region passed to it. + </para></listitem> + + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>VIDEO_INVERT_CLIPLIST</constant></term> + <listitem><para> + This indicates that the video driver requires the clip + list to contain the regions which are obscured rather + than the regions which are are visible. + </para></listitem> + + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>VIDEO_OVERLAID_STILLS</constant></term> + <listitem><para> + Implementing PutStill for hardware that does video as an + overlay can be awkward since it's unclear how long to leave + the video up for. When this flag is set, StopVideo will be + called whenever the destination gets clipped or moved so that + the still can be left up until then. + </para></listitem> + + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>VIDEO_OVERLAID_IMAGES</constant></term> + <listitem><para> + Same as <constant>VIDEO_OVERLAID_STILLS</constant> but for images. + </para></listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>VIDEO_CLIP_TO_VIEWPORT</constant></term> + <listitem><para> + Indicates that the clip region passed to the driver functions + should be clipped to the visible portion of the screen in the + case where the viewport is smaller than the virtual desktop. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + </variablelist> + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>name</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + The name of the adaptor. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>nEncodings</structfield> + <structfield>pEncodings</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + The number of encodings the adaptor is capable of and pointer + to the <structname>XF86VideoEncodingRec</structname> array. The + <structname>XF86VideoEncodingRec</structname> is described later on. + For drivers that only support XvImages there should be an encoding + named "XV_IMAGE" and the width and height should specify + the maximum size source image supported. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>nFormats</structfield> + <structfield>pFormats</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + The number of formats the adaptor is capable of and pointer to + the <structname>XF86VideoFormatRec</structname> array. The + <structname>XF86VideoFormatRec</structname> is described later on. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>nPorts</structfield> + <structfield>pPortPrivates</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + The number of ports is the number of separate data streams which + the adaptor can handle simultaneously. If you have more than + one port, the adaptor is expected to be able to render into more + than one window at a time. <structfield>pPortPrivates</structfield> is + an array of pointers or ints - one for each port. A port's + private data will be passed to the driver any time the port is + requested to do something like put the video or stop the video. + In the case where there may be many ports, this enables the + driver to know which port the request is intended for. Most + commonly, this will contain a pointer to the data structure + containing information about the port. In Xv, all ports on + a particular adaptor are expected to be identical in their + functionality. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>nAttributes</structfield> + <structfield>pAttributes</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + The number of attributes recognized by the adaptor and a pointer to + the array of <structname>XF86AttributeRecs</structname>. The + <structname>XF86AttributeRec</structname> is described later on. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>nImages</structfield> + <structfield>pImages</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + The number of <structname>XF86ImageRecs</structname> supported by the adaptor + and a pointer to the array of <structname>XF86ImageRecs</structname>. The + <structname>XF86ImageRec</structname> is described later on. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield> + PutVideo PutStill GetVideo GetStill StopVideo + SetPortAttribute GetPortAttribute QueryBestSize PutImage + QueryImageAttributes + </structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + These functions define the DDX->driver interface. In each + case, the pointer <parameter>data</parameter> is passed to the driver. + This is the port private for that port as described above. All + fields are required except under the following conditions: + + <orderedlist> + <listitem><para> + <structfield>PutVideo</structfield>, <structfield>PutStill</structfield> and + the image routines <structfield>PutImage</structfield> and + <structfield>QueryImageAttributes</structfield> are not required when the + adaptor type does not contain <constant>XvInputMask</constant>. + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + <structfield>GetVideo</structfield> and <structfield>GetStill</structfield> + are not required when the adaptor type does not contain + <constant>XvOutputMask</constant>. + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + <structfield>GetVideo</structfield> and <structfield>PutVideo</structfield> + are not required when the adaptor type does not contain + <constant>XvVideoMask</constant>. + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + <structfield>GetStill</structfield> and <structfield>PutStill</structfield> + are not required when the adaptor type does not contain + <constant>XvStillMask</constant>. + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + <structfield>PutImage</structfield> and <structfield>QueryImageAttributes</structfield> + are not required when the adaptor type does not contain + <constant>XvImageMask</constant>. + </para></listitem> + + </orderedlist> + + </para> + + <para> + With the exception of <structfield>QueryImageAttributes</structfield>, these + functions should return <constant>Success</constant> if the operation was + completed successfully. They can return <constant>XvBadAlloc</constant> + otherwise. <structfield>QueryImageAttributes</structfield> returns the size + of the XvImage queried. + </para> + + <para> + If the <constant>VIDEO_NO_CLIPPING</constant> + flag is set, the <literal remap="tt">clipBoxes</literal> may be ignored by + the driver. <literal remap="tt">ClipBoxes</literal> is an <literal remap="tt">X-Y</literal> + banded region identical to those used throughout the server. + The clipBoxes represent the visible portions of the area determined + by <literal remap="tt">drw_x</literal>, <literal remap="tt">drw_y</literal>, + <literal remap="tt">drw_w</literal> and <literal remap="tt">drw_h</literal> in the Get/Put + function. The boxes are in screen coordinates, are guaranteed + not to overlap and an empty region will never be passed. + If the driver has specified <constant>VIDEO_INVERT_CLIPLIST</constant>, + <literal remap="tt">clipBoxes</literal> will indicate the areas of the primitive + which are obscured rather than the areas visible. + + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + </variablelist> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + typedef int (* PutVideoFuncPtr)( ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, + short vid_x, short vid_y, short drw_x, short drw_y, + short vid_w, short vid_h, short drw_w, short drw_h, + RegionPtr clipBoxes, pointer data ); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This indicates that the driver should take a subsection + <parameter>vid_w</parameter> by <parameter>vid_h</parameter> at location + <parameter>(vid_x,vid_y)</parameter> from the video stream and direct + it into the rectangle <parameter>drw_w</parameter> by <parameter>drw_h</parameter> + at location <parameter>(drw_x,drw_y)</parameter> on the screen, scaling as + necessary. Due to the large variations in capabilities of + the various hardware expected to be used with this extension, + it is not expected that all hardware will be able to do this + exactly as described. In that case the driver should just do + <quote>the best it can,</quote> scaling as closely to the target rectangle + as it can without rendering outside of it. In the worst case, + the driver can opt to just not turn on the video. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + typedef int (* PutStillFuncPtr)( ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, + short vid_x, short vid_y, short drw_x, short drw_y, + short vid_w, short vid_h, short drw_w, short drw_h, + RegionPtr clipBoxes, pointer data ); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This is same as <structfield>PutVideo</structfield> except that the driver + should place only one frame from the stream on the screen. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + typedef int (* GetVideoFuncPtr)( ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, + short vid_x, short vid_y, short drw_x, short drw_y, + short vid_w, short vid_h, short drw_w, short drw_h, + RegionPtr clipBoxes, pointer data ); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This is same as <structfield>PutVideo</structfield> except that the driver + gets video from the screen and outputs it. The driver should + do the best it can to get the requested dimensions correct + without reading from an area larger than requested. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + typedef int (* GetStillFuncPtr)( ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, + short vid_x, short vid_y, short drw_x, short drw_y, + short vid_w, short vid_h, short drw_w, short drw_h, + RegionPtr clipBoxes, pointer data ); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This is the same as <literal remap="tt">GetVideo</literal> except that the + driver should place only one frame from the screen into the + output stream. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + typedef void (* StopVideoFuncPtr)(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, + pointer data, Bool cleanup); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This indicates the driver should stop displaying the video. + This is used to stop both input and output video. The + <parameter>cleanup</parameter> field indicates that the video is + being stopped because the client requested it to stop or + because the server is exiting the current VT. In that case + the driver should deallocate any offscreen memory areas (if + there are any) being used to put the video to the screen. If + <parameter>cleanup</parameter> is not set, the video is being stopped + temporarily due to clipping or moving of the window, etc... + and video will likely be restarted soon so the driver should + not deallocate any offscreen areas associated with that port. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + typedef int (* SetPortAttributeFuncPtr)(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, + Atom attribute,INT32 value, pointer data); + </programlisting> + + <programlisting> + typedef int (* GetPortAttributeFuncPtr)(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, + Atom attribute,INT32 *value, pointer data); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + A port may have particular attributes such as hue, + saturation, brightness or contrast. Xv clients set and + get these attribute values by sending attribute strings + (Atoms) to the server. Such requests end up at these + driver functions. It is recommended that the driver provide + at least the following attributes mentioned in the Xv client + library docs: + <literallayout><constant> + XV_ENCODING + XV_HUE + XV_SATURATION + XV_BRIGHTNESS + XV_CONTRAST + </constant></literallayout> + but the driver may recognize as many atoms as it wishes. If + a requested attribute is unknown by the driver it should return + <constant>BadMatch</constant>. <constant>XV_ENCODING</constant> is the + attribute intended to let the client specify which video + encoding the particular port should be using (see the description + of <structname>XF86VideoEncodingRec</structname> below). If the + requested encoding is unsupported, the driver should return + <constant>XvBadEncoding</constant>. If the value lies outside the + advertised range <constant>BadValue</constant> may be returned. + <constant>Success</constant> should be returned otherwise. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + typedef void (* QueryBestSizeFuncPtr)(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, + Bool motion, short vid_w, short vid_h, + short drw_w, short drw_h, + unsigned int *p_w, unsigned int *p_h, pointer data); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + <function>QueryBestSize</function> provides the client with a way + to query what the destination dimensions would end up being + if they were to request that an area + <parameter>vid_w</parameter> by <parameter>vid_h</parameter> from the video + stream be scaled to rectangle of + <parameter>drw_w</parameter> by <parameter>drw_h</parameter> on the screen. + Since it is not expected that all hardware will be able to + get the target dimensions exactly, it is important that the + driver provide this function. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + typedef int (* PutImageFuncPtr)( ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, + short src_x, short src_y, short drw_x, short drw_y, + short src_w, short src_h, short drw_w, short drw_h, + int image, char *buf, short width, short height, + Bool sync, RegionPtr clipBoxes, pointer data ); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This is similar to <structfield>PutStill</structfield> except that the + source of the video is not a port but the data stored in a system + memory buffer at <parameter>buf</parameter>. The data is in the format + indicated by the <parameter>image</parameter> descriptor and represents a + source of size <parameter>width</parameter> by <parameter>height</parameter>. + If <parameter>sync</parameter> is TRUE the driver should not return + from this function until it is through reading the data + from <parameter>buf</parameter>. Returning when <parameter>sync</parameter> + is TRUE indicates that it is safe for the data at <parameter>buf</parameter> + to be replaced, freed, or modified. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + typedef int (* QueryImageAttributesFuncPtr)( ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, + int image, short *width, short *height, + int *pitches, int *offsets); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function is called to let the driver specify how data for + a particular <parameter>image</parameter> of size <parameter>width</parameter> + by <parameter>height</parameter> should be stored. Sometimes only + the size and corrected width and height are needed. In that + case <parameter>pitches</parameter> and <parameter>offsets</parameter> are + NULL. The size of the memory required for the image is returned + by this function. The <parameter>width</parameter> and + <parameter>height</parameter> of the requested image can be altered by + the driver to reflect format limitations (such as component + sampling periods that are larger than one). If + <parameter>pitches</parameter> and <parameter>offsets</parameter> are not NULL, + these will be arrays with as many elements in them as there + are planes in the <parameter>image</parameter> format. The driver + should specify the pitch (in bytes) of each scanline in the + particular plane as well as the offset to that plane (in bytes) + from the beginning of the image. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + </para> + + <para> +The XF86VideoEncodingRec: + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> +typedef struct { + int id; + char *name; + unsigned short width, height; + XvRationalRec rate; +} XF86VideoEncodingRec, *XF86VideoEncodingPtr; + + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + The <structname>XF86VideoEncodingRec</structname> specifies what encodings + the adaptor can support. Most of this data is just informational + and for the client's benefit, and is what will be reported by + <function>XvQueryEncodings</function>. The <parameter>id</parameter> field is + expected to be a unique identifier to allow the client to request a + certain encoding via the <constant>XV_ENCODING</constant> attribute string. + + </para> + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + </para> + + <para> +The XF86VideoFormatRec: + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> +typedef struct { + char depth; + short class; +} XF86VideoFormatRec, *XF86VideoFormatPtr; + + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This specifies what visuals the video is viewable in. + <parameter>depth</parameter> is the depth of the visual (not bpp). + <parameter>class</parameter> is the visual class such as + <constant>TrueColor</constant>, <constant>DirectColor</constant> or + <constant>PseudoColor</constant>. Initialization of an adaptor will fail + if none of the visuals on that screen are supported. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + </para> + + <para> +The XF86AttributeRec: + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> +typedef struct { + int flags; + int min_value; + int max_value; + char *name; +} XF86AttributeListRec, *XF86AttributeListPtr; + + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Each adaptor may have an array of these advertising the attributes + for its ports. Currently defined flags are <literal remap="tt">XvGettable</literal> + and <literal remap="tt">XvSettable</literal> which may be OR'd together indicating that + attribute is <quote>gettable</quote> or <quote>settable</quote> by the client. The + <literal remap="tt">min</literal> and <literal remap="tt">max</literal> field specify the valid range + for the value. <literal remap="tt">Name</literal> is a text string describing the + attribute by name. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + </para> + + <para> +The XF86ImageRec: + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> +typedef struct { + int id; + int type; + int byte_order; + char guid[16]; + int bits_per_pixel; + int format; + int num_planes; + + /* for RGB formats */ + int depth; + unsigned int red_mask; + unsigned int green_mask; + unsigned int blue_mask; + + /* for YUV formats */ + unsigned int y_sample_bits; + unsigned int u_sample_bits; + unsigned int v_sample_bits; + unsigned int horz_y_period; + unsigned int horz_u_period; + unsigned int horz_v_period; + unsigned int vert_y_period; + unsigned int vert_u_period; + unsigned int vert_v_period; + char component_order[32]; + int scanline_order; +} XF86ImageRec, *XF86ImagePtr; + + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + XF86ImageRec describes how video source data is laid out in memory. + The fields are as follows: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>id</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + This is a unique descriptor for the format. It is often good to + set this value to the FOURCC for the format when applicable. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>type</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + This is <constant>XvRGB</constant> or <constant>XvYUV</constant>. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>byte_order</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + This is <constant>LSBFirst</constant> or <constant>MSBFirst</constant>. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>guid</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + This is the Globally Unique IDentifier for the format. When + not applicable, all characters should be NULL. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>bits_per_pixel</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + The number of bits taken up (but not necessarily used) by each + pixel. Note that for some planar formats which have fractional + bits per pixel (such as IF09) this number may be rounded _down_. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>format</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + This is <constant>XvPlanar</constant> or <constant>XvPacked</constant>. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>num_planes</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + The number of planes in planar formats. This should be set to + one for packed formats. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>depth</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + The significant bits per pixel in RGB formats (analgous to the + depth of a pixmap format). + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>red_mask</structfield></term> + <term><structfield>green_mask</structfield></term> + <term><structfield>blue_mask</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + The red, green and blue bitmasks for packed RGB formats. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>y_sample_bits</structfield></term> + <term><structfield>u_sample_bits</structfield></term> + <term><structfield>v_sample_bits</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + The y, u and v sample sizes (in bits). + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>horz_y_period</structfield></term> + <term><structfield>horz_u_period</structfield></term> + <term><structfield>horz_v_period</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + The y, u and v sampling periods in the horizontal direction. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>vert_y_period</structfield></term> + <term><structfield>vert_u_period</structfield></term> + <term><structfield>vert_v_period</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + The y, u and v sampling periods in the vertical direction. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>component_order</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + Uppercase ascii characters representing the order that + samples are stored within packed formats. For planar formats + this represents the ordering of the planes. Unused characters + in the 32 byte string should be set to NULL. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>scanline_order</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + This is <constant>XvTopToBottom</constant> or <constant>XvBottomToTop</constant>. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + Since some formats (particular some planar YUV formats) may not +be completely defined by the parameters above, the guid, when +available, should provide the most accurate description of the +format. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + </para> + </sect1> + + <sect1> + <title>The Loader</title> + + <para> +This section describes the interfaces to the module loader. The loader +interfaces can be divided into two groups: those that are only available to +the XFree86 common layer, and those that are also available to modules. + </para> + + <sect2> + <title>Loader Overview</title> + + <para> +The loader is capable of loading modules in a range of object formats, +and knowledge of these formats is built in to the loader. Knowledge of +new object formats can be added to the loader in a straightforward +manner. This makes it possible to provide OS-independent modules (for +a given CPU architecture type). In addition to this, the loader can +load modules via the OS-provided <function>dlopen(3)</function> service where +available. Such modules are not platform independent, and the semantics +of <function>dlopen()</function> on most systems results in significant +limitations in the use of modules of this type. Support for +<function>dlopen()</function> modules in the loader is primarily for +experimental and development purposes. + </para> + + <para> +Symbols exported by the loader (on behalf of the core X server) to +modules are determined at compile time. Only those symbols explicitly +exported are available to modules. All external symbols of loaded +modules are exported to other modules, and to the core X server. The +loader can be requested to check for unresolved symbols at any time, +and the action to be taken for unresolved symbols can be controlled by +the caller of the loader. Typically the caller identifies which symbols +can safely remain unresolved and which cannot. + </para> + + <para> +NOTE: Now that ISO-C allows pointers to functions and pointers to data to +have different internal representations, some of the following interfaces +will need to be revisited. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>Semi-private Loader Interface</title> + + <para> +The following is the semi-private loader interface that is available to the +XFree86 common layer. + </para> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void LoaderInit(void); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + The <function>LoaderInit()</function> function initialises the loader, + and it must be called once before calling any other loader functions. + This function initialises the tables of exported symbols, and anything + else that might need to be initialised. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void LoaderSetPath(const char *path); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + The <function>LoaderSetPath()</function> function initialises a default + module search path. This must be called if calls to other functions + are to be made without explicitly specifying a module search path. + The search path <parameter>path</parameter> must be a string of one or more + comma separated absolute paths. Modules are expected to be located + below these paths, possibly in subdirectories of these paths. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + pointer LoadModule(const char *module, const char *path, + const char **subdirlist, const char **patternlist, + pointer options, const XF86ModReqInfo * modreq, + int *errmaj, int *errmin); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + The <function>LoadModule()</function> function loads the module called + <parameter>module</parameter>. The return value is a module handle, and + may be used in future calls to the loader that require a reference + to a loaded module. The module name <parameter>module</parameter> is + normally the module's canonical name, which doesn't contain any + directory path information, or any object/library file prefixes of + suffixes. Currently a full pathname and/or filename is also accepted. + This might change. The other parameters are: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term><parameter>path</parameter></term> + <listitem><para> + An optional comma-separated list of module search paths. + When <constant>NULL</constant>, the default search path is used. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + + <varlistentry> + <term><parameter>subdirlist</parameter></term> + <listitem><para> + An optional <constant>NULL</constant> terminated list of + subdirectories to search. When <constant>NULL</constant>, + the default built-in list is used (refer to + <varname>stdSubdirs</varname> in <filename>loadmod.c</filename>). + The default list is also substituted for entries in + <parameter>subdirlist</parameter> with the value + <constant>DEFAULT_LIST</constant>. This makes is possible + to augment the default list instead of replacing it. + Subdir elements must be relative, and must not contain + <literal remap="tt">".."</literal>. If any violate this requirement, + the load fails. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + + <varlistentry> + <term><parameter>patternlist</parameter></term> + <listitem><para> + An optional <constant>NULL</constant> terminated list of + POSIX regular expressions used to connect module + filenames with canonical module names. Each regex + should contain exactly one subexpression that corresponds + to the canonical module name. When <constant>NULL</constant>, + the default built-in list is used (refer to + <varname>stdPatterns</varname> in + <filename>loadmod.c</filename>). The default list is also + substituted for entries in <parameter>patternlist</parameter> + with the value <constant>DEFAULT_LIST</constant>. This + makes it possible to augment the default list instead + of replacing it. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + + <varlistentry> + <term><parameter>options</parameter></term> + <listitem><para> + An optional parameter that is passed to the newly + loaded module's <literal remap="tt">SetupProc</literal> function + (if it has one). This argument is normally a + <constant>NULL</constant> terminated list of + <structname>Options</structname>, and must be interpreted that + way by modules loaded directly by the XFree86 common + layer. However, it may be used for application-specific + parameter passing in other situations. + </para> + + <para> + When loading <quote>external</quote> modules (modules that don't + have the standard entry point, for example a + special shared library) the options parameter can be + set to <constant>EXTERN_MODULE</constant> to tell the + loader not to reject the module when it doesn't find + the standard entry point. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + + <varlistentry> + <term><parameter>modreq</parameter></term> + <listitem><para> + An optional <structname>XF86ModReqInfo*</structname> containing + version/ABI/vendor information to requirements to + check the newly loaded module against. The main + purpose of this is to allow the loader to verify that + a module of the correct type/version before running + its <function>SetupProc</function> function. + </para> + + <para> + The <literal remap="tt">XF86ModReqInfo</literal> struct is defined + as follows: + <programlisting> +typedef struct { + CARD8 majorversion; /* MAJOR_UNSPEC */ + CARD8 minorversion; /* MINOR_UNSPEC */ + CARD16 patchlevel; /* PATCH_UNSPEC */ + const char * abiclass; /* ABI_CLASS_NONE */ + CARD32 abiversion; /* ABI_VERS_UNSPEC */ + const char * moduleclass; /* MOD_CLASS_NONE */ +} XF86ModReqInfo; + </programlisting> + + The information here is compared against the equivalent + information in the module's + <structname>XF86ModuleVersionInfo</structname> record (which + is described below). The values in comments above + indicate <quote>don't care</quote> settings for each of the fields. + The comparisons made are as follows: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>majorversion</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + Must match the module's majorversion + exactly. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>minorversion</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + The module's minor version must be + no less than this value. This + comparison is only made if + <structfield>majorversion</structfield> is + specified and matches. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>patchlevel</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + The module's patchlevel must be no + less than this value. This comparison + is only made if + <structfield>minorversion</structfield> is + specified and matches. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>abiclass</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + String must match the module's abiclass + string. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>abiversion</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + Must be consistent with the module's + abiversion (major equal, minor no + older). + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>moduleclass</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + String must match the module's + moduleclass string. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + </variablelist> + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><parameter>errmaj</parameter></term> + <listitem><para> + An optional pointer to a variable holding the major + part or the error code. When provided, + <parameter>*errmaj</parameter> is filled in when + <function>LoadModule()</function> fails. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><parameter>errmin</parameter></term> + <listitem><para> + Like <parameter>errmaj</parameter>, but for the minor part + of the error code. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + </variablelist> + + </para></blockquote> + </para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void UnloadModule(pointer mod); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function unloads the module referred to by the handle mod. + All child modules are also unloaded recursively. This function must + not be used to directly unload modules that are child modules (i.e., + those that have been loaded with the <function>LoadSubModule()</function> + described below). + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + </sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>Module Requirements</title> + + <para> +Modules must provide information about themselves to the loader, and +may optionally provide entry points for "setup" and "teardown" functions +(those two functions are referred to here as <function>SetupProc</function> +and <function>TearDownProc</function>). + </para> + + <para> +The module information is contained in the +<structname>XF86ModuleVersionInfo</structname> struct, which is defined as follows: + + <programlisting> +typedef struct { + const char * modname; /* name of module, e.g. "foo" */ + const char * vendor; /* vendor specific string */ + CARD32 _modinfo1_; /* constant MODINFOSTRING1/2 to find */ + CARD32 _modinfo2_; /* infoarea with a binary editor/sign tool */ + CARD32 xf86version; /* contains XF86_VERSION_CURRENT */ + CARD8 majorversion; /* module-specific major version */ + CARD8 minorversion; /* module-specific minor version */ + CARD16 patchlevel; /* module-specific patch level */ + const char * abiclass; /* ABI class that the module uses */ + CARD32 abiversion; /* ABI version */ + const char * moduleclass; /* module class */ + CARD32 checksum[4]; /* contains a digital signature of the */ + /* version info structure */ +} XF86ModuleVersionInfo; + </programlisting> + +The fields are used as follows: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>modname</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + The module's name. This field is currently only for + informational purposes, but the loader may be modified + in future to require it to match the module's canonical + name. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>vendor</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + The module vendor. This field is for informational purposes + only. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>_modinfo1_</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + This field holds the first part of a signature that can + be used to locate this structure in the binary. It should + always be initialised to <constant>MODINFOSTRING1</constant>. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>_modinfo2_</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + This field holds the second part of a signature that can + be used to locate this structure in the binary. It should + always be initialised to <constant>MODINFOSTRING2</constant>. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>xf86version</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + The XFree86 version against which the module was compiled. + This is mostly for informational/diagnostic purposes. It + should be initialised to <constant>XF86_VERSION_CURRENT</constant>, which is + defined in <filename>xf86Version.h</filename>. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>majorversion</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + The module-specific major version. For modules where this + version is used for more than simply informational + purposes, the major version should only change (be + incremented) when ABI incompatibilities are introduced, + or ABI components are removed. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>minorversion</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + The module-specific minor version. For modules where this + version is used for more than simply informational + purposes, the minor version should only change (be + incremented) when ABI additions are made in a backward + compatible way. It should be reset to zero when the major + version is increased. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>patchlevel</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + The module-specific patch level. The patch level should + increase with new revisions of the module where there + are no ABI changes, and it should be reset to zero when + the minor version is increased. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>abiclass</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + The ABI class that the module requires. The class is + specified as a string for easy extensibility. It should + indicate which (if any) of the X server's built-in ABI + classes that the module relies on, or a third-party ABI + if appropriate. Built-in ABI classes currently defined are: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>ABI_CLASS_NONE</constant></term> + <listitem><para>no class + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>ABI_CLASS_ANSIC</constant></term> + <listitem><para>only requires the ANSI C interfaces + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>ABI_CLASS_VIDEODRV</constant></term> + <listitem><para>requires the video driver ABI + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>ABI_CLASS_XINPUT</constant></term> + <listitem><para>requires the XInput driver ABI + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>ABI_CLASS_EXTENSION</constant></term> + <listitem><para>requires the extension module ABI + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>ABI_CLASS_FONT</constant></term> + <listitem><para>requires the font module ABI + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + </variablelist> + + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>abiversion</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + The version of abiclass that the module requires. The + version consists of major and minor components. The + major version must match and the minor version must be + no newer than that provided by the server or parent + module. Version identifiers for the built-in classes + currently defined are: + + <literallayout><constant> + ABI_ANSIC_VERSION + ABI_VIDEODRV_VERSION + ABI_XINPUT_VERSION + ABI_EXTENSION_VERSION + ABI_FONT_VERSION + </constant></literallayout> + + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>moduleclass</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + This is similar to the abiclass field, except that it + defines the type of module rather than the ABI it + requires. For example, although all video drivers require + the video driver ABI, not all modules that require the + video driver ABI are video drivers. This distinction + can be made with the moduleclass. Currently pre-defined + module classes are: + + <literallayout><constant> + MOD_CLASS_NONE + MOD_CLASS_VIDEODRV + MOD_CLASS_XINPUT + MOD_CLASS_FONT + MOD_CLASS_EXTENSION + </constant></literallayout> + + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>checksum</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + Not currently used. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> +The module version information, and the optional <function>SetupProc</function> +and <function>TearDownProc</function> entry points are found by the loader +by locating a data object in the module called "modnameModuleData", +where "modname" is the canonical name of the module. Modules must +contain such a data object, and it must be declared with global scope, +be compile-time initialised, and is of the following type: + + <programlisting> +typedef struct { + XF86ModuleVersionInfo * vers; + ModuleSetupProc setup; + ModuleTearDownProc teardown; +} XF86ModuleData; + </programlisting> + </para> + + <para> +The vers parameter must be initialised to a pointer to a correctly +initialised <structname>XF86ModuleVersionInfo</structname> struct. The other +two parameter are optional, and should be initialised to +<constant>NULL</constant> when not required. The other parameters are defined +as + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + typedef pointer (*ModuleSetupProc)(pointer, pointer, int *, int *); + + typedef void (*ModuleTearDownProc)(pointer); + + pointer SetupProc(pointer module, pointer options, + int *errmaj, int *errmin); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + When defined, this function is called by the loader after successfully + loading a module. module is a handle for the newly loaded module, + and maybe used by the <function>SetupProc</function> if it calls other + loader functions that require a reference to it. The remaining + arguments are those that were passed to the + <function>LoadModule()</function> (or <function>LoadSubModule()</function>), + and are described above. When the <function>SetupProc</function> is + successful it must return a non-<constant>NULL</constant> value. The + loader checks this, and if it is <constant>NULL</constant> it unloads + the module and reports the failure to the caller of + <function>LoadModule()</function>. If the <function>SetupProc</function> + does things that need to be undone when the module is unloaded, + it should define a <function>TearDownProc</function>, and return a + pointer that the <function>TearDownProc</function> can use to undo what + has been done. + </para> + + <para> + When a module is loaded multiple times, the <function>SetupProc</function> + is called once for each time it is loaded. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void TearDownProc(pointer tearDownData); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + When defined, this function is called when the loader unloads a + module. The <parameter>tearDownData</parameter> parameter is the return + value of the <function>SetupProc()</function> that was called when the + module was loaded. The purpose of this function is to clean up + before the module is unloaded (for example, by freeing allocated + resources). + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>Public Loader Interface</title> + + <para> +The following is the Loader interface that is available to any part of +the server, and may also be used from within modules. + </para> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + pointer LoadSubModule(pointer parent, const char *module, + const char **subdirlist, const char **patternlist, + pointer options, const XF86ModReqInfo * modreq, + int *errmaj, int *errmin); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function is like the <function>LoadModule()</function> function + described above, except that the module loaded is registered as a + child of the calling module. The <parameter>parent</parameter> parameter + is the calling module's handle. Modules loaded with this function + are automatically unloaded when the parent module is unloaded. The + other difference is that the path parameter may not be specified. + The module search path used for modules loaded with this function + is the default search path as initialised with + <function>LoaderSetPath()</function>. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void UnloadSubModule(pointer module); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function unloads the module with handle <parameter>module</parameter>. + If that module itself has children, they are also unloaded. It is + like <function>UnloadModule()</function>, except that it is safe to use + for unloading child modules. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + pointer LoaderSymbol(const char *symbol); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function returns the address of the symbol with name + <parameter>symbol</parameter>. This may be used to locate a module entry + point with a known name. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + char **LoaderlistDirs(const char **subdirlist, + const char **patternlist); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function returns a <constant>NULL</constant> terminated list of + canonical modules names for modules found in the default module + search path. The <parameter>subdirlist</parameter> and + <parameter>patternlist</parameter> parameters are as described above, and + can be used to control the locations and names that are searched. + If no modules are found, the return value is <constant>NULL</constant>. + The returned list should be freed by calling + <function>LoaderFreeDirList()</function> when it is no longer needed. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void LoaderFreeDirList(char **list); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function frees a module list created by + <function>LoaderlistDirs()</function>. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void LoaderReqSymLists(const char **list0, ...); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function allows the registration of required symbols with the + loader. It is normally used by a caller of + <function>LoadSubModule()</function>. If any symbols registered in this + way are found to be unresolved when + <function>LoaderCheckUnresolved()</function> is called then + <function>LoaderCheckUnresolved()</function> will report a failure. + The function takes one or more <constant>NULL</constant> terminated + lists of symbols. The end of the argument list is indicated by a + <constant>NULL</constant> argument. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void LoaderReqSymbols(const char *sym0, ...); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function is like <function>LoaderReqSymLists()</function> except + that its arguments are symbols rather than lists of symbols. This + function is more convenient when single functions are to be registered, + especially when the single function might depend on runtime factors. + The end of the argument list is indicated by a <constant>NULL</constant> + argument. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void LoaderRefSymLists(const char **list0, ...); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function allows the registration of possibly unresolved symbols + with the loader. When <function>LoaderCheckUnresolved()</function> is + run it won't generate warnings for symbols registered in this way + unless they were also registered as required symbols. + The function takes one or more <constant>NULL</constant> terminated + lists of symbols. The end of the argument list is indicated by a + <constant>NULL</constant> argument. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void LoaderRefSymbols(const char *sym0, ...); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function is like <function>LoaderRefSymLists()</function> except + that its arguments are symbols rather than lists of symbols. This + function is more convenient when single functions are to be registered, + especially when the single function might depend on runtime factors. + The end of the argument list is indicated by a <constant>NULL</constant> + argument. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + int LoaderCheckUnresolved(int delayflag); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function checks for unresolved symbols. It generates warnings + for unresolved symbols that have not been registered with + <function>LoaderRefSymLists()</function>, and maps them to a dummy + function. This behaviour may change in future. If unresolved + symbols are found that have been registered with + <function>LoaderReqSymLists()</function> or + <function>LoaderReqSymbols()</function> then this function returns a + non-zero value. If none of these symbols are unresolved the return + value is zero, indicating success. + </para> + + <para> + The <parameter>delayflag</parameter> parameter should normally be set to + <constant>LD_RESOLV_IFDONE</constant>. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + LoaderErrorMsg(const char *name, const char *modname, + int errmaj, int errmin); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function prints an error message that includes the text <quote>Failed + to load module</quote>, the module name <parameter>modname</parameter>, a message + specific to the <parameter>errmaj</parameter> value, and the value if + <parameter>errmin</parameter>. If <parameter>name</parameter> is + non-<constant>NULL</constant>, it is printed as an identifying prefix + to the message (followed by a <quote>:</quote>). + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + </sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>Special Registration Functions</title> + + <para> +The loader contains some functions for registering some classes of modules. +These may be moved out of the loader at some point. + </para> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void LoadExtension(ExtensionModule *ext); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This registers the entry points for the extension identified by + <parameter>ext</parameter>. The <structname>ExtensionModule</structname> struct is + defined as: + + <programlisting> +typedef struct { + InitExtension initFunc; + char * name; + Bool *disablePtr; + InitExtension setupFunc; +} ExtensionModule; + </programlisting> + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void LoadFont(FontModule *font); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This registers the entry points for the font rasteriser module + identified by <parameter>font</parameter>. The <structname>FontModule</structname> + struct is defined as: + + <programlisting> + typedef struct { + InitFont initFunc; + char * name; + pointer module; +} FontModule; + </programlisting> + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + </sect2> + + </sect1> + + <sect1> + <title>Helper Functions</title> + + <para> +This section describe <quote>helper</quote> functions that video driver +might find useful. While video drivers are not required to use any of +these to be considered <quote>compliant</quote>, the use of appropriate helpers is +strongly encouraged to improve the consistency of driver behaviour. + </para> + + <sect2> + <title>Functions for printing messages</title> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + ErrorF(const char *format, ...); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This is the basic function for writing to the error log (typically + stderr and/or a log file). Video drivers should usually avoid + using this directly in favour of the more specialised functions + described below. This function is useful for printing messages + while debugging a driver. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + FatalError(const char *format, ...); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This prints a message and causes the Xserver to abort. It should + rarely be used within a video driver, as most error conditions + should be flagged by the return values of the driver functions. + This allows the higher layers to decide how to proceed. In rare + cases, this can be used within a driver if a fatal unexpected + condition is found. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + xf86ErrorF(const char *format, ...); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This is like <function>ErrorF()</function>, except that the message is + only printed when the Xserver's verbosity level is set to the + default (<constant>1</constant>) or higher. It means that the messages + are not printed when the server is started with the + <option>-quiet</option> flag. Typically this function would only be + used for continuing messages started with one of the more specialised + functions described below. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + xf86ErrorFVerb(int verb, const char *format, ...); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Like <function>xf86ErrorF()</function>, except the minimum verbosity + level for which the message is to be printed is given explicitly. + Passing a <parameter>verb</parameter> value of zero means the message + is always printed. A value higher than <constant>1</constant> can be + used for information would normally not be needed, but which might + be useful when diagnosing problems. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + xf86Msg(MessageType type, const char *format, ...); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This is like <function>xf86ErrorF()</function>, except that the message + is prefixed with a marker determined by the value of + <parameter>type</parameter>. The marker is used to indicate the type of + message (warning, error, probed value, config value, etc). Note + the <varname>xf86Verbose</varname> value is ignored for messages of + type <constant>X_ERROR</constant>. + </para> + + <para> + The marker values are: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>X_PROBED</constant></term> + <listitem><para>Value was probed. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>X_CONFIG</constant></term> + <listitem><para>Value was given in the config file. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>X_DEFAULT</constant></term> + <listitem><para>Value is a default. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>X_CMDLINE</constant></term> + <listitem><para>Value was given on the command line. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>X_NOTICE</constant></term> + <listitem><para>Notice. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>X_ERROR</constant></term> + <listitem><para>Error message. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>X_WARNING</constant></term> + <listitem><para>Warning message. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>X_INFO</constant></term> + <listitem><para>Informational message. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>X_NONE</constant></term> + <listitem><para>No prefix. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>X_NOT_IMPLEMENTED</constant></term> + <listitem><para>The message relates to functionality + that is not yetimplemented. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + </variablelist> + + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + xf86MsgVerb(MessageType type, int verb, const char *format, ...); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Like <function>xf86Msg()</function>, but with the verbosity level given + explicitly. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + xf86DrvMsg(int scrnIndex, MessageType type, const char *format, ...); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This is like <function>xf86Msg()</function> except that the driver's + name (the <structfield>name</structfield> field of the + <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>) followed by the + <parameter>scrnIndex</parameter> in parentheses is printed following the + prefix. This should be used by video drivers in most cases as it + clearly indicates which driver/screen the message is for. If + <parameter>scrnIndex</parameter> is negative, this function behaves + exactly like <function>xf86Msg()</function>. + </para> + + <para> + NOTE: This function can only be used after the + <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> and its <structfield>name</structfield> field + have been allocated. Normally, this means that it can not be + used before the END of the <function>ChipProbe()</function> function. + Prior to that, use <function>xf86Msg()</function>, providing the + driver's name explicitly. No screen number can be supplied at + that point. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + xf86DrvMsgVerb(int scrnIndex, MessageType type, int verb, + const char *format, ...); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Like <function>xf86DrvMsg()</function>, but with the verbosity level + given explicitly. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + </sect2> + + + <sect2> + <title>Functions for setting values based on command line and config file</title> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + Bool xf86SetDepthBpp(ScrnInfoPtr scrp, int depth, int bpp, + + int fbbpp, int depth24flags); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function sets the <structfield>depth</structfield>, <structfield>pixmapBPP</structfield> and <structfield>bitsPerPixel</structfield> fields + of the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>. It also determines the defaults for display-wide + attributes and pixmap formats the screen will support, and finds + the Display subsection that matches the depth/bpp. This function + should normally be called very early from the + <function>ChipPreInit()</function> function. + </para> + + <para> + It requires that the <structfield>confScreen</structfield> field of the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> be + initialised prior to calling it. This is done by the XFree86 + common layer prior to calling <function>ChipPreInit()</function>. + </para> + + <para> + The parameters passed are: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term><parameter>depth</parameter></term> + <listitem><para> + driver's preferred default depth if no other is given. + If zero, use the overall server default. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><parameter>bpp</parameter></term> + <listitem><para> + Same, but for the pixmap bpp. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><parameter>fbbpp</parameter></term> + <listitem><para> + Same, but for the framebuffer bpp. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><parameter>depth24flags</parameter></term> + <listitem><para> + Flags that indicate the level of 24/32bpp support + and whether conversion between different framebuffer + and pixmap formats is supported. The flags for this + argument are defined as follows, and multiple flags + may be ORed together: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>NoDepth24Support</constant></term> + <listitem><para>No depth 24 formats supported + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>Support24bppFb</constant></term> + <listitem><para>24bpp framebuffer supported + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>Support32bppFb</constant></term> + <listitem><para>32bpp framebuffer supported + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>SupportConvert24to32</constant></term> + <listitem><para>Can convert 24bpp pixmap to 32bpp fb + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>SupportConvert32to24</constant></term> + <listitem><para>Can convert 32bpp pixmap to 24bpp fb + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>ForceConvert24to32</constant></term> + <listitem><para>Force 24bpp pixmap to 32bpp fb conversion + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>ForceConvert32to24</constant></term> + <listitem><para>Force 32bpp pixmap to 24bpp fb conversion + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + It uses the command line, config file, and default values in the + correct order of precedence to determine the depth and bpp values. + It is up to the driver to check the results to see that it supports + them. If not the <function>ChipPreInit()</function> function should + return <constant>FALSE</constant>. + </para> + + <para> + If only one of depth/bpp is given, the other is set to a reasonable + (and consistent) default. + </para> + + <para> + If a driver finds that the initial <parameter>depth24flags</parameter> + it uses later results in a fb format that requires more video + memory than is available it may call this function a second time + with a different <parameter>depth24flags</parameter> setting. + </para> + + <para> + On success, the return value is <constant>TRUE</constant>. On failure + it prints an error message and returns <constant>FALSE</constant>. + </para> + + <para> + The following fields of the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> are + initialised by this function: + + <blockquote><para> +<structfield>depth</structfield>, <structfield>bitsPerPixel</structfield>, +<structfield>display</structfield>, <structfield>imageByteOrder</structfield>, +<structfield>bitmapScanlinePad</structfield>, +<structfield>bitmapScanlineUnit</structfield>, <structfield>bitmapBitOrder</structfield>, +<structfield>numFormats</structfield>, <structfield>formats</structfield>, +<structfield>fbFormat</structfield>. + </para></blockquote> + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void xf86PrintDepthBpp(scrnInfoPtr scrp); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function can be used to print out the depth and bpp settings. + It should be called after the final call to + <function>xf86SetDepthBpp()</function>. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + Bool xf86SetWeight(ScrnInfoPtr scrp, rgb weight, rgb mask); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function sets the <structfield>weight</structfield>, <structfield>mask</structfield>, + <structfield>offset</structfield> and <structfield>rgbBits</structfield> fields of the + <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>. It would normally be called fairly + early in the <function>ChipPreInit()</function> function for + depths > 8bpp. + </para> + + <para> + It requires that the <structfield>depth</structfield> and + <structfield>display</structfield> fields of the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> + be initialised prior to calling it. + </para> + + <para> + The parameters passed are: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term><parameter>weight</parameter></term> + <listitem><para> + driver's preferred default weight if no other is given. + If zero, use the overall server default. + + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><parameter>mask</parameter></term> + <listitem><para> + Same, but for mask. + + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + It uses the command line, config file, and default values in the + correct order of precedence to determine the weight value. It + derives the mask and offset values from the weight and the defaults. + It is up to the driver to check the results to see that it supports + them. If not the <function>ChipPreInit()</function> function should + return <constant>FALSE</constant>. + </para> + + <para> + On success, this function prints a message showing the weight + values selected, and returns <constant>TRUE</constant>. + </para> + + <para> + On failure it prints an error message and returns <constant>FALSE</constant>. + </para> + + <para> + The following fields of the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> are + initialised by this function: + + <blockquote><para> + <structfield>weight</structfield>, + <structfield>mask</structfield>, + <structfield>offset</structfield>. + </para></blockquote> + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + Bool xf86SetDefaultVisual(ScrnInfoPtr scrp, int visual); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function sets the <structfield>defaultVisual</structfield> field of the + <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>. It would normally be called fairly + early from the <function>ChipPreInit()</function> function. + </para> + + <para> + It requires that the <structfield>depth</structfield> and + <structfield>display</structfield> fields of the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> + be initialised prior to calling it. + </para> + + <para> + The parameters passed are: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term><parameter>visual</parameter></term> + <listitem><para> + driver's preferred default visual if no other is given. + If <constant>-1</constant>, use the overall server default. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + It uses the command line, config file, and default values in the + correct order of precedence to determine the default visual value. + It is up to the driver to check the result to see that it supports + it. If not the <function>ChipPreInit()</function> function should + return <constant>FALSE</constant>. + </para> + + <para> + On success, this function prints a message showing the default visual + selected, and returns <constant>TRUE</constant>. + </para> + + <para> + On failure it prints an error message and returns <constant>FALSE</constant>. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + Bool xf86SetGamma(ScrnInfoPtr scrp, Gamma gamma); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function sets the <structfield>gamma</structfield> field of the + <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>. It would normally be called fairly + early from the <function>ChipPreInit()</function> function in cases + where the driver supports gamma correction. + </para> + + <para> + It requires that the <structfield>monitor</structfield> field of the + <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> be initialised prior to calling it. + </para> + + <para> + The parameters passed are: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term><parameter>gamma</parameter></term> + <listitem><para> + driver's preferred default gamma if no other is given. + If zero (<code>< 0.01</code>), use the overall server + default. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + It uses the command line, config file, and default values in the + correct order of precedence to determine the gamma value. It is + up to the driver to check the results to see that it supports + them. If not the <function>ChipPreInit()</function> function should + return <constant>FALSE</constant>. + </para> + + <para> + On success, this function prints a message showing the gamma + value selected, and returns <constant>TRUE</constant>. + </para> + + <para> + On failure it prints an error message and returns <constant>FALSE</constant>. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void xf86SetDpi(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, int x, int y); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function sets the <structfield>xDpi</structfield> and <structfield>yDpi</structfield> + fields of the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>. The driver can specify + preferred defaults by setting <parameter>x</parameter> and <parameter>y</parameter> + to non-zero values. The <option>-dpi</option> command line option + overrides all other settings. Otherwise, if the + <emphasis>DisplaySize</emphasis> entry is present in the screen's &k.monitor; + config file section, it is used together with the virtual size to + calculate the dpi values. This function should be called after + all the mode resolution has been done. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void xf86SetBlackWhitePixels(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This functions sets the <structfield>blackPixel</structfield> and + <structfield>whitePixel</structfield> fields of the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> + according to whether or not the <option>-flipPixels</option> command + line options is present. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + const char *xf86GetVisualName(int visual); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Returns a printable string with the visual name matching the + numerical visual class provided. If the value is outside the + range of valid visual classes, <constant>NULL</constant> is returned. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + </sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>Primary Mode functions</title> + + <para> +The primary mode helper functions are those which would normally be +used by a driver, unless it has unusual requirements which cannot +be catered for the by the helpers. + </para> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + int xf86ValidateModes(ScrnInfoPtr scrp, DisplayModePtr availModes, + char **modeNames, ClockRangePtr clockRanges, + int *linePitches, int minPitch, int maxPitch, + int pitchInc, int minHeight, int maxHeight, + int virtualX, int virtualY, + unsigned long apertureSize, + LookupModeFlags strategy); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function basically selects the set of modes to use based on + those available and the various constraints. It also sets some + other related parameters. It is normally called near the end of + the <function>ChipPreInit()</function> function. + </para> + + <para> + The parameters passed to the function are: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term><parameter>availModes</parameter></term> + <listitem><para> + List of modes available for the monitor. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><parameter>modeNames</parameter></term> + <listitem><para> + List of mode names that the screen is requesting. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><parameter>clockRanges</parameter></term> + <listitem><para> + A list of clock ranges allowed by the driver. Each + range includes whether interlaced or multiscan modes + are supported for that range. See below for more on + <parameter>clockRanges</parameter>. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><parameter>linePitches</parameter></term> + <listitem><para> + List of line pitches supported by the driver. + This is optional and should be <constant>NULL</constant> when + not used. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><parameter>minPitch</parameter></term> + <listitem><para> + Minimum line pitch supported by the driver. This must + be supplied when <parameter>linePitches</parameter> is + <constant>NULL</constant>, and is ignored otherwise. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><parameter>maxPitch</parameter></term> + <listitem><para> + Maximum line pitch supported by the driver. This is + required when <parameter>minPitch</parameter> is required. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><parameter>pitchInc</parameter></term> + <listitem><para> + Granularity of horizontal pitch values as supported by + the chipset. This is expressed in bits. This must be + supplied. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><parameter>minHeight</parameter></term> + <listitem><para> + minimum virtual height allowed. If zero, no limit is + imposed. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><parameter>maxHeight</parameter></term> + <listitem><para> + maximum virtual height allowed. If zero, no limit is + imposed. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><parameter>virtualX</parameter></term> + <listitem><para> + If greater than zero, this is the virtual width value + that will be used. Otherwise, the virtual width is + chosen to be the smallest that can accommodate the modes + selected. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><parameter>virtualY</parameter></term> + <listitem><para> + If greater than zero, this is the virtual height value + that will be used. Otherwise, the virtual height is + chosen to be the smallest that can accommodate the modes + selected. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><parameter>apertureSize</parameter></term> + <listitem><para> + The size (in bytes) of the aperture used to access video + memory. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><parameter>strategy</parameter></term> + <listitem><para> + The strategy to use when choosing from multiple modes + with the same name. The options are: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>LOOKUP_DEFAULT</constant></term> + <listitem><para>??? + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>LOOKUP_BEST_REFRESH</constant></term> + <listitem><para>mode with best refresh rate + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>LOOKUP_CLOSEST_CLOCK</constant></term> + <listitem><para>mode with closest matching clock + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>LOOKUP_LIST_ORDER</constant></term> + <listitem><para>first usable mode in list + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + </variablelist> + + The following options can also be combined (OR'ed) with + one of the above: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>LOOKUP_CLKDIV2</constant></term> + <listitem><para>Allow halved clocks + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>LOOKUP_OPTIONAL_TOLERANCES</constant></term> + <listitem><para> + Allow missing horizontal sync and/or vertical refresh + ranges in the xorg.conf Monitor section + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + </variablelist> + + <constant>LOOKUP_OPTIONAL_TOLERANCES</constant> should only be + specified when the driver can ensure all modes it generates + can sync on, or at least not damage, the monitor or digital + flat panel. Horizontal sync and/or vertical refresh ranges + specified by the user will still be honoured (and acted upon). + + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + This function requires that the following fields of the + <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> are initialised prior to calling it: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>clock[]</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + List of discrete clocks (when non-programmable) + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>numClocks</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + Number of discrete clocks (when non-programmable) + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>progClock</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + Whether the clock is programmable or not + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>monitor</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + Pointer to the applicable xorg.conf monitor section + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>fdFormat</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + Format of the screen buffer + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>videoRam</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + total video memory size (in bytes) + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>maxHValue</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + Maximum horizontal timing value allowed + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>maxVValue</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + Maximum vertical timing value allowed + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>xInc</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + Horizontal timing increment in pixels (defaults to 8) + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + This function fills in the following <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> + fields: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>modePool</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + A subset of the modes available to the monitor which + are compatible with the driver. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>modes</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + One mode entry for each of the requested modes, with + the status field of each filled in to indicate if + the mode has been accepted or not. This list of + modes is a circular list. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>virtualX</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + The resulting virtual width. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>virtualY</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + The resulting virtual height. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>displayWidth</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + The resulting line pitch. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>virtualFrom</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + Where the virtual size was determined from. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + The first stage of this function checks that the + <parameter>virtualX</parameter> and <parameter>virtualY</parameter> values + supplied (if greater than zero) are consistent with the line pitch + and <parameter>maxHeight</parameter> limitations. If not, an error + message is printed, and the return value is <constant>-1</constant>. + </para> + + <para> + The second stage sets up the mode pool, eliminating immediately + any modes that exceed the driver's line pitch limits, and also + the virtual width and height limits (if greater than zero). For + each mode removed an informational message is printed at verbosity + level <constant>2</constant>. If the mode pool ends up being empty, + a warning message is printed, and the return value is + <constant>0</constant>. + </para> + + <para> + The final stage is to lookup each mode name, and fill in the remaining + parameters. If an error condition is encountered, a message is + printed, and the return value is <constant>-1</constant>. Otherwise, + the return value is the number of valid modes found + (<constant>0</constant> if none are found). + </para> + + <para> + Even if the supplied mode names include duplicates, no two names will + ever match the same mode. Furthermore, if the supplied mode names do not + yield a valid mode (including the case where no names are passed at all), + the function will continue looking through the mode pool until it finds + a mode that survives all checks, or until the mode pool is exhausted. + </para> + + <para> + A message is only printed by this function when a fundamental + problem is found. It is intended that this function may be called + more than once if there is more than one set of constraints that + the driver can work within. + </para> + + <para> + If this function returns <constant>-1</constant>, the + <function>ChipPreInit()</function> function should return + <constant>FALSE</constant>. + </para> + + <para> + <parameter>clockRanges</parameter> is a linked list of clock ranges + allowed by the driver. If a mode doesn't fit in any of the defined + <parameter>clockRanges</parameter>, it is rejected. The first + <literal remap="tt">clockRange</literal> that matches all requirements is used. + This structure needs to be initialized to NULL when allocated. + </para> + + <para> + <parameter>clockRanges</parameter> contains the following fields: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>minClock</structfield></term> + <term><structfield>maxClock</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + The lower and upper mode clock bounds for which the rest + of the <structname>clockRange</structname> parameters apply. + Since these are the mode clocks, they are not scaled + with the <structfield>ClockMulFactor</structfield> and + <structfield>ClockDivFactor</structfield>. It is up to the driver + to adjust these values if they depend on the clock + scaling factors. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>clockIndex</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + (not used yet) <constant>-1</constant> for programmable clocks + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>interlaceAllowed</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + <constant>TRUE</constant> if interlacing is allowed for this + range + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>doubleScanAllowed</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + <constant>TRUE</constant> if doublescan or multiscan is allowed + for this range + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>ClockMulFactor</structfield></term> + <term><structfield>ClockDivFactor</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + Scaling factors that are applied to the mode clocks ONLY + before selecting a clock index (when there is no + programmable clock) or a <structfield>SynthClock</structfield> + value. This is useful for drivers that support pixel + multiplexing or that need to scale the clocks because + of hardware restrictions (like sending 24bpp data to an + 8 bit RAMDAC using a tripled clock). + </para> + + <para> + Note that these parameters describe what must be done + to the mode clock to achieve the data transport clock + between graphics controller and RAMDAC. For example + for <literal remap="tt">2:1</literal> pixel multiplexing, two pixels + are sent to the RAMDAC on each clock. This allows the + RAMDAC clock to be half of the actual pixel clock. + Hence, <code>ClockMulFactor=1</code> and + <code>ClockDivFactor=2</code>. This means that the + clock used for clock selection (ie, determining the + correct clock index from the list of discrete clocks) + or for the <structfield>SynthClock</structfield> field in case of + a programmable clock is: (<code>mode->Clock * + ClockMulFactor) / ClockDivFactor</code>. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>PrivFlags</structfield></term> + <listitem><para> + This field is copied into the + <literal remap="tt">mode->PrivFlags</literal> field when this + <literal remap="tt">clockRange</literal> is selected by + <function>xf86ValidateModes()</function>. It allows the + driver to find out what clock range was selected, so it + knows it needs to set up pixel multiplexing or any other + range-dependent feature. This field is purely + driver-defined: it may contain flag bits, an index or + anything else (as long as it is an <literal remap="tt">INT</literal>). + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + Note that the <structfield>mode->SynthClock</structfield> field is always + filled in by <function>xf86ValidateModes()</function>: it will contain + the <quote>data transport clock</quote>, which is the clock that will have + to be programmed in the chip when it has a programmable clock, or + the clock that will be picked from the clocks list when it is not + a programmable one. Thus: + + <programlisting> + mode->SynthClock = (mode->Clock * ClockMulFactor) / ClockDivFactor + </programlisting> + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void xf86PruneDriverModes(ScrnInfoPtr scrp); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function deletes modes in the modes field of the + <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> that have been marked as invalid. + This is normally run after having run + <function>xf86ValidateModes()</function> for the last time. For each + mode that is deleted, a warning message is printed out indicating + the reason for it being deleted. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void xf86SetCrtcForModes(ScrnInfoPtr scrp, int adjustFlags); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function fills in the <structname>Crtc*</structname> fields for all + the modes in the <structfield>modes</structfield> field of the + <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>. The <parameter>adjustFlags</parameter> + parameter determines how the vertical CRTC values are scaled for + interlaced modes. They are halved if it is + <constant>INTERLACE_HALVE_V</constant>. The vertical CRTC values are + doubled for doublescan modes, and are further multiplied by the + <literal remap="tt">VScan</literal> value. + </para> + + <para> + This function is normally called after calling + <function>xf86PruneDriverModes()</function>. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void xf86PrintModes(ScrnInfoPtr scrp); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function prints out the virtual size setting, and the line + pitch being used. It also prints out two lines for each mode being + used. The first line includes the mode's pixel clock, horizontal sync + rate, refresh rate, and whether it is interlaced, doublescanned and/or + multi-scanned. The second line is the mode's Modeline. + </para> + + <para> + This function is normally called after calling + <function>xf86SetCrtcForModes()</function>. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + </sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>Secondary Mode functions</title> + + <para> +The secondary mode helper functions are functions which are normally +used by the primary mode helper functions, and which are not normally +called directly by a driver. If a driver has unusual requirements +and needs to do its own mode validation, it might be able to make +use of some of these secondary mode helper functions. + </para> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + int xf86GetNearestClock(ScrnInfoPtr scrp, int freq, Bool allowDiv2, + int *divider); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function returns the index of the closest clock to the + frequency <parameter>freq</parameter> given (in kHz). It assumes that + the number of clocks is greater than zero. It requires that the + <structfield>numClocks</structfield> and <structfield>clock</structfield> fields of the + <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> are initialised. The + <structfield>allowDiv2</structfield> field determines if the clocks can be + halved. The <parameter>*divider</parameter> return value indicates + whether clock division is used when determining the clock returned. + </para> + + <para> + This function is only for non-programmable clocks. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + const char *xf86ModeStatusToString(ModeStatus status); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function converts the <parameter>status</parameter> value to a + descriptive printable string. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + ModeStatus xf86LookupMode(ScrnInfoPtr scrp, DisplayModePtr modep, + ClockRangePtr clockRanges, LookupModeFlags strategy); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function takes a pointer to a mode with the name filled in, + and looks for a mode in the <structfield>modePool</structfield> list which + matches. The parameters of the matching mode are filled in to + <parameter>*modep</parameter>. The <parameter>clockRanges</parameter> and + <parameter>strategy</parameter> parameters are as for the + <function>xf86ValidateModes()</function> function above. + </para> + + <para> + This function requires the <structfield>modePool</structfield>, + <structfield>clock[]</structfield>, <structfield>numClocks</structfield> and + <structfield>progClock</structfield> fields of the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> + to be initialised before being called. + </para> + + <para> + The return value is <constant>MODE_OK</constant> if a mode was found. + Otherwise it indicates why a matching mode could not be found. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + ModeStatus xf86InitialCheckModeForDriver(ScrnInfoPtr scrp, + DisplayModePtr mode, ClockRangePtr clockRanges, + LookupModeFlags strategy, int maxPitch, + int virtualX, int virtualY); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function checks the passed mode against some basic driver + constraints. Apart from the ones passed explicitly, the + <structfield>maxHValue</structfield> and <structfield>maxVValue</structfield> fields of + the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> are also used. If the + <structfield>ValidMode</structfield> field of the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> + is set, that function is also called to check the mode. Next, the + mode is checked against the monitor's constraints. + </para> + + <para> + If the mode is consistent with all constraints, the return value + is <constant>MODE_OK</constant>. Otherwise the return value indicates + which constraint wasn't met. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void xf86DeleteMode(DisplayModePtr *modeList, DisplayModePtr mode); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function deletes the <parameter>mode</parameter> given from the + <parameter>modeList</parameter>. It never prints any messages, so it is + up to the caller to print a message if required. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + </sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>Functions for handling strings and tokens</title> + + <para> + Tables associating strings and numerical tokens combined with the + following functions provide a compact way of handling strings from + the config file, and for converting tokens into printable strings. + The table data structure is: + + <programlisting> +typedef struct { + int token; + const char * name; +} SymTabRec, *SymTabPtr; + </programlisting> + </para> + + <para> + A table is an initialised array of <structname>SymTabRec</structname>. The + tokens must be non-negative integers. Multiple names may be mapped + to a single token. The table is terminated with an element with a + <structfield>token</structfield> value of <constant>-1</constant> and + <constant>NULL</constant> for the <structfield>name</structfield>. + </para> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + const char *xf86TokenToString(SymTabPtr table, int token); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function returns the first string in <parameter>table</parameter> + that matches <parameter>token</parameter>. If no match is found, + <constant>NULL</constant> is returned (NOTE, older versions of this + function would return the string "unknown" when no match is found). + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + int xf86StringToToken(SymTabPtr table, const char *string); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function returns the first token in <parameter>table</parameter> + that matches <parameter>string</parameter>. The + <function>xf86NameCmp()</function> function is used to determine the + match. If no match is found, <constant>-1</constant> is returned. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + </sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>Functions for finding which config file entries to use</title> + + <para> + These functions can be used to select the appropriate config file + entries that match the detected hardware. They are described above + in the <link linkend="probe">Probe</link> and + <link linkend="avail">Available Functions</link> sections. + </para> + + </sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>Probing discrete clocks on old hardware</title> + + <para> + The <function>xf86GetClocks()</function> function may be used to assist + in finding the discrete pixel clock values on older hardware. + </para> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void xf86GetClocks(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, int num, + Bool (*ClockFunc)(ScrnInfoPtr, int), + void (*ProtectRegs)(ScrnInfoPtr, Bool), + void (*BlankScreen)(ScrnInfoPtr, Bool), + int vertsyncreg, int maskval, int knownclkindex, + int knownclkvalue); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function uses a comparative sampling method to measure the + discrete pixel clock values. The number of discrete clocks to + measure is given by <parameter>num</parameter>. <parameter>clockFunc</parameter> + is a function that selects the <parameter>n</parameter>'th clock. It + should also save or restore any state affected by programming the + clocks when the index passed is <constant>CLK_REG_SAVE</constant> or + <constant>CLK_REG_RESTORE</constant>. <parameter>ProtectRegs</parameter> is + a function that does whatever is required to protect the hardware + state while selecting a new clock. <parameter>BlankScreen</parameter> + is a function that blanks the screen. <parameter>vertsyncreg</parameter> + and <parameter>maskval</parameter> are the register and bitmask to + check for the presence of vertical sync pulses. + <parameter>knownclkindex</parameter> and <parameter>knownclkvalue</parameter> + are the index and value of a known clock. These are the known + references on which the comparative measurements are based. The + number of clocks probed is set in <structfield>pScrn->numClocks</structfield>, + and the probed clocks are set in the <structfield>pScrn->clock[]</structfield> + array. All of the clock values are in units of kHz. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void xf86ShowClocks(ScrnInfoPtr scrp, MessageType from); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Print out the pixel clocks <parameter>scrp->clock[]</parameter>. + <parameter>from</parameter> indicates whether the clocks were probed + or from the config file. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + </sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>Other helper functions</title> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + Bool xf86IsUnblank(int mode); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Returns <constant>TRUE</constant> when the screen saver mode specified + by <parameter>mode</parameter> requires the screen be unblanked, + and <constant>FALSE</constant> otherwise. The screen saver modes that + require blanking are <constant>SCREEN_SAVER_ON</constant> and + <constant>SCREEN_SAVER_CYCLE</constant>, and the screen saver modes that + require unblanking are <constant>SCREEN_SAVER_OFF</constant> and + <constant>SCREEN_SAVER_FORCER</constant>. Drivers may call this helper + from their <function>SaveScreen()</function> function to interpret the + screen saver modes. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + </sect2> + </sect1> + + <sect1> + <title>The vgahw module</title> + + <para> +The vgahw modules provides an interface for saving, restoring and +programming the standard VGA registers, and for handling VGA colourmaps. + </para> + + <sect2> + <title>Data Structures</title> + + <para> + The public data structures used by the vgahw module are + <structname>vgaRegRec</structname> and <structname>vgaHWRec</structname>. They are + defined in <filename>vgaHW.h.</filename> + </para> + + </sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>General vgahw Functions</title> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + Bool vgaHWGetHWRec(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function allocates a <structname>vgaHWRec</structname> structure, and + hooks it into the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>'s + <structfield>privates</structfield>. Like all information hooked into the + <structfield>privates</structfield>, it is persistent, and only needs to be + allocated once per screen. This function should normally be called + from the driver's <function>ChipPreInit()</function> function. The + <structname>vgaHWRec</structname> is zero-allocated, and the following + fields are explicitly initialised: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>ModeReg.DAC[]</structfield></term> + <listitem><para>initialised with a default colourmap + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>ModeReg.Attribute[0x11]</structfield></term> + <listitem><para>initialised with the default overscan index + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>ShowOverscan</structfield></term> + <listitem><para>initialised according to the "ShowOverscan" option + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>paletteEnabled</structfield></term> + <listitem><para>initialised to FALSE + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>cmapSaved</structfield></term> + <listitem><para>initialised to FALSE + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + <varlistentry> + <term><structfield>pScrn</structfield></term> + <listitem><para>initialised to pScrn + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + In addition to the above, <function>vgaHWSetStdFuncs()</function> is + called to initialise the register access function fields with the + standard VGA set of functions. + </para> + + <para> + Once allocated, a pointer to the <structname>vgaHWRec</structname> can be + obtained from the <literal remap="tt">ScrnInfoPtr</literal> with the + <literal remap="tt">VGAHWPTR(pScrn)</literal> macro. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void vgaHWFreeHWRec(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function frees a <structname>vgaHWRec</structname> structure. It + should be called from a driver's <function>ChipFreeScreen()</function> + function. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + Bool vgaHWSetRegCounts(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, int numCRTC, + int numSequencer, int numGraphics, int numAttribute); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function allows the number of CRTC, Sequencer, Graphics and + Attribute registers to be changed. This makes it possible for + extended registers to be saved and restored with + <function>vgaHWSave()</function> and <function>vgaHWRestore()</function>. + This function should be called after a <structname>vgaHWRec</structname> + has been allocated with <function>vgaHWGetHWRec()</function>. The + default values are defined in <filename>vgaHW.h</filename> as follows: + + <programlisting> +#define VGA_NUM_CRTC 25 +#define VGA_NUM_SEQ 5 +#define VGA_NUM_GFX 9 +#define VGA_NUM_ATTR 21 + </programlisting> + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + Bool vgaHWCopyReg(vgaRegPtr dst, vgaRegPtr src); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function copies the contents of the VGA saved registers in + <parameter>src</parameter> to <parameter>dst</parameter>. Note that it isn't + possible to simply do this with <function>memcpy()</function> (or + similar). This function returns <constant>TRUE</constant> unless there + is a problem allocating space for the <structfield>CRTC</structfield> and + related fields in <parameter>dst</parameter>. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void vgaHWSetStdFuncs(vgaHWPtr hwp); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function initialises the register access function fields of + <parameter>hwp</parameter> with the standard VGA set of functions. This + is called by <function>vgaHWGetHWRec()</function>, so there is usually + no need to call this explicitly. The register access functions + are described below. If the registers are shadowed in some other + port I/O space (for example a PCI I/O region), these functions + can be used to access the shadowed registers if + <structfield>hwp->PIOOffset</structfield> is initialised with + <literal remap="tt">offset</literal>, calculated in such a way that when the + standard VGA I/O port value is added to it the correct offset into + the PIO area results. This value is initialised to zero in + <function>vgaHWGetHWRec()</function>. (Note: the PIOOffset functionality + is present in XFree86 4.1.0 and later.) + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void vgaHWSetMmioFuncs(vgaHWPtr hwp, CARD8 *base, int offset); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function initialised the register access function fields of + hwp with a generic MMIO set of functions. + <structfield>hwp->MMIOBase</structfield> is initialised with + <parameter>base</parameter>, which must be the virtual address that the + start of MMIO area is mapped to. <structfield>hwp->MMIOOffset</structfield> + is initialised with <parameter>offset</parameter>, which must be calculated + in such a way that when the standard VGA I/O port value is added + to it the correct offset into the MMIO area results. That means + that these functions are only suitable when the VGA I/O ports are + made available in a direct mapping to the MMIO space. If that is + not the case, the driver will need to provide its own register + access functions. The register access functions are described + below. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + Bool vgaHWMapMem(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function maps the VGA memory window. It requires that the + <structname>vgaHWRec</structname> be allocated. If a driver requires + non-default <structfield>MapPhys</structfield> or <structfield>MapSize</structfield> + settings (the physical location and size of the VGA memory window) + then those fields of the <structname>vgaHWRec</structname> must be initialised + before calling this function. Otherwise, this function initialiases + the default values of <constant>0xA0000</constant> for + <structfield>MapPhys</structfield> and <code>(64 * 1024)</code> for + <structfield>MapSize</structfield>. This function must be called before + attempting to save or restore the VGA state. If the driver doesn't + call it explicitly, the <function>vgaHWSave()</function> and + <function>vgaHWRestore()</function> functions may call it if they need + to access the VGA memory (in which case they will also call + <function>vgaHWUnmapMem()</function> to unmap the VGA memory before + exiting). + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void vgaHWUnmapMem(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function unmaps the VGA memory window. It must only be called + after the memory has been mapped. The <structfield>Base</structfield> field + of the <structname>vgaHWRec</structname> field is set to <constant>NULL</constant> + to indicate that the memory is no longer mapped. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void vgaHWGetIOBase(vgaHWPtr hwp); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function initialises the <structfield>IOBase</structfield> field of the + <structname>vgaHWRec</structname>. This function must be called before + using any other functions that access the video hardware. + </para> + + <para> + A macro <function>VGAHW_GET_IOBASE()</function> is also available in + <filename>vgaHW.h</filename> that returns the I/O base, and this may + be used when the vgahw module is not loaded (for example, in the + <function>ChipProbe()</function> function). + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void vgaHWUnlock(vgaHWPtr hwp); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function unlocks the VGA <literal remap="tt">CRTC[0-7]</literal> registers, + and must be called before attempting to write to those registers. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void vgaHWLock(vgaHWPtr hwp); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function locks the VGA <literal remap="tt">CRTC[0-7]</literal> registers. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void vgaHWEnable(vgaHWPtr hwp); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function enables the VGA subsystem. (Note, this function is + present in XFree86 4.1.0 and later.). + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void vgaHWDisable(vgaHWPtr hwp); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function disables the VGA subsystem. (Note, this function is + present in XFree86 4.1.0 and later.). + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void vgaHWSave(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, vgaRegPtr save, int flags); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function saves the VGA state. The state is written to the + <structname>vgaRegRec</structname> pointed to by <parameter>save</parameter>. + <parameter>flags</parameter> is set to one or more of the following flags + ORed together: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>VGA_SR_MODE</constant></term> + <listitem><para>the mode setting registers are saved + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>VGA_SR_FONTS</constant></term> + <listitem><para>the text mode font/text data is saved + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>VGA_SR_CMAP</constant></term> + <listitem><para>the colourmap (LUT) is saved + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + <varlistentry> + <term><constant>VGA_SR_ALL</constant></term> + <listitem><para>all of the above are saved + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + The <structname>vgaHWRec</structname> and its <structfield>IOBase</structfield> fields + must be initialised before this function is called. If + <constant>VGA_SR_FONTS</constant> is set in <parameter>flags</parameter>, the + VGA memory window must be mapped. If it isn't then + <function>vgaHWMapMem()</function> will be called to map it, and + <function>vgaHWUnmapMem()</function> will be called to unmap it + afterwards. <function>vgaHWSave()</function> uses the three functions + below in the order <function>vgaHWSaveColormap()</function>, + <function>vgaHWSaveMode()</function>, <function>vgaHWSaveFonts()</function> to + carry out the different save phases. It is undecided at this + stage whether they will remain part of the vgahw module's public + interface or not. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void vgaHWSaveMode(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, vgaRegPtr save); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function saves the VGA mode registers. They are saved to + the <structname>vgaRegRec</structname> pointed to by <parameter>save</parameter>. + The registers saved are: + + <literallayout> + MiscOut + CRTC[0-0x18] + Attribute[0-0x14] + Graphics[0-8] + Sequencer[0-4] + </literallayout> + </para> + + <para> + The number of registers actually saved may be modified by a prior call + to <function>vgaHWSetRegCounts()</function>. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void vgaHWSaveFonts(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, vgaRegPtr save); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function saves the text mode font and text data held in the + video memory. If called while in a graphics mode, no save is + done. The VGA memory window must be mapped with + <function>vgaHWMapMem()</function> before to calling this function. + </para> + + <para> + On some platforms, one or more of the font/text plane saves may be + no-ops. This is the case when the platform's VC driver already + takes care of this. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void vgaHWSaveColormap(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, vgaRegPtr save); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function saves the VGA colourmap (LUT). Before saving it, it + attempts to verify that the colourmap is readable. In rare cases + where it isn't readable, a default colourmap is saved instead. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void vgaHWRestore(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, vgaRegPtr restore, int flags); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function programs the VGA state. The state programmed is + that contained in the <structname>vgaRegRec</structname> pointed to by + <parameter>restore</parameter>. <parameter>flags</parameter> is the same + as described above for the <function>vgaHWSave()</function> function. + </para> + + <para> + The <structname>vgaHWRec</structname> and its <structfield>IOBase</structfield> fields + must be initialised before this function is called. If + <constant>VGA_SR_FONTS</constant> is set in <parameter>flags</parameter>, the + VGA memory window must be mapped. If it isn't then + <function>vgaHWMapMem()</function> will be called to map it, and + <function>vgaHWUnmapMem()</function> will be called to unmap it + afterwards. <function>vgaHWRestore()</function> uses the three functions + below in the order <function>vgaHWRestoreFonts()</function>, + <function>vgaHWRestoreMode()</function>, + <function>vgaHWRestoreColormap()</function> to carry out the different + restore phases. It is undecided at this stage whether they will + remain part of the vgahw module's public interface or not. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void vgaHWRestoreMode(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, vgaRegPtr restore); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function restores the VGA mode registers. They are restored + from the data in the <structname>vgaRegRec</structname> pointed to by + <parameter>restore</parameter>. The registers restored are: + + <literallayout> + MiscOut + CRTC[0-0x18] + Attribute[0-0x14] + Graphics[0-8] + Sequencer[0-4] + </literallayout> + </para> + + <para> + The number of registers actually restored may be modified by a prior call + to <function>vgaHWSetRegCounts()</function>. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void vgaHWRestoreFonts(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, vgaRegPtr restore); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function restores the text mode font and text data to the + video memory. The VGA memory window must be mapped with + <function>vgaHWMapMem()</function> before to calling this function. + </para> + + <para> + On some platforms, one or more of the font/text plane restores + may be no-ops. This is the case when the platform's VC driver + already takes care of this. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void vgaHWRestoreColormap(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, vgaRegPtr restore); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function restores the VGA colourmap (LUT). + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void vgaHWInit(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, DisplayModePtr mode); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function fills in the <structname>vgaHWRec</structname>'s + <structfield>ModeReg</structfield> field with the values appropriate for + programming the given video mode. It requires that the + <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>'s <structfield>depth</structfield> field is + initialised, which determines how the registers are programmed. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void vgaHWSeqReset(vgaHWPtr hwp, Bool start); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Do a VGA sequencer reset. If start is <constant>TRUE</constant>, the + reset is started. If start is <constant>FALSE</constant>, the reset + is ended. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void vgaHWProtect(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, Bool on); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function protects VGA registers and memory from corruption + during loads. It is typically called with on set to + <constant>TRUE</constant> before programming, and with on set to + <constant>FALSE</constant> after programming. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + Bool vgaHWSaveScreen(ScreenPtr pScreen, int mode); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function blanks and unblanks the screen. It is blanked when + <parameter>mode</parameter> is <constant>SCREEN_SAVER_ON</constant> or + <constant>SCREEN_SAVER_CYCLE</constant>, and unblanked when + <parameter>mode</parameter> is <constant>SCREEN_SAVER_OFF</constant> or + <constant>SCREEN_SAVER_FORCER</constant>. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void vgaHWBlankScreen(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, Bool on); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + This function blanks and unblanks the screen. It is blanked when + <parameter>on</parameter> is <constant>FALSE</constant>, and unblanked when + <parameter>on</parameter> is <constant>TRUE</constant>. This function is + provided for use in cases where the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> + can't be derived from the <structname>ScreenRec</structname> (while probing + for clocks, for example). + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + </sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>VGA Colormap Functions</title> + + <para> + The vgahw module uses the standard colormap support (see the + <link linkend="cmap">Colormap Handling</link> section. This is initialised + with the following function: + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + Bool vgaHWHandleColormaps(ScreenPtr pScreen); + </programlisting> + </para></blockquote> + </para> + + </sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>VGA Register Access Functions</title> + + <para> + The vgahw module abstracts access to the standard VGA registers by + using a set of functions held in the <structname>vgaHWRec</structname>. When + the <structname>vgaHWRec</structname> is created these function pointers are + initialised with the set of standard VGA I/O register access functions. + In addition to these, the vgahw module includes a basic set of MMIO + register access functions, and the <structname>vgaHWRec</structname> function + pointers can be initialised to these by calling the + <function>vgaHWSetMmioFuncs()</function> function described above. Some + drivers/platforms may require a different set of functions for VGA + access. The access functions are described here. + </para> + + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void writeCrtc(vgaHWPtr hwp, CARD8 index, CARD8 value); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Write <parameter>value</parameter> to CRTC register <parameter>index</parameter>. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + CARD8 readCrtc(vgaHWPtr hwp, CARD8 index); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Return the value read from CRTC register <parameter>index</parameter>. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void writeGr(vgaHWPtr hwp, CARD8 index, CARD8 value); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Write <parameter>value</parameter> to Graphics Controller register + <parameter>index</parameter>. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + CARD8 readGR(vgaHWPtr hwp, CARD8 index); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Return the value read from Graphics Controller register + <parameter>index</parameter>. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void writeSeq(vgaHWPtr hwp, CARD8 index, CARD8, value); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Write <parameter>value</parameter> to Sequencer register + <parameter>index</parameter>. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + CARD8 readSeq(vgaHWPtr hwp, CARD8 index); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Return the value read from Sequencer register <parameter>index</parameter>. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void writeAttr(vgaHWPtr hwp, CARD8 index, CARD8, value); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Write <parameter>value</parameter> to Attribute Controller register + <parameter>index</parameter>. When writing out the index value this + function should set bit 5 (<constant>0x20</constant>) according to the + setting of <structfield>hwp->paletteEnabled</structfield> in order to + preserve the palette access state. It should be cleared when + <structfield>hwp->paletteEnabled</structfield> is <constant>TRUE</constant> + and set when it is <constant>FALSE</constant>. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + CARD8 readAttr(vgaHWPtr hwp, CARD8 index); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Return the value read from Attribute Controller register + <parameter>index</parameter>. When writing out the index value this + function should set bit 5 (<constant>0x20</constant>) according to the + setting of <structfield>hwp->paletteEnabled</structfield> in order to + preserve the palette access state. It should be cleared when + <structfield>hwp->paletteEnabled</structfield> is <constant>TRUE</constant> + and set when it is <constant>FALSE</constant>. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void writeMiscOut(vgaHWPtr hwp, CARD8 value); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Write <quote><parameter>value</parameter></quote> to the Miscellaneous Output register. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + CARD8 readMiscOut(vgwHWPtr hwp); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Return the value read from the Miscellaneous Output register. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void enablePalette(vgaHWPtr hwp); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Clear the palette address source bit in the Attribute Controller + index register and set <literal remap="tt">hwp->paletteEnabled</literal> to + <constant>TRUE</constant>. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void disablePalette(vgaHWPtr hwp); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Set the palette address source bit in the Attribute Controller + index register and set <literal remap="tt">hwp->paletteEnabled</literal> to + <constant>FALSE</constant>. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void writeDacMask(vgaHWPtr hwp, CARD8 value); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Write <parameter>value</parameter> to the DAC Mask register. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + CARD8 readDacMask(vgaHWptr hwp); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Return the value read from the DAC Mask register. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void writeDacReadAddress(vgaHWPtr hwp, CARD8 value); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Write <parameter>value</parameter> to the DAC Read Address register. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void writeDacWriteAddress(vgaHWPtr hwp, CARD8 value); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Write <parameter>value</parameter> to the DAC Write Address register. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void writeDacData(vgaHWPtr hwp, CARD8 value); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Write <parameter>value</parameter> to the DAC Data register. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + CARD8 readDacData(vgaHWptr hwp); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Return the value read from the DAC Data register. + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + CARD8 readEnable(vgaHWptr hwp); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Return the value read from the VGA Enable register. (Note: This + function is present in XFree86 4.1.0 and later.) + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + + <blockquote><para> + <programlisting> + void writeEnable(vgaHWPtr hwp, CARD8 value); + </programlisting> + <blockquote><para> + Write <parameter>value</parameter> to the VGA Enable register. (Note: This + function is present in XFree86 4.1.0 and later.) + </para> + + </blockquote></para></blockquote> + </sect2> + </sect1> + + <sect1 id="sample"> + <title>Some notes about writing a driver</title> + + <note><para>NOTE: some parts of this are not up to date</para></note> + + <para> +The following is an outline for writing a basic unaccelerated driver +for a PCI video card with a linear mapped framebuffer, and which has a +VGA core. It is includes some general information that is relevant to +most drivers (even those which don't fit that basic description). + </para> + + <para> +The information here is based on the initial conversion of the Matrox +Millennium driver to the <quote>new design</quote>. For a fleshing out and sample +implementation of some of the bits outlined here, refer to that driver. +Note that this is an example only. The approach used here will not be +appropriate for all drivers. + </para> + + <para> +Each driver must reserve a unique driver name, and a string that is used +to prefix all of its externally visible symbols. This is to avoid name +space clashes when loading multiple drivers. The examples here are for +the <quote>ZZZ</quote> driver, which uses the <quote>ZZZ</quote> or <quote>zzz</quote> prefix for its externally +visible symbols. + </para> + + <sect2> + <title>Include files</title> + + <para> + All drivers normally include the following headers: + <literallayout><filename> + "xf86.h" + "xf86_OSproc.h" + "xf86_ansic.h" + "xf86Resources.h" + </filename></literallayout> + Wherever inb/outb (and related things) are used the following should be + included: + <literallayout><filename> + "compiler.h" + </filename></literallayout> + Note: in drivers, this must be included after <filename>"xf86_ansic.h"</filename>. + </para> + + <para> + Drivers that need to access PCI vendor/device definitions need this: + <literallayout><filename> + "xf86PciInfo.h" + </filename></literallayout> + </para> + + <para> + Drivers that need to access the PCI config space need this: + <literallayout><filename> + "xf86Pci.h" + </filename></literallayout> + </para> + + <para> + Drivers using the mi banking wrapper need: + + <literallayout><filename> + "mibank.h" + </filename></literallayout> + </para> + + <para> + Drivers that initialise a SW cursor need this: + <literallayout><filename> + "mipointer.h" + </filename></literallayout> + </para> + + <para> + All drivers implementing backing store need this: + <literallayout><filename> + "mibstore.h" + </filename></literallayout> + </para> + + <para> + All drivers using the mi colourmap code need this: + <literallayout><filename> + "micmap.h" + </filename></literallayout> + </para> + + <para> + If a driver uses the vgahw module, it needs this: + <literallayout><filename> + "vgaHW.h" + </filename></literallayout> + </para> + + <para> + Drivers supporting VGA or Hercules monochrome screens need: + <literallayout><filename> + "xf1bpp.h" + </filename></literallayout> + </para> + + <para> + Drivers supporting VGA or EGC 16-colour screens need: + <literallayout><filename> + "xf4bpp.h" + </filename></literallayout> + </para> + + <para> + Drivers using cfb need: + <programlisting> + #define PSZ 8 + #include "cfb.h" + #undef PSZ + </programlisting> + </para> + + <para> + Drivers supporting bpp 16, 24 or 32 with cfb need one or more of: + <literallayout><filename> + "cfb16.h" + "cfb24.h" + "cfb32.h" + </filename></literallayout> + </para> + + <para> + The driver's own header file: + <literallayout><filename> + "zzz.h" + </filename></literallayout> + </para> + + <para> + Drivers must NOT include the following: + + <literallayout><filename> + "xf86Priv.h" + "xf86Privstr.h" + "xf86_libc.h" + "xf86_OSlib.h" + "Xos.h"</filename> + any OS header + </literallayout> + </para> + + </sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>Data structures and initialisation</title> + + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para>The following macros should be defined: + <programlisting> +#define VERSION <version-as-an-int> +#define ZZZ_NAME "ZZZ" /* the name used to prefix messages */ +#define ZZZ_DRIVER_NAME "zzz" /* the driver name as used in config file */ +#define ZZZ_MAJOR_VERSION <int> +#define ZZZ_MINOR_VERSION <int> +#define ZZZ_PATCHLEVEL <int> + </programlisting> + </para> + <para> + NOTE: <constant>ZZZ_DRIVER_NAME</constant> should match the name of the + driver module without things like the "lib" prefix, the "_drv" suffix + or filename extensions. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + A DriverRec must be defined, which includes the functions required + at the pre-probe phase. The name of this DriverRec must be an + upper-case version of ZZZ_DRIVER_NAME (for the purposes of static + linking). + <programlisting> +DriverRec ZZZ = { + VERSION, + ZZZ_DRIVER_NAME, + ZZZIdentify, + ZZZProbe, + ZZZAvailableOptions, + NULL, + 0 +}; + </programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para>Define list of supported chips and their matching ID: + <programlisting> +static SymTabRec ZZZChipsets[] = { + { PCI_CHIP_ZZZ1234, "zzz1234a" }, + { PCI_CHIP_ZZZ5678, "zzz5678a" }, + { -1, NULL } +}; + </programlisting> + </para> + <para> + The token field may be any integer value that the driver may use to + uniquely identify the supported chipsets. For drivers that support + only PCI devices using the PCI device IDs might be a natural choice, + but this isn't mandatory. For drivers that support both PCI and other + devices (like ISA), some other ID should probably used. When other + IDs are used as the tokens it is recommended that the names be + defined as an <type>enum</type> type. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + If the driver uses the <function>xf86MatchPciInstances()</function> + helper (recommended for drivers that support PCI cards) a list that + maps PCI IDs to chip IDs and fixed resources must be defined: + <programlisting> +static PciChipsets ZZZPciChipsets[] = { + { PCI_CHIP_ZZZ1234, PCI_CHIP_ZZZ1234, RES_SHARED_VGA }, + { PCI_CHIP_ZZZ5678, PCI_CHIP_ZZZ5678, RES_SHARED_VGA }, + { -1, -1, RES_UNDEFINED } +} + </programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Define the <structname>XF86ModuleVersionInfo</structname> struct for the + driver. This is required for the dynamically loaded version: + <programlisting> +static XF86ModuleVersionInfo zzzVersRec = +{ + "zzz", + MODULEVENDORSTRING, + MODINFOSTRING1, + MODINFOSTRING2, + XF86_VERSION_CURRENT, + ZZZ_MAJOR_VERSION, ZZZ_MINOR_VERSION, ZZZ_PATCHLEVEL, + ABI_CLASS_VIDEODRV, + ABI_VIDEODRV_VERSION, + MOD_CLASS_VIDEODRV, + {0,0,0,0} +}; + </programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Define a data structure to hold the driver's screen-specific data. + This must be used instead of global variables. This would be defined + in the <filename>"zzz.h"</filename> file, something like: + <programlisting> +typedef struct { + type1 field1; + type2 field2; + int fooHack; + Bool pciRetry; + Bool noAccel; + Bool hwCursor; + CloseScreenProcPtr CloseScreen; + OptionInfoPtr Options; + ... +} ZZZRec, *ZZZPtr; + </programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Define the list of config file Options that the driver accepts. For + consistency between drivers those in the list of <quote>standard</quote> options + should be used where appropriate before inventing new options. + + <programlisting> +typedef enum { + OPTION_FOO_HACK, + OPTION_PCI_RETRY, + OPTION_HW_CURSOR, + OPTION_NOACCEL +} ZZZOpts; + +static const OptionInfoRec ZZZOptions[] = { + { OPTION_FOO_HACK, "FooHack", OPTV_INTEGER, {0}, FALSE }, + { OPTION_PCI_RETRY, "PciRetry", OPTV_BOOLEAN, {0}, FALSE }, + { OPTION_HW_CURSOR, "HWcursor", OPTV_BOOLEAN, {0}, FALSE }, + { OPTION_NOACCEL, "NoAccel", OPTV_BOOLEAN, {0}, FALSE }, + { -1, NULL, OPTV_NONE, {0}, FALSE } +}; + </programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>Functions</title> + + + <sect3> + <title>SetupProc</title> + + <para> + For dynamically loaded modules, a <varname>ModuleData</varname> + variable is required. It is should be the name of the driver + prepended to "ModuleData". A <function>Setup()</function> function is + also required, which calls <function>xf86AddDriver()</function> to add + the driver to the main list of drivers. + </para> + + <programlisting> +static MODULESETUPPROTO(zzzSetup); + +XF86ModuleData zzzModuleData = { &zzzVersRec, zzzSetup, NULL }; + +static pointer +zzzSetup(pointer module, pointer opts, int *errmaj, int *errmin) +{ + static Bool setupDone = FALSE; + + /* This module should be loaded only once, but check to be sure. */ + + if (!setupDone) { + /* + * Modules that this driver always requires may be loaded + * here by calling LoadSubModule(). + */ + + setupDone = TRUE; + xf86AddDriver(&MGA, module, 0); + + /* + * The return value must be non-NULL on success even though + * there is no TearDownProc. + */ + return (pointer)1; + } else { + if (errmaj) *errmaj = LDR_ONCEONLY; + return NULL; + } +} + </programlisting> + </sect3> + + <sect3> + <title>GetRec, FreeRec</title> + + <para> + A function is usually required to allocate the driver's + screen-specific data structure and hook it into the + <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>'s <structfield>driverPrivate</structfield> field. + The <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>'s <structfield>driverPrivate</structfield> is + initialised to <constant>NULL</constant>, so it is easy to check if the + initialisation has already been done. After allocating it, initialise + the fields. By using <function>xnfcalloc()</function> to do the allocation + it is zeroed, and if the allocation fails the server exits. + </para> + + <para> + NOTE: + When allocating structures from inside the driver which are defined + on the common level it is important to initialize the structure to + zero. + Only this guarantees that the server remains source compatible to + future changes in common level structures. + </para> + + <programlisting> +static Bool +ZZZGetRec(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn) +{ + if (pScrn->driverPrivate != NULL) + return TRUE; + pScrn->driverPrivate = xnfcalloc(sizeof(ZZZRec), 1); + /* Initialise as required */ + ... + return TRUE; +} + </programlisting> + + <para> + Define a macro in <filename>"zzz.h"</filename> which gets a pointer to + the <structname>ZZZRec</structname> when given <parameter>pScrn</parameter>: + + <programlisting> +#define ZZZPTR(p) ((ZZZPtr)((p)->driverPrivate)) + </programlisting> + </para> + + <para> + Define a function to free the above, setting it to <constant>NULL</constant> + once it has been freed: + + <programlisting> +static void +ZZZFreeRec(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn) +{ + if (pScrn->driverPrivate == NULL) + return; + xfree(pScrn->driverPrivate); + pScrn->driverPrivate = NULL; +} + </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3> + <title>Identify</title> + + <para> + Define the <function>Identify()</function> function. It is run before + the Probe, and typically prints out an identifying message, which + might include the chipsets it supports. This function is mandatory: + + <programlisting> +static void +ZZZIdentify(int flags) +{ + xf86PrintChipsets(ZZZ_NAME, "driver for ZZZ Tech chipsets", + ZZZChipsets); +} + </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3> + <title>Probe</title> + + <para> + Define the <function>Probe()</function> function. The purpose of this + is to find all instances of the hardware that the driver supports, + and for the ones not already claimed by another driver, claim the + slot, and allocate a <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>. This should be + a minimal probe, and it should under no circumstances leave the + state of the hardware changed. Because a device is found, don't + assume that it will be used. Don't do any initialisations other + than the required <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> initialisations. + Don't allocate any new data structures. + </para> + + <para> + This function is mandatory. + </para> + + <para> + NOTE: The <function>xf86DrvMsg()</function> functions cannot be used from + the Probe. + </para> + + <programlisting> +static Bool +ZZZProbe(DriverPtr drv, int flags) +{ + Bool foundScreen = FALSE; + int numDevSections, numUsed; + GDevPtr *devSections; + int *usedChips; + int i; + + /* + * Find the config file Device sections that match this + * driver, and return if there are none. + */ + if ((numDevSections = xf86MatchDevice(ZZZ_DRIVER_NAME, + &devSections)) <= 0) { + return FALSE; + } + + /* + * Since this is a PCI card, "probing" just amounts to checking + * the PCI data that the server has already collected. If there + * is none, return. + * + * Although the config file is allowed to override things, it + * is reasonable to not allow it to override the detection + * of no PCI video cards. + * + * The provided xf86MatchPciInstances() helper takes care of + * the details. + */ + /* test if PCI bus present */ + if (xf86GetPciVideoInfo()) { + + numUsed = xf86MatchPciInstances(ZZZ_NAME, PCI_VENDOR_ZZZ, + ZZZChipsets, ZZZPciChipsets, devSections, + numDevSections, drv, &usedChips); + + for (i = 0; i < numUsed; i++) { + ScrnInfoPtr pScrn = NULL; + if ((pScrn = xf86ConfigPciEntity(pScrn, flags, usedChips[i], + ZZZPciChipsets, NULL, NULL, + NULL, NULL, NULL))) { + /* Allocate a ScrnInfoRec */ + pScrn->driverVersion = VERSION; + pScrn->driverName = ZZZ_DRIVER_NAME; + pScrn->name = ZZZ_NAME; + pScrn->Probe = ZZZProbe; + pScrn->PreInit = ZZZPreInit; + pScrn->ScreenInit = ZZZScreenInit; + pScrn->SwitchMode = ZZZSwitchMode; + pScrn->AdjustFrame = ZZZAdjustFrame; + pScrn->EnterVT = ZZZEnterVT; + pScrn->LeaveVT = ZZZLeaveVT; + pScrn->FreeScreen = ZZZFreeScreen; + pScrn->ValidMode = ZZZValidMode; + foundScreen = TRUE; + /* add screen to entity */ + } + } + xfree(usedChips); + } + +#ifdef HAS_ISA_DEVS + /* + * If the driver supports ISA hardware, the following block + * can be included too. + */ + numUsed = xf86MatchIsaInstances(ZZZ_NAME, ZZZChipsets, + ZZZIsaChipsets, drv, ZZZFindIsaDevice, + devSections, numDevSections, &usedChips); + for (i = 0; i < numUsed; i++) { + ScrnInfoPtr pScrn = NULL; + if ((pScrn = xf86ConfigIsaEntity(pScrn, flags, usedChips[i], + ZZZIsaChipsets, NULL, NULL, NULL, + NULL, NULL))) { + pScrn->driverVersion = VERSION; + pScrn->driverName = ZZZ_DRIVER_NAME; + pScrn->name = ZZZ_NAME; + pScrn->Probe = ZZZProbe; + pScrn->PreInit = ZZZPreInit; + pScrn->ScreenInit = ZZZScreenInit; + pScrn->SwitchMode = ZZZSwitchMode; + pScrn->AdjustFrame = ZZZAdjustFrame; + pScrn->EnterVT = ZZZEnterVT; + pScrn->LeaveVT = ZZZLeaveVT; + pScrn->FreeScreen = ZZZFreeScreen; + pScrn->ValidMode = ZZZValidMode; + foundScreen = TRUE; + } + } + xfree(usedChips); +#endif /* HAS_ISA_DEVS */ + + xfree(devSections); + return foundScreen; + </programlisting> + </sect3> + + <sect3> + <title>AvailableOptions</title> + + <para> + Define the <function>AvailableOptions()</function> function. The purpose + of this is to return the available driver options back to the + -configure option, so that an xorg.conf file can be built and the + user can see which options are available for them to use. + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3> + <title>PreInit</title> + + <para> + Define the <function>PreInit()</function> function. The purpose of + this is to find all the information required to determine if the + configuration is usable, and to initialise those parts of the + <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> that can be set once at the beginning + of the first server generation. The information should be found in + the least intrusive way possible. + </para> + + <para> + This function is mandatory. + </para> + + <para> + NOTES: + <orderedlist> + <listitem><para> + The <function>PreInit()</function> function is only called once + during the life of the X server (at the start of the first + generation). + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + Data allocated here must be of the type that persists for + the life of the X server. This means that data that hooks into + the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname>'s <structfield>privates</structfield> + field should be allocated here, but data that hooks into the + <structname>ScreenRec</structname>'s <structfield>devPrivates</structfield> field + should not be allocated here. The <structfield>driverPrivate</structfield> + field should also be allocated here. + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + Although the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> has been allocated + before this function is called, the <structname>ScreenRec</structname> + has not been allocated. That means that things requiring it + cannot be used in this function. + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + Very little of the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> has been + initialised when this function is called. It is important to + get the order of doing things right in this function. + </para></listitem> + + </orderedlist> + </para> + + <programlisting> +static Bool +ZZZPreInit(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, int flags) +{ + /* Fill in the monitor field */ + pScrn->monitor = pScrn->confScreen->monitor; + + /* + * If using the vgahw module, it will typically be loaded + * here by calling xf86LoadSubModule(pScrn, "vgahw"); + */ + + /* + * Set the depth/bpp. Use the globally preferred depth/bpp. If the + * driver has special default depth/bpp requirements, the defaults should + * be specified here explicitly. + * We support both 24bpp and 32bpp framebuffer layouts. + * This sets pScrn->display also. + */ + if (!xf86SetDepthBpp(pScrn, 0, 0, 0, + Support24bppFb | Support32bppFb)) { + return FALSE; + } else { + if (depth/bpp isn't one we support) { + print error message; + return FALSE; + } + } + /* Print out the depth/bpp that was set */ + xf86PrintDepthBpp(pScrn); + + /* Set bits per RGB for 8bpp */ + if (pScrn->depth <= 8) { + /* Take into account a dac_6_bit option here */ + pScrn->rgbBits = 6 or 8; + } + + /* + * xf86SetWeight() and xf86SetDefaultVisual() must be called + * after pScrn->display is initialised. + */ + + /* Set weight/mask/offset for depth > 8 */ + if (pScrn->depth > 8) { + if (!xf86SetWeight(pScrn, defaultWeight, defaultMask)) { + return FALSE; + } else { + if (weight isn't one we support) { + print error message; + return FALSE; + } + } + } + + /* Set the default visual. */ + if (!xf86SetDefaultVisual(pScrn, -1)) { + return FALSE; + } else { + if (visual isn't one we support) { + print error message; + return FALSE; + } + } + + /* If the driver supports gamma correction, set the gamma. */ + if (!xf86SetGamma(pScrn, default_gamma)) { + return FALSE; + } + + /* This driver uses a programmable clock */ + pScrn->progClock = TRUE; + + /* Allocate the ZZZRec driverPrivate */ + if (!ZZZGetRec(pScrn)) { + return FALSE; + } + + pZzz = ZZZPTR(pScrn); + + /* Collect all of the option flags (fill in pScrn->options) */ + xf86CollectOptions(pScrn, NULL); + + /* + * Process the options based on the information in ZZZOptions. + * The results are written to pZzz->Options. If all of the options + * processing is done within this function a local variable "options" + * can be used instead of pZzz->Options. + */ + if (!(pZzz->Options = xalloc(sizeof(ZZZOptions)))) + return FALSE; + (void)memcpy(pZzz->Options, ZZZOptions, sizeof(ZZZOptions)); + xf86ProcessOptions(pScrn->scrnIndex, pScrn->options, pZzz->Options); + + /* + * Set various fields of ScrnInfoRec and/or ZZZRec based on + * the options found. + */ + from = X_DEFAULT; + pZzz->hwCursor = FALSE; + if (xf86IsOptionSet(pZzz->Options, OPTION_HW_CURSOR)) { + from = X_CONFIG; + pZzz->hwCursor = TRUE; + } + xf86DrvMsg(pScrn->scrnIndex, from, "Using %s cursor\n", + pZzz->hwCursor ? "HW" : "SW"); + if (xf86IsOptionSet(pZzz->Options, OPTION_NOACCEL)) { + pZzz->noAccel = TRUE; + xf86DrvMsg(pScrn->scrnIndex, X_CONFIG, + "Acceleration disabled\n"); + } else { + pZzz->noAccel = FALSE; + } + if (xf86IsOptionSet(pZzz->Options, OPTION_PCI_RETRY)) { + pZzz->UsePCIRetry = TRUE; + xf86DrvMsg(pScrn->scrnIndex, X_CONFIG, "PCI retry enabled\n"); + } + pZzz->fooHack = 0; + if (xf86GetOptValInteger(pZzz->Options, OPTION_FOO_HACK, + &pZzz->fooHack)) { + xf86DrvMsg(pScrn->scrnIndex, X_CONFIG, "Foo Hack set to %d\n", + pZzz->fooHack); + } + + /* + * Find the PCI slot(s) that this screen claimed in the probe. + * In this case, exactly one is expected, so complain otherwise. + * Note in this case we're not interested in the card types so + * that parameter is set to NULL. + */ + if ((i = xf86GetPciInfoForScreen(pScrn->scrnIndex, &pciList, NULL)) + != 1) { + print error message; + ZZZFreeRec(pScrn); + if (i > 0) + xfree(pciList); + return FALSE; + } + /* Note that pciList should be freed below when no longer needed */ + + /* + * Determine the chipset, allowing config file chipset and + * chipid values to override the probed information. The config + * chipset value has precedence over its chipid value if both + * are present. + * + * It isn't necessary to fill in pScrn->chipset if the driver + * keeps track of the chipset in its ZZZRec. + */ + + ... + + /* + * Determine video memory, fb base address, I/O addresses, etc, + * allowing the config file to override probed values. + * + * Set the appropriate pScrn fields (videoRam is probably the + * most important one that other code might require), and + * print out the settings. + */ + + ... + + /* Initialise a clockRanges list. */ + + ... + + /* Set any other chipset specific things in the ZZZRec */ + + ... + + /* Select valid modes from those available */ + + i = xf86ValidateModes(pScrn, pScrn->monitor->Modes, + pScrn->display->modes, clockRanges, + NULL, minPitch, maxPitch, rounding, + minHeight, maxHeight, + pScrn->display->virtualX, + pScrn->display->virtualY, + pScrn->videoRam * 1024, + LOOKUP_BEST_REFRESH); + if (i == -1) { + ZZZFreeRec(pScrn); + return FALSE; + } + + /* Prune the modes marked as invalid */ + + xf86PruneDriverModes(pScrn); + + /* If no valid modes, return */ + + if (i == 0 || pScrn->modes == NULL) { + print error message; + ZZZFreeRec(pScrn); + return FALSE; + } + + /* + * Initialise the CRTC fields for the modes. This driver expects + * vertical values to be halved for interlaced modes. + */ + xf86SetCrtcForModes(pScrn, INTERLACE_HALVE_V); + + /* Set the current mode to the first in the list. */ + pScrn->currentMode = pScrn->modes; + + /* Print the list of modes being used. */ + xf86PrintModes(pScrn); + + /* Set the DPI */ + xf86SetDpi(pScrn, 0, 0); + + /* Load bpp-specific modules */ + switch (pScrn->bitsPerPixel) { + case 1: + mod = "xf1bpp"; + break; + case 4: + mod = "xf4bpp"; + break; + case 8: + mod = "cfb"; + break; + case 16: + mod = "cfb16"; + break; + case 24: + mod = "cfb24"; + break; + case 32: + mod = "cfb32"; + break; + } + if (mod && !xf86LoadSubModule(pScrn, mod)) + ZZZFreeRec(pScrn); + return FALSE; + + /* Load XAA if needed */ + if (!pZzz->noAccel || pZzz->hwCursor) + if (!xf86LoadSubModule(pScrn, "xaa")) { + ZZZFreeRec(pScrn); + return FALSE; + } + + /* Done */ + return TRUE; +} + </programlisting> + </sect3> + + <sect3> + <title>MapMem, UnmapMem</title> + + <para> + Define functions to map and unmap the video memory and any other + memory apertures required. These functions are not mandatory, but + it is often useful to have such functions. + </para> + + <programlisting> +static Bool +ZZZMapMem(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn) +{ + /* Call xf86MapPciMem() to map each PCI memory area */ + ... + return TRUE or FALSE; +} + +static Bool +ZZZUnmapMem(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn) +{ + /* Call xf86UnMapVidMem() to unmap each memory area */ + ... + return TRUE or FALSE; +} + </programlisting> + </sect3> + + <sect3> + <title>Save, Restore</title> + + <para> + Define functions to save and restore the original video state. These + functions are not mandatory, but are often useful. + </para> + + <programlisting> +static void +ZZZSave(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn) +{ + /* + * Save state into per-screen data structures. + * If using the vgahw module, vgaHWSave will typically be + * called here. + */ + ... +} + +static void +ZZZRestore(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn) +{ + /* + * Restore state from per-screen data structures. + * If using the vgahw module, vgaHWRestore will typically be + * called here. + */ + ... +} + </programlisting> + </sect3> + + <sect3> + <title>ModeInit</title> + + <para> + Define a function to initialise a new video mode. This function isn't + mandatory, but is often useful. + </para> + + <programlisting> +static Bool +ZZZModeInit(ScrnInfoPtr pScrn, DisplayModePtr mode) +{ + /* + * Program a video mode. If using the vgahw module, + * vgaHWInit and vgaRestore will typically be called here. + * Once up to the point where there can't be a failure + * set pScrn->vtSema to TRUE. + */ + ... +} + </programlisting> + </sect3> + + <sect3> + <title>ScreenInit</title> + + <para> + Define the <function>ScreenInit()</function> function. This is called + at the start of each server generation, and should fill in as much + of the <structname>ScreenRec</structname> as possible as well as any other + data that is initialised once per generation. It should initialise + the framebuffer layers it is using, and initialise the initial video + mode. + </para> + + <para> + This function is mandatory. + </para> + + <para> + NOTE: The <structname>ScreenRec</structname> (<parameter>pScreen</parameter>) is + passed to this driver, but it and the + <varname>ScrnInfoRecs</varname> are not yet hooked into each + other. This means that in this function, and functions it + calls, one cannot be found from the other. + </para> + + <programlisting> +static Bool +ZZZScreenInit(int scrnIndex, ScreenPtr pScreen, int argc, char **argv) +{ + /* Get the ScrnInfoRec */ + pScrn = xf86Screens[pScreen->myNum]; + + /* + * If using the vgahw module, its data structures and related + * things are typically initialised/mapped here. + */ + + /* Save the current video state */ + ZZZSave(pScrn); + + /* Initialise the first mode */ + ZZZModeInit(pScrn, pScrn->currentMode); + + /* Set the viewport if supported */ + + ZZZAdjustFrame(scrnIndex, pScrn->frameX0, pScrn->frameY0, 0); + + /* + * Setup the screen's visuals, and initialise the framebuffer + * code. + */ + + /* Reset the visual list */ + miClearVisualTypes(); + + /* + * Setup the visuals supported. This driver only supports + * TrueColor for bpp > 8, so the default set of visuals isn't + * acceptable. To deal with this, call miSetVisualTypes with + * the appropriate visual mask. + */ + + if (pScrn->bitsPerPixel > 8) { + if (!miSetVisualTypes(pScrn->depth, TrueColorMask, + pScrn->rgbBits, pScrn->defaultVisual)) + return FALSE; + } else { + if (!miSetVisualTypes(pScrn->depth, + miGetDefaultVisualMask(pScrn->depth), + pScrn->rgbBits, pScrn->defaultVisual)) + return FALSE; + } + + /* + * Initialise the framebuffer. + */ + + switch (pScrn->bitsPerPixel) { + case 1: + ret = xf1bppScreenInit(pScreen, FbBase, + pScrn->virtualX, pScrn->virtualY, + pScrn->xDpi, pScrn->yDpi, + pScrn->displayWidth); + break; + case 4: + ret = xf4bppScreenInit(pScreen, FbBase, + pScrn->virtualX, pScrn->virtualY, + pScrn->xDpi, pScrn->yDpi, + pScrn->displayWidth); + break; + case 8: + ret = cfbScreenInit(pScreen, FbBase, + pScrn->virtualX, pScrn->virtualY, + pScrn->xDpi, pScrn->yDpi, + pScrn->displayWidth); + break; + case 16: + ret = cfb16ScreenInit(pScreen, FbBase, + pScrn->virtualX, pScrn->virtualY, + pScrn->xDpi, pScrn->yDpi, + pScrn->displayWidth); + break; + case 24: + ret = cfb24ScreenInit(pScreen, FbBase, + pScrn->virtualX, pScrn->virtualY, + pScrn->xDpi, pScrn->yDpi, + pScrn->displayWidth); + break; + case 32: + ret = cfb32ScreenInit(pScreen, FbBase, + pScrn->virtualX, pScrn->virtualY, + pScrn->xDpi, pScrn->yDpi, + pScrn->displayWidth); + break; + default: + print a message about an internal error; + ret = FALSE; + break; + } + + if (!ret) + return FALSE; + + /* Override the default mask/offset settings */ + if (pScrn->bitsPerPixel > 8) { + for (i = 0, visual = pScreen->visuals; + i < pScreen->numVisuals; i++, visual++) { + if ((visual->class | DynamicClass) == DirectColor) { + visual->offsetRed = pScrn->offset.red; + visual->offsetGreen = pScrn->offset.green; + visual->offsetBlue = pScrn->offset.blue; + visual->redMask = pScrn->mask.red; + visual->greenMask = pScrn->mask.green; + visual->blueMask = pScrn->mask.blue; + } + } + } + + /* + * If banking is needed, initialise an miBankInfoRec (defined in + * "mibank.h"), and call miInitializeBanking(). + */ + if (!miInitializeBanking(pScreen, pScrn->virtualX, pScrn->virtualY, + pScrn->displayWidth, pBankInfo)) + return FALSE; + + /* + * If backing store is to be supported (as is usually the case), + * initialise it. + */ + miInitializeBackingStore(pScreen); + + /* + * Set initial black & white colourmap indices. + */ + xf86SetBlackWhitePixels(pScreen); + + /* + * Install colourmap functions. If using the vgahw module, + * vgaHandleColormaps would usually be called here. + */ + + ... + + /* + * Initialise cursor functions. This example is for the mi + * software cursor. + */ + miDCInitialize(pScreen, xf86GetPointerScreenFuncs()); + + /* Initialise the default colourmap */ + switch (pScrn->depth) { + case 1: + if (!xf1bppCreateDefColormap(pScreen)) + return FALSE; + break; + case 4: + if (!xf4bppCreateDefColormap(pScreen)) + return FALSE; + break; + default: + if (!cfbCreateDefColormap(pScreen)) + return FALSE; + break; + } + + /* + * Wrap the CloseScreen vector and set SaveScreen. + */ + ZZZPTR(pScrn)->CloseScreen = pScreen->CloseScreen; + pScreen->CloseScreen = ZZZCloseScreen; + pScreen->SaveScreen = ZZZSaveScreen; + + /* Report any unused options (only for the first generation) */ + if (serverGeneration == 1) { + xf86ShowUnusedOptions(pScrn->scrnIndex, pScrn->options); + } + + /* Done */ + return TRUE; +} + </programlisting> + </sect3> + + <sect3> + <title>SwitchMode</title> + + <para> + Define the <function>SwitchMode()</function> function if mode switching + is supported by the driver. + </para> + + <programlisting> +static Bool +ZZZSwitchMode(int scrnIndex, DisplayModePtr mode, int flags) +{ + return ZZZModeInit(xf86Screens[scrnIndex], mode); +} + </programlisting> + </sect3> + + <sect3> + <title>AdjustFrame</title> + + <para> + Define the <function>AdjustFrame()</function> function if the driver + supports this. + </para> + + <programlisting> +static void +ZZZAdjustFrame(int scrnIndex, int x, int y, int flags) +{ + /* Adjust the viewport */ +} + </programlisting> + </sect3> + + <sect3> + <title>EnterVT, LeaveVT</title> + + <para> + Define the <function>EnterVT()</function> and <function>LeaveVT()</function> + functions. + </para> + + <para> + These functions are mandatory. + </para> + + <programlisting> +static Bool +ZZZEnterVT(int scrnIndex, int flags) +{ + ScrnInfoPtr pScrn = xf86Screens[scrnIndex]; + return ZZZModeInit(pScrn, pScrn->currentMode); +} + +static void +ZZZLeaveVT(int scrnIndex, int flags) +{ + ScrnInfoPtr pScrn = xf86Screens[scrnIndex]; + ZZZRestore(pScrn); +} + </programlisting> + </sect3> + + <sect3> + <title>CloseScreen</title> + + <para> + Define the <function>CloseScreen()</function> function: + </para> + + <para> + This function is mandatory. Note that it unwraps the previously + wrapped <structfield>pScreen->CloseScreen</structfield>, and finishes by + calling it. + </para> + + <programlisting> +static Bool +ZZZCloseScreen(int scrnIndex, ScreenPtr pScreen) +{ + ScrnInfoPtr pScrn = xf86Screens[scrnIndex]; + if (pScrn->vtSema) { + ZZZRestore(pScrn); + ZZZUnmapMem(pScrn); + } + pScrn->vtSema = FALSE; + pScreen->CloseScreen = ZZZPTR(pScrn)->CloseScreen; + return (*pScreen->CloseScreen)(scrnIndex, pScreen); +} + </programlisting> + </sect3> + + <sect3> + <title>SaveScreen</title> + + <para> + Define the <function>SaveScreen()</function> function (the screen + blanking function). When using the vgahw module, this will typically + be: + + <programlisting> +static Bool +ZZZSaveScreen(ScreenPtr pScreen, int mode) +{ + return vgaHWSaveScreen(pScreen, mode); +} + </programlisting> + </para> + + <para> + This function is mandatory. Before modifying any hardware register + directly this function needs to make sure that the Xserver is active + by checking if <parameter>pScrn</parameter> is non-NULL and for + <literal remap="tt">pScrn->vtSema == TRUE</literal>. + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3> + <title>FreeScreen</title> + + <para> + Define the <function>FreeScreen()</function> function. This function + is optional. It should be defined if the <structname>ScrnInfoRec</structname> + <structfield>driverPrivate</structfield> field is used so that it can be freed + when a screen is deleted by the common layer for reasons possibly + beyond the driver's control. This function is not used in during + normal (error free) operation. The per-generation data is freed by + the <function>CloseScreen()</function> function. + </para> + + <programlisting> +static void +ZZZFreeScreen(int scrnIndex, int flags) +{ + /* + * If the vgahw module is used vgaHWFreeHWRec() would be called + * here. + */ + ZZZFreeRec(xf86Screens[scrnIndex]); +} + + </programlisting> + + </sect3> + + </sect2> + + </sect1> + +</article> diff --git a/xorg-server/hw/xfree86/doc/devel/Makefile.am b/xorg-server/hw/xfree86/doc/devel/Makefile.am deleted file mode 100644 index c9eca5eb3..000000000 --- a/xorg-server/hw/xfree86/doc/devel/Makefile.am +++ /dev/null @@ -1,7 +0,0 @@ -# Documentation for developers that is distributed with the source but -# not installed on the system for end-users - -EXTRA_DIST = \ - Registry \ - exa-driver.txt \ - README.DRIcomp diff --git a/xorg-server/hw/xfree86/doc/devel/exa-driver.txt b/xorg-server/hw/xfree86/doc/exa-driver.txt index 048307ee7..048307ee7 100644 --- a/xorg-server/hw/xfree86/doc/devel/exa-driver.txt +++ b/xorg-server/hw/xfree86/doc/exa-driver.txt diff --git a/xorg-server/hw/xfree86/doc/sgml/Makefile.am b/xorg-server/hw/xfree86/doc/sgml/Makefile.am deleted file mode 100644 index e6661c544..000000000 --- a/xorg-server/hw/xfree86/doc/sgml/Makefile.am +++ /dev/null @@ -1,27 +0,0 @@ -# Copyright 2005 Red Hat, Inc.
-#
-# Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this software
-# and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted without
-# fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies
-# and that both that copyright notice and this permission notice
-# appear in supporting documentation, and that the name of Red Hat
-# not be used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution
-# of the software without specific, written prior permission. Red
-# Hat makes no representations about the suitability of this software
-# for any purpose. It is provided "as is" without express or implied
-# warranty.
-#
-# RED HAT DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE,
-# INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN
-# NO EVENT SHALL RED HAT BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR
-# CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS
-# OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT,
-# NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING OUT OF OR IN
-# CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
-
-doc_sources = DESIGN.xml
-
-# Developer's documentation is not installed
-if ENABLE_DEVEL_DOCS
-include $(top_srcdir)/doc/xml/xmlrules-noinst.in
-endif
|